ZyXEL NSA210 1-Bay Digital Media Server User's Guide
The NSA210 1-Bay is a digital media server that allows you to store, share, and stream your digital media files over your network. It also has a variety of other features, such as a download service, a printer server, and an FTP server.
Advertisement
Advertisement
NSA210
1-Bay Digital Media Server
Default Login Details
Web Address
User Name
Password nsa210 admin
1234
Firmware Version 4.10
Edition 1, 10/2010
www.zyxel.com
www.zyxel.com
Copyright © 2010
ZyXEL Communications Corporation
About This User's Guide
About This User's Guide
Intended Audience
This manual is intended for people who want to configure the NSA using the Web
Configurator.
Tips for Reading User’s Guides On-Screen
When reading a ZyXEL User’s Guide On-Screen, keep the following in mind:
• If you don’t already have the latest version of Adobe Reader, you can download it from http://www.adobe.com.
• Use the PDF’s bookmarks to quickly navigate to the areas that interest you.
Adobe Reader’s bookmarks pane opens by default in all ZyXEL User’s Guide
PDFs.
• If you know the page number or know vaguely which page-range you want to view, you can enter a number in the toolbar in Reader, then press [ENTER] to jump directly to that page.
• Type [CTRL]+[F] to open the Adobe Reader search utility and enter a word or phrase. This can help you quickly pinpoint the information you require. You can also enter text directly into the toolbar in Reader.
• To quickly move around within a page, press the [SPACE] bar. This turns your cursor into a “hand” with which you can grab the page and move it around freely on your screen.
• Embedded hyperlinks are actually cross-references to related text. Click them to jump to the corresponding section of the User’s Guide PDF.
Related Documentation
• Quick Start Guide
The Quick Start Guide is designed to help you get your NSA up and running right away. It contains information on setting up your network and configuring for
Internet access.
• Web Configurator Online Help
The embedded Web Help contains descriptions of individual screens and supplementary information.
Note: It is recommended you use the Web Configurator to configure the NSA.
• Support Disc
Refer to the included CD for support documents.
3
NSA210 User’s Guide
4
About This User's Guide
Documentation Feedback
Send your comments, questions or suggestions to: [email protected]
Thank you!
The Technical Writing Team, ZyXEL Communications Corp.,
6 Innovation Road II, Science-Based Industrial Park, Hsinchu, 30099, Taiwan.
Need More Help?
More help is available at www.zyxel.com.
• Download Library
Search for the latest product updates and documentation from this link. Read the Tech Doc Overview to find out how to efficiently use the User Guide, Quick
Start Guide and Command Line Interface Reference Guide in order to better understand how to use your product.
• Knowledge Base
If you have a specific question about your product, the answer may be here.
This is a collection of answers to previously asked questions about ZyXEL products.
• Forum
This contains discussions on ZyXEL products. Learn from others who use ZyXEL products and share your experiences as well.
NSA210 User’s Guide
About This User's Guide
Customer Support
Should problems arise that cannot be solved by the methods listed above, you should contact your vendor. If you cannot contact your vendor, then contact a
ZyXEL office for the region in which you bought the device.
See http://www.zyxel.com/web/contact_us.php for contact information. Please have the following information ready when you contact an office.
• Product model and serial number.
• Warranty Information.
• Date that you received your device.
Brief description of the problem and the steps you took to solve it.
NSA210 User’s Guide
5
6
Document Conventions
Document Conventions
Warnings and Notes
These are how warnings and notes are shown in this User’s Guide.
Warnings tell you about things that could harm you or your device.
Note: Notes tell you other important information (for example, other things you may need to configure or helpful tips) or recommendations.
Syntax Conventions
• The NSA may be referred to as the “NSA”, the “device” or the “system” in this
User’s Guide.
• Product labels, screen names, field labels and field choices are all in bold font.
• A key stroke is denoted by square brackets and uppercase text, for example,
[ENTER] means the “enter” or “return” key on your keyboard.
• “Enter” means for you to type one or more characters and then press the
[ENTER] key. “Select” or “choose” means for you to use one of the predefined choices.
• A right angle bracket ( > ) within a screen name denotes a mouse click. For example, Maintenance > Log > Log Setting means you first click
Maintenance in the navigation panel, then the Log sub menu and finally the
Log Setting tab to get to that screen.
• Units of measurement may denote the “metric” value or the “scientific” value.
For example, “k” for kilo may denote “1000” or “1024”, “M” for mega may denote “1000000” or “1048576” and so on.
• “e.g.,” is a shorthand for “for instance”, and “i.e.,” means “that is” or “in other words”.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Document Conventions
Icons Used in Figures
Figures in this User’s Guide may use the following generic icons. The NSA icon is not an exact representation of your device.
Graphics in this book may differ slightly from the product due to differences in operating systems, operating system versions, or if you installed updated firmware/software for your device. Every effort has been made to ensure that the information in this manual is accurate.
NSA Computer Notebook computer
Server Television Firewall
Wireless Access Point Router
Internet
Switch
NSA210 User’s Guide
7
8
Safety Warnings
Safety Warnings
• Do NOT use this product near water, for example, in a wet basement or near a swimming pool.
• Do NOT expose your device to dampness, dust or corrosive liquids.
• Do NOT store things on the device.
• Do NOT install, use, or service this device during a thunderstorm. There is a remote risk of electric shock from lightning.
• Connect ONLY suitable accessories to the device.
• Do NOT open the device or unit. Opening or removing covers can expose you to dangerous high voltage points or other risks. ONLY qualified service personnel should service or disassemble this device. Please contact your vendor for further information.
• ONLY qualified service personnel should service or disassemble this device.
• Make sure to connect the cables to the correct ports.
• Place connecting cables carefully so that no one will step on them or stumble over them.
• Always disconnect all cables from this device before servicing or disassembling.
• Use ONLY an appropriate power adaptor or cord for your device.
• Connect the power adaptor or cord to the right supply voltage (for example, 110V AC in
North America or 230V AC in Europe).
• Do NOT allow anything to rest on the power adaptor or cord and do NOT place the product where anyone can walk on the power adaptor or cord.
• Do NOT use the device if the power adaptor or cord is damaged as it might cause electrocution.
• If the power adaptor or cord is damaged, remove it from the power outlet.
• Do NOT attempt to repair the power adaptor or cord. Contact your local vendor to order a new one.
• Do not use the device outside, and make sure all the connections are indoors. There is a remote risk of electric shock from lightning.
• CAUTION: RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY (on the motherboard) IS REPLACED BY AN
INCORRECT TYPE. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS.
Dispose them at the applicable collection point for the recycling of electrical and electronic equipment. For detailed information about recycling of this product, please contact your local city office, your household waste disposal service or the store where you purchased the product.
• Do NOT obstruct the device ventilation slots, as insufficient airflow may harm your device.
Your product is marked with this symbol, which is known as the WEEE mark. WEEE stands for Waste Electronics and Electrical Equipment. It means that used electrical and electronic products should not be mixed with general waste. Used electrical and electronic equipment should be treated separately.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Contents Overview
Contents Overview
9
NSA210 User’s Guide
Contents Overview
10
NSA210 User’s Guide
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
11
NSA210 User’s Guide
Table of Contents
12
NSA210 User’s Guide
Table of Contents
Part II: Technical Reference ................................................................ 159
NSA210 User’s Guide
13
Table of Contents
14
NSA210 User’s Guide
Table of Contents
NSA210 User’s Guide
15
Table of Contents
16
NSA210 User’s Guide
Table of Contents
NSA210 User’s Guide
17
Table of Contents
18
NSA210 User’s Guide
Table of Contents
NSA210 User’s Guide
19
Table of Contents
20
NSA210 User’s Guide
P
ART
I
User’s Guide
21
22
C
H A P T E R
1
Getting to Know Your NSA
1.1 Overview
This chapter covers the main features and applications of the NSA.
Use the NSA210 to do the following.
• Share files between computers on your network.
• Back up files from your computers to the NSA.
• Use the COPY/SYNC button to copy or synchronize files between the NSA and
USB devices like card readers, MP3 players, mass storage devices, and digital cameras without using a computer.
• Have the NSA handle large file downloads.
• Automatically download files from website feeds for convenient viewing.
• Play the NSA’s video, music and photo files on your computers using the included media client software.
• Play the NSA’s video, music and photo files on hardware-based media clients like the DMA-2500.
• Use the NSA’s website to share files with remote users.
• Use iTunes on your computer to play video and music files stored on the NSA.
• Share printers.
• Automatically upload photo and video files to your FTP server, Flickr and
YouTube accounts.
23
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 1 Getting to Know Your NSA
Figure 1 Example of the NSA in a Home Network
24
NSA
Above is the NSA in a home network. Users back up and share data on the NSA.
The DMA-2500 plays the NSA’s media files on the TV. A USB hard drive provides extra storage space and files are copied directly from the USB mass storage device to the NSA.
Place the NSA behind a firewall and/or IDP (Intrusion Detection and Prevention) device to protect it from attacks from the Internet.
Note: See
for a more detailed list of NSA features and lists of compatible hard drives and USB devices.
Refer to the Quick Start Guide for hardware connections and how to install and remove hard drives from the disk trays.
Note: Turn off and disconnect the NSA before you install or remove the internal hard disk.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 1 Getting to Know Your NSA
1.2 Firmware
Before you can start using your NSA, you have to install the firmware on the hard
disk. Use the NAS Starter Utility to do this. See Chapter 2 on page 29 for more
information on the NAS Starter Utility.
Figure 2 NSA210 Hard Disk Partition
FW
Hard disk
Your NSA210’s firmware is installed in the hard disk.
The firmware includes the features mentioned in Section 3.5.2 on page 72 . You
can use the Package Management screen (
) to install more applications from a web location (specified in the firmware) to your NSA.
1.3 Hard Disk
Your NSA has one internal hard disk bay and one external SATA (eSATA) port. This allows you to connect one internal SATA (Serial Advanced Technology Attachment) hard disk and one eSATA hard disk (optional).
After installing the firmware on the internal hard disk, it is configured as a JBOD volume by default. JBOD stands for Just a Bunch Of Disk and in this storage method, all disk space is used for your data - none is used for backup. If you are not using an eSATA hard disk, JBOD is the only storage method you can use.
If you attach an eSATA (external SATA) hard disk, you can create a RAID 1 volume. RAID 1 allows data recovery in case your hard disk fails. To create a RAID
1 volume on the NSA, you must delete the JBOD volume created by the firmware.
Refer to Section 7.4 on page 173 for the Storage screen where you can create the
RAID 1 volume.
The eSATA hard disk can also be configured as a JBOD or a PC Compatible Volume.
See Section 7.5.2 on page 180 for more information on these storage methods.
Note that both SATA and eSATA hard disks are treated as internal or SATA volumes
in the Storage screen ( Section 7.4 on page 173 ). Any hard disk connected to the
USB port(s) is considered an external or USB volume.
NSA210 User’s Guide
25
Chapter 1 Getting to Know Your NSA
1.4 LEDs
The NSA LEDs (lights) tell you important information.
Figure 3 NSA Front Panel
26
This table describes the NSA’s LEDs.
Table 1 LEDs
LED
POWER Blue
SYSTEM Green
HDD
COLOR STATUS DESCRIPTION
Red
Green
On
Off
The NSA is turned on and receiving power.
The NSA is turned off.
On The NSA has fully started and is operating normally.
Blinking The NSA is starting up or upgrading the firmware.
On
On
The NSA has failed.
The hard disk drive is connected properly to the NSA.
Blinking The NSA is saving data to the hard disk drive.
Red On The hard disk drive has failed and the NSA can no longer detect it.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 1 Getting to Know Your NSA
Table 1 LEDs (continued)
LED
USB eSATA
COPY
COLOR STATUS DESCRIPTION
Green On The hard disk drive is connected properly to the NSA.
Red
Green
Red
Green
Red
Blinking The NSA is saving data to the hard disk drive.
On The hard disk drive has failed and the NSA can no longer detect it.
Off
On
No USB device connected to the USB port.
The hard disk drive is connected properly to the NSA.
Blinking The NSA is saving data to the hard disk drive.
On The hard disk drive has failed and the NSA can no longer detect it.
Off
On
No eSATA hard disk connected to the eSATA port.
A USB device is connected to the NSA.
Blinking The NSA is copying or synchronizing files to or from the
USB device.
On
Off
Copying or synchronizing files to or from the USB device failed.
No USB device is connected.
1.4.1 COPY/SYNC Button
Use the COPY/SYNC button on the front panel to copy or synchronize files between a connected USB device and the NSA. See
for more details on how to configure the copy/sync settings.
1.4.2 RESET Button
Use the RESET button on the rear panel to restore the NSA’s default settings.
Figure 4 The RESET Button
Press
1 Beep
2 Beeps
5 more seconds
Release to Reset
IP Address
Password
Release to
Clear All Settings
• Press the RESET button until you hear one beep (after about two seconds), then release it. You will hear one more beep after you release the button.
This resets the NSA’s IP address and password to the default values.
NSA210 User’s Guide
27
Chapter 1 Getting to Know Your NSA
• Press the RESET button until you hear two beeps. After the second beep, continue pressing the button for five more seconds, then release it. You will hear three quick beeps after you release the button.
This resets the NSA to the factory default configuration. All settings you have configured on the NSA, including IP address, password, user accounts, groups, and so on will be reset to the factory defaults.
The reset process does NOT affect the volume settings, nor data stored on the
NSA.
You should periodically back up your configuration file to your computer (see
Section 15.5 on page 352 for details about managing the NSA’s configuration file).
You could then restore your configuration in the event that you or someone else reset the NSA to the factory defaults.
Note: You should keep the NSA in a secure location in order to prevent unauthorized reset of the device.
28
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
2
NAS Starter Utility
2.1 Overview
The NAS Starter Utility descriptions are divided into the following sections:
•
Starting the NAS Starter Utility on page 30
•
NAS Discovery Screen on page 31
•
Main NAS Starter Utility Screen on page 32
•
Initialization Wizard on page 33
•
Import Files or Folders with zPilot on page 45
•
Add a Network Drive to My Computer on page 46
•
•
Configure Network Setting on page 47
•
NAS Starter Utility Icon Menu (Windows) on page 49
•
NAS Starter Utility Icon Menu (Mac) on page 50
You must use the NAS Starter Utility each time you install a new hard disk on the
NSA. The NAS Starter Utility:
• Discovers and accesses the NSA’s Web Configurator when you connect the NSA for the first time to your computer or your network.
• Initializes the hard disk, which includes formatting it.
• Installs the firmware on the hard disk in your NSA so you can start configuring the NSA.
29
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
The NAS Starter Utility formats the hard disk so that it installs the firmware on one partition and your data on another, as described in the following figure.
Figure 5 NSA210 Hard Disk Partition
Hard disk
Hard disk partition where NSA installs the firmware
Hard disk partition where NSA stores data
Make sure you have a backup of any existing data in the hard disk before installing it in the NSA. The NSA reformats the hard disk so any data is lost.
The Windows version of the NAS Starter Utility works with Windows 2000,
Windows XP, Windows Vista or Windows 7. The Mac OS version works with Mac OS
X 10.4 and later versions.
Note: Refer to the Quick Start Guide for your NSA’s hardware connections and the steps for installing the NAS Starter Utility.
2.2 Starting the NAS Starter Utility
• The NAS Starter Utility broadcasts a request packet when you first run it. Each
NSA has an NAS Starter Utility Agent that always listens and responds to requests from the NAS Starter Utility. The NAS Starter Utility receives the response packet that contains information, such as host name, IP, and so on.
• If you plan to use more than one NSA in your network, configure them with unique server names. This enables you to identify each NSA in the NAS Starter
Utility screens.
• The NAS Starter Utility checks whether a hard disk is initialized or uninitialized.
An initialized hard disk has the NSA firmware installed and can be used readily.
An uninitialized hard disk can be a new hard disk or a used hard disk that has a different format than the NSA. In this case, the NSA has to initialize the hard disk by formatting it and installing the NSA firmware. All previous data is deleted so back up any files in the hard disk before installing it in the NSA.
30
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
2.3 NAS Discovery Screen
Use this screen to view the NSAs in your network. The NSA’s default name is based on it’s model name. See
Section 2.9 on page 47 for how to change it to a
more recognizable one in your network.
Start the NAS Starter Utility (click the icon in your Desktop or in Start >
Programs > ZyXEL > NAS Starter Utility). The first time you open the NAS
Starter Utility the discovery screen appears as follows.
Figure 6 NAS Discovery
NSA210 User’s Guide
31
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 2 NAS Discovery
LABEL
Refresh
Hostname
DESCRIPTION
Click this to refresh the screen. The NAS Starter Utility does not automatically refresh.
This is the server name you configured for the NSA. If you have more than one NSA in your network, it is recommended that you give each one a unique name for identification purposes.
If you have several NSAs connected to your computer/network, hover your mouse over the host name to view the details of each device. A box pops up containing details about the NSA.
Hostname shows the NSA’s configured server name.
IP shows the NSA’s current IP address.
MAC Address shows the NSA’s unique physical hardware address
(MAC).
Model ID shows the NSA’s model name.
Firmware Version shows the version of firmware the NSA is currently using.
Status shows whether the NSA is Online, Unreachable,
Configuring, or Config Failed.
2.4 Main NAS Starter Utility Screen
The main NAS Starter Utility screen displays after you select a NSA in the NSA
Discovery screen. Run the Initialization Wizard is the only link that appears if you have not yet initialized the hard disk.
Figure 7
NAS Starter Utility
Main Screen
32
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 3
NAS Starter Utility
Main Screen
LABEL
Discovery bar
Name
Firmware
IP address
Status
NAS Discovery
DESCRIPTION
Click this to use the NSA Discovery screen ( Section 2.3 on page 31 ) to
find and select the NSA on your network to which you want to connect.
The bar shows the NSA’s in-use and remaining storage capacity.
This is the server name you configured for the NSA. If you have more than one NSA in your network, it is recommended that you give each one a unique name for identification purposes.
This shows the version of firmware the NSA is currently using.
This is the current IP address of the NSA.
This shows whether the NSA is Uninitialized, Online, Unreachable,
Configuring, or Config Failed.
Click this to use the NSA Discovery screen ( Section 2.3 on page 31 ) to
find and select the NSA on your network to which you want to connect.
Click this to launch zPilot to drag and drop files onto the NSA.
Import files or folders with zPilot
Add a network drive to My
Computer
Manage the device
Play Media Files from Home
Screen
Show the directory of the
NSA
Run the
Initialization
Wizard
Configure network setting
This is available in Windows. Click this to add the NSA as a network drive in your computer’s Windows Explorer.
Click this to log into the advanced administration screens. See
3.5 on page 71 for details on the administration screens.
Click this to enjoy your media files though your web browser. See
Section 3.4 on page 56 for details on the Home screen.
This is available in Windows. Click this to open the NSA’s file directory
in Windows Explorer. See Section 2.5.3 on page 44 for details.
Click this to set up the NSA for the first time. See
for details.
Click this to change the NSA network settings such as the NSA’s name,
IP address, subnet mask, default gateway, DNS, or PPPoE. See Section
2.5 Initialization Wizard
Use these screens to set up the NSA for the first time. They will install the NSA’s firmware and configure its basic settings.
Click Run the Initialization Wizard in the main utility screen to display the following screen. You must log in using an admin account. The default
NSA210 User’s Guide
33
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility administrator username is ‘admin’ and the default password is ‘1234’ and click
Next.
Figure 8 Initialization Wizard Welcome
Choose Default Configuration (recommended) or manual configuration. Use the manual option if you need to name the NSA to configure specific network settings.
Click Next.
Figure 9 Initialization Wizard: Wizard Type
34
NSA210 User’s Guide
2.5.1 Default Configuration
1
The NAS Starter Utility checks the Internet connection.
Figure 10 Check Network Connection
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
2
Type a new administrator password (and retype it to confirm). If you do not want to change the administrator password, you can leave the fields blank and just click
Next.
Figure 11 Change Admin Password
NSA210 User’s Guide
35
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
3
Specify usernames and passwords for the individuals you want to be able to access the NSA.
Figure 12 Create User Accounts
4
Check your settings. If they are OK, click Next. Otherwise click Back. If you want to change anything other than the user accounts, keep clicking Back until you can change the wizard type to manual.
Figure 13 Confirm Settings
36
NSA210 User’s Guide
5
Wait while the NAS Starter Utility configures the NSA.
Figure 14 Setting the NAS
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
After the NAS Starter Utility finishes configuring the NSA, you can click Show the
directory of the NAS to see the NSA’s shares (see
click Finish to return to the main NAS Starter Utility screen (see
Figure 15 Setting the NAS
NSA210 User’s Guide
37
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
2.5.2 Manual Configuration
1
Set up the NSA’s basic network configuration first.
Figure 16 Setup Network
38
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 4 NAS Starter Utility > Config
LABEL
Get IP automatically from DHCP server
Assign IP
Manually
DESCRIPTION
Select this if the NSA is automatically assigned an IP address from the
ISP or a DHCP server in your network.
Select this if you want to assign the NSA a fixed IP address, subnet mask and default gateway.
Use DNS server from DHCP server
Assign DNS server manually
Note: Do not configure an IP address that is already in use in your network. This results to a network IP address conflict and makes the NSA inaccessible.
Domain Name System (DNS) is for mapping a domain name to its corresponding IP address and vice versa. Select this if the NSA is automatically given DNS information from the ISP or a DHCP server in your network.
If you were given specific IP address(es) of the DNS server(s), select this and enter the primary and secondary DNS in the corresponding fields.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
2
If your Internet connection requires you to enter a user name and password to connect to the Internet, enter them here and click Next. If you do not need to enter a user name and password to connect to the Internet, click Skip.
Figure 17 PPPoE
3
The NAS Starter Utility checks the Internet connection.
Figure 18 Check Network Connection
NSA210 User’s Guide
39
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
4
Type a new administrator password (and retype it to confirm) and click Next. If you do not want to change the administrator password, you can leave the fields blank and just click Next.
Figure 19 Change Admin Password
5
Specify a name to uniquely identify the NSA on your network. Choose the time zone of your location. This sets the time difference between your time zone and
Greenwich Mean Time (GMT).
Figure 20 Create User Accounts
40
NSA210 User’s Guide
6
Select how to configure the hard disks.
Figure 21 Create User Accounts
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
With only one hard disk installed, just click Next. If you have two hard disks installed choose one of the following:
• RAID 1: Use this to mirror all data on one disk to the other disk to protect against data loss.
• Individual Disks: Use this if you want maximum storage capacity and/or you have other means of protecting your data. This creates two JBOD volumes
(with one disk in each), a failure of one disk (volume) should not affect the other volume (disk).
• JBOD: Use this if you want maximum storage capacity and/or you have other means of protecting your data. This combines the two physical disks into a single virtual one, so they appear as a single large disk.
• RAID 0: Use this if you want maximum speed for your disks, and/or you have other means of protecting your data. RAID 0 has the fastest read and write performance but if one disk fails you lose all your data from both disks.
NSA210 User’s Guide
41
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
7
This screen is available in Windows and lists the shares the NAS Starter Utility creates on the NSA by default. Select the ones you want to use as network drives in Windows Explorer.
Figure 22 Connect Network Drives
8
Specify usernames and passwords for the individuals you want to be able to access the NSA and click Next.
Figure 23 Create User Accounts
42
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
9
If the settings are OK, click Next. Otherwise click Back. If you want to change anything other than the user accounts, keep clicking Back until you can change the wizard type to manual.
Figure 24 Confirm Settings
10
Wait while the NAS Starter Utility configures the NSA.
Figure 25 Setting the NAS
After the NAS Starter Utility finishes configuring the NSA, you can click Show the
directory of the NAS to see the NSA’s shares (see
NSA210 User’s Guide
43
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility click Finish to return to the main NAS Starter Utility screen (see
Figure 26 Setting the NAS
2.5.3 Directory of the NAS
Clear the Guest option and enter the administrator user name and password and click Login to be able to view the NSA’s shares to which you have access.
Otherwise select Guest and click Login to be able to view the NSA’s public shares.
Figure 27 Login
44
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
The utility opens the NSA’s directory in Windows Explorer.
Figure 28 Directory
2.6 Import Files or Folders with zPilot
In the main NAS Starter Utility screen click Import files or folders with zPilot to be able to drag and drop files from your computer to the NSA.
Enter the administrator user name and password and click Login.
Figure 29 Login
The zPilot icon displays.
Figure 30 zPilot
Drag files onto the zPilot icon to move them to the NSA. zPilot automatically sorts music, photo, and video files into the Music, Photo, and Video folders. zPilot can automatically sort the types of media files listed in
for the subtitles). Other types of files go to the Public folder. For folders of files
NSA210 User’s Guide
45
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility you are prompted to choose the target destination. The zPilot icon shows the transfer rate.
Figure 31 zPilot Showing Transfer Rate
Double-click the zPilot icon to display the NAS Starter Utility screen with status details about the file transfers. Click the “x” button next to a file entry to stop transferring the file. Click
Clean Up
to clear completed transfers from the list.
Figure 32 zPilot Showing Transfer Rate
2.7 Add a Network Drive to My Computer
This is available in Windows. In the main NAS Starter Utility screen click Add a
network drive to My Computer to add the NSA as a network drive in your computer’s Windows Explorer.
Clear the Guest option and enter the administrator user name and password and click Login to be able to add the NSA’s shares to which you have access as network drives. Otherwise select Guest and click Login to be able to add the
NSA’s public shares as network drives.
Figure 33 Login
46
Select a share on the NSA and the drive letter on your computer to which you want to map it. The shares that each user can select to map depends on the user’s
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility permissions. For example, if share1 is private to user1, then only user1 is allowed to map share1. The table displays the NSA shares that are already mapped to drive letters on your computer. After you click OK you can see the new drive in
Windows Explorer (My Computer) where you can access and use it like your computer’s other drives.
Figure 34 Network Drive Mapping
2.8 Manage the Device
In the main NAS Starter Utility screen click Manage the Device to log into the
NSA’s administration screens where you can manage the NSA.
Enter the administrator user name and password and click Login.
Figure 35 Login
See Section 3.5 on page 71 for more on the administration screens.
2.9 Configure Network Setting
Use these screens to change the NSA network settings such as the NSA’s name, IP address, subnet mask, default gateway, DNS, or PPPoE.
NSA210 User’s Guide
47
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
Click Configure network setting in the main utility screen to display the following screen.
Figure 36 NAS Starter Utility > Configure network setting
48
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 5 NAS Starter Utility > Config
LABEL
NAS Name
Get IP automatically from DHCP server
Assign IP
Manually
DESCRIPTION
Specify a name to uniquely identify the NSA on your network. You can enter up to 15 alphanumeric characters with minus signs allowed but not as the last character. The name must begin with an alphabetic character (a-z) and is case sensitive.
Select this if the NSA is automatically assigned an IP address from the
ISP or a DHCP server in your network.
Select this if you want to assign the NSA a fixed IP address, subnet mask and default gateway.
Use DNS server from DHCP server
Assign DNS server manually
PPPoE
Note: Do not configure an IP address that is already in use in your network. This results to a network IP address conflict and makes the NSA inaccessible.
Domain Name System (DNS) is for mapping a domain name to its corresponding IP address and vice versa. Select this if the NSA is automatically given DNS information from the ISP or a DHCP server in your network.
If you were given specific IP address(es) of the DNS server(s), select this and enter the primary and secondary DNS in the corresponding fields.
Click this if your Internet connection requires you to enter a user name and password to connect to the Internet.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
If your Internet connection requires you to enter a user name and password to connect to the Internet, select Enable PPPoE Connection and enter your user name and password.
Figure 37 PPPoE
2.10 NAS Starter Utility Icon Menu (Windows)
To open the NSU Starter Utility icon’s menu on a Windows computer, right-click the NSU system tray icon. See
Section 2.6 on page 45 for details about the zPilot.
Figure 38 Windows NSU Icon Menu
• If the NAS Starter Utility can connect to the NSA to which you last connected in the NAS Starter Utility, its hostname appears in the first row.
• Show Main Screen displays the main NAS Starter Utility screen. This option is available when the main screen is not displayed.
• Show File Importer Status displays the NAS Starter Utility file importer status screen. This is available when the NAS Starter Utility can connect to the NSA, you have logged into the zPilot, and the NAS Starter Utility main screen and file importer status screens are not displayed.
• Hide NSA Starter Utility hides the NAS Starter Utility screen but does not close the utility. This option is available when the NAS Starter Utility is displayed.
NSA210 User’s Guide
49
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
• Enable zPilot when system starts up has your computer automatically start the zPilot file transfer tool at startup. This is available when the NAS Starter
Utility can connect to the NSA.
• zPilot stays on top keeps the zPilot icon on top of any other open screens so it is easy to locate. This is available when the NAS Starter Utility can connect to the NSA and you have previously logged into the zPilot. You also have to open the zPilot to have it stay on top.
• About displays the version of the NAS Starter Utility.
• Exit closes the NAS Starter Utility, including the zPilot.
2.11 NAS Starter Utility Icon Menu (Mac)
To open the NSU Starter Utility icon’s menu on a Mac, hold down [CTRL] and click the NSU dock icon. See
Section 2.6 on page 45 for details about the zPilot.
Figure 39 Mac NSU Icon Menu
50
• If the NAS Starter Utility can connect to the NSA to which you last connected in the NAS Starter Utility, its hostname appears in the first row.
• Show Main Screen displays the main NAS Starter Utility screen. This option is available when the main screen is not displayed.
• Hide NSA Starter Utility hides the NAS Starter Utility screen but does not close the utility. This option is available when the NAS Starter Utility is displayed.
• zPilot stays on top keeps the zPilot icon on top of any other open screens so it is easy to locate. This is available when the NAS Starter Utility can connect to the NSA and you have previously logged into the zPilot. You need to exit the
NAS Starter Utility, restart it, and open the zPilot to have it stay on top.
• About displays the version of the NAS Starter Utility.
• Options offers the standard Keep in Dock, Open at Login, and Show in
Finder Mac functions.
• Hide hides the NAS Starter Utility screen but does not close the utility. This option is available when the NAS Starter Utility is displayed.
• Quit closes the NAS Starter Utility, including the zPilot.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
NSA210 User’s Guide
51
Chapter 2 NAS Starter Utility
52
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
3
Web Configurator Basics
3.1 Overview
This chapter describes how to access the NSA Web Configurator and provides an overview of its screens.
The Web Configurator is an HTML-based management interface that allows easy
NSA setup and management using an Internet browser.
Use Internet Explorer 6.0, Mozilla Firefox 2.00, or Safari 4.04 or later versions of these
browsers. The recommended screen resolution is 1024 by 768 pixels or higher.
In order to use the Web Configurator you need to allow:
• Web browser pop-up windows from your device. Web pop-up blocking is enabled by default in Windows XP SP (Service Pack) 2.
• JavaScript (enabled by default).
3.2 Accessing the NSA Web Configurator
Make sure your NSA is properly connected and that your computer is in the same subnet as the NSA (refer to the Quick Start Guide or the appendices).
3.2.1 Access the NSA Via NAS Starter Utility
If you don’t know the IP address of the NSA, use the NAS Starter Utility’s Play
Media Files from Home Screen link to find it. Refer to the Quick Start Guide for
53
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
how to install and run the NAS Starter Utility. See Chapter 2 on page 29 for more
information on the NAS Starter Utility.
Figure 40 NAS Starter Utility Main Screen
3.2.2 Web Browser Access
Configure the server name of your NSA using the Network Configuration screen
(
Section 2.9 on page 47 ) of the NAS Starter Utility. Open your browser and type in
the server name of the NSA (“nsa210” by default).
Figure 41 NSA URL
3.3 Login
The default username and password are ‘admin’ and ‘1234’ respectively. Enter your username and password. If you use the option to stay logged in for two weeks (assuming you do not log out), make sure you keep your computer secure.
54
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Then click Login. See
for how to create other user accounts.
Figure 42 NSA Login Screen
If you have not done so yet, you should see a screen asking you to change your password (highly recommended) as shown next. Type a new password (and retype it to confirm) and click Apply or click Ignore.
Figure 43 Change Password Screen
NSA210 User’s Guide
55
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.4 Home Screens
All users (including the administrator) first see the Home screen after logging in.
Figure 44 Home
56
Note: If you did not select the option to stay logged in for two weeks when you logged in, the Web Configurator management session automatically times out if it is left idle for 15 minutes. Simply log back into the NSA if this happens to you.
The main Home screen displays icons for the various features you can access.
Table 6 Main Home Screen Icons
ICON DESCRIPTION
Use Music, Photo, and Video to play your music, picture, and video files.
Use Favorite to create and edit playlists.
Use File Browser to see your files in a tree-folder structure.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Table 6 Main Home Screen Icons (continued)
ICON DESCRIPTION
Administrators can use Application Zone to install, access, and manage the NSA’s applications.
Use System to edit general system settings or log into the administrator advanced configuration screens.
Note: For Windows computers your browser may need VLC and Windows Media
Player installed to play music and video files. For Mac your browser may need
VLC and QuickTime. To get the VLC plugins, you have to download and install
VLC (use the .exe file) and select the Mozilla plugin option. To display your photos as a 3-D wall for quick browsing, install the CoolIris plugin.
The icons at the top-right of the screen are visible from most screens. Use them to navigate between the screens and menus. The following table describes the icons.
Table 7 Global Home Labels and Icons
LABEL/ICON
Home
Help
Logout
DESCRIPTION
Click this to return to the Home screen.
Click this to open a web help page specific to the screen you are currently configuring.
Click this at any time to exit the Web Configurator.
NSA210 User’s Guide
57
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Here are some Home screen descriptions. A music screen is shown here as an example. Other screens work in a similar way.
Figure 45 Music Screen
A
B
C
D
This table describes common labels in the Home media screens. Not every item displays in every screen.
Table 8 Home Media Screens
LABEL
A
B
C
DESCRIPTION
Click a letter to go to the first item starting with that letter.
View files. Double-click an item to play it.
Shows which page is displaying and the total number of pages of entries.
Click an arrow or type a number to go to another page of entries.
58
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Table 8 Home Media Screens
LABEL
D
DESCRIPTION
Select the sorting criteria:
Thumbnail
List
Play
Delete
Rename
Artist - Sort music by artist.
All - All of the menu’s files display here.
Genre - Sort music by category.
Folder - List the folders containing music files.
Album - List the identified music albums.
Current Playlist - Show the playing and queued songs.
The NSA categorizes files into genres and albums according to the information stored in your files. Files may not appear in the proper folders if they have missing, incorrect or incomplete information.
Click this to view the files as thumbnails.
Click this to view the files as a list.
Click this to play the currently selected file. You can also double-click a file to play it.
Select an item and click Delete to remove it.
Select an item and click Rename to change its name.
Note: When you change a file name, make sure you keep the file extension unchanged.
Add to
Current
Playlist
Click this to add the selected music file to the currently playing playlist.
Add to Playlist Click this to add the selected music file to a playlist.
Search Click this to look for a file or folder by name.
Refresh
Now Playing
Click this to update the display in the screen.
This link is available when a song is playing. Click it to see details about the song that is currently playing.
3.4.1 Now Playing (Music)
A Now Playing link displays when a song is playing. Click it to display a panel like the following. This screen displays the name of the current song and it’s play progress and lets you control the playback.
Figure 46 Now Playing
NSA210 User’s Guide
59
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.4.2 Video Playback
While playing a video through the Web Configurator Home screens, besides the usual reverse, play, pause, stop, full screen, and volume options, Windows computers also display an option to switch between VLC Player and Windows
Media Player (WMP). See the button circled below. If your video is not playing back properly you can try using this option to change to the other media player.
Figure 47 Video Playback
60
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.4.3 Exif and Google Maps (Photos)
Click a photo’s EXIF button to display or hide the photo’s Exchangeable image file format (Exif) data.
Figure 48 Exif Information
If a photo’s Exif data includes GPS location data, click the latitude or longitude link to display the location in Google Maps. Click Clear to delete the markers of other photos and only display the current photo’s marker.
Figure 49 Google Maps
NSA210 User’s Guide
61
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.4.4 Slideshow and CoolIris (Photos)
In a Photo menu click the SlideShow button to display the menu’s files as a slideshow. Move your cursor over the slideshow’s screen to display full screen, previous, pause, and next buttons for controlling the slideshow.
Figure 50 Slideshow
When the CoolIris plugin is installed in your browser, click the Launch CoolIris button to display your photos as a 3-D wall for quick browsing.
3.4.5 Favorite
Use the Favorite menu to manage your playlists.
3.4.5.1 Shared Playlist
Use Favorite > Shared Playlist to view and play playlists that you created externally (in iTunes, Windows Media Player, VLC media player, or Winamp for example) and saved to the NSA. When using zPilot to move files to the NSA, playlists are automatically put into the music share.
62
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.4.5.2 My Favorite
Use Favorite > My Favorite to create, edit, and play playlists. These playlists are specific to the NSA and cannot be used in external music players.
Figure 51 Favorite > My Favorite
This table describes labels in this menu.
Table 9 Favorite > My Favorite
LABEL
New
Edit
Delete All
DESCRIPTION
Click this to create a new playlist.
Double-click a playlist or select it and click Edit to go to a screen where you can remove songs from the playlist.
Within a playlist click Delete All to remove all of the playlist’s songs.
3.4.6 File Browser
Click File Browser to open the following screen. Use the file browsing screens to play, open, upload, and download files. A share is a set of user access permissions for a specific folder on a volume (gives someone access to a folder). It is equivalent to the Windows concept of a shared folder, but the access rights are independent of the folder (you configure the share and the folder separately). You
NSA210 User’s Guide
63
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics can map a share to a network drive for easy and familiar file transfer for Windows users.
• A folder icon with a hand indicates a share.
• The administrator owns and manages the public shares.
• Double-click a media file to open it. Double-click other types of files to be able to save them.
• Click to the right of a file or folder name to select it.
• Use the [SHIFT] key to select a range of entries. Hold down the [CTRL] key to select multiple individual entries.
• Drag and drop files to open a screen that lets you choose whether to copy or move them.
• You can upload files of up to 2 GB in size.
• You can download individual files of up to 4 GB in size with Mozilla Firefox and
Internet Explorer 7 and later or up to 2 GB in size with Internet Explorer 6.
Figure 52 File Browser
64
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 10 File Browser
LABEL
Up
Name
Size
DESCRIPTION
Click this to go to the next higher layer in the share’s folder tree.
This column identifies the names of folders and files in the share. Click a file’s file name to open the file or save it to your computer. Click a folder’s name to display the folder’s contents.
This column displays a file’s size in bytes.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Table 10 File Browser (continued)
LABEL
Last Modified
Create New Folder
DESCRIPTION
This column displays the last time the file or folder was changed
(in year-month-day hour:minute:second format).
Click this to open the following screen where you can create a new folder within the share.
Configure Share
Upload
Specify a name to identify the folder. See Section 3.4.7 on page
for more information on folder names. Click Apply to create a folder or click Cancel to exit this screen.
Select a share and click this link to open a screen where you can see and configure share management details.
Click this to open the following screen where you can add files to the share.
Download
Restore
Use the Browse button to locate your file/s and click Apply to upload the file. Click Cancel to close this screen.
Note: Do not refresh the screen while an upload is going on.
Select a file and click this to save the file to your computer.
Note: Do not refresh the screen while a download is going on.
When you are in a recycle bin folder, select a folder or file and click this to restore it.
NSA210 User’s Guide
65
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.4.6.1 Configure Share Screen
In the File Browser screen, select a share and click Configure Share to open the following screen where you can see and configure share management details.
Figure 53 File Browser > Configure Share
66
The following table describes the labels in the this screen.
Table 11 File Browser > Configure Share
LABEL
Share Name
Volume
Make this share owned by
Enable This
Share
Enable Recycle
Bin
Publish this share to Media
Server
Publish this share to Web
DESCRIPTION
Configure a name to identify this share. Type a share name from 1 to
239 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example) ASCII characters. The name cannot be the same as another existing local share. See
Section 3.4.7 on page 67 for more information on share
names. This is not configurable for the NSA’s default admin, music, photo, public, and video shares.
This shows the volume the share is on. It is read-only.
Select the administrator or user account that is to own (manage) this share. The share owner controls access rights to the share. This is not configurable for the NSA’s default admin and public shares.
Select this option to allow users to access this share. When this option is not selected, you cannot see and access this share.
Select this option to keep deleted items in a recycle bin. When you delete an item, a recycle folder is created within the share, and the deleted item is stored in the recycle bin. Later if you want to retrieve a deleted item, you can select the item from the recycle folder and move/copy the item to another share.
Select this option to make the share’s files available to media clients.
You can also select whether to share music, photo, and video files.
Select this option to let people use a web browser to access this share’s files without logging into the Home screens.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Table 11 File Browser > Configure Share (continued)
LABEL
Share Access
DESCRIPTION
Select who can access the files in the share and how much access they are to be given. If you publish the share to the media server or the web, all users will have at least read-only access to the share, regardless of what you configure here.
Select Keep it private to owner to allow only the share owner to read files in the share, delete files in the share and save files to the share.
Select Make it public to allow anyone (with or without a user account on the NSA) to read files in the share, delete files in the share and save files to the share.
Apply
Cancel
Select Advanced to select which individual users can read the share’s files, which users can delete the share’s files, and which users are blocked from doing either.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
3.4.7 Share and Folder Names
The name can only contain the following characters:
• Alphanumeric (A-z, 0-9) and Unicode.
The NSA allows FTP access to shares, folders or files with names encoded in the
UTF-8 (8-bit UCS/Unicode Transformation Format) format. So your FTP client must support UTF-8 in order to access shares, folders or files on the NSA with
Unicode names.
• Spaces
• _ [underscores]
• . [periods]
• - [dashes]
Other limitations include:
• All leading and trailing spaces are removed automatically.
• Multiple spaces within names are converted to a single space.
• Share names must be unique (they cannot be the same as other share names).
• The NSA creates automatic volume names for external (USB) disk volumes.
These are a type of share, so the share name you configure cannot conflict with the external (USB) disk volume names. “ExtVol1” or “ExtVol2” are examples of external (USB) disk volume names.
• Folder names must be unique (they cannot be the same as other folder names).
• The minimum character length of a name is one character, that is a name cannot be blank.
• The maximum character length of share name is 239 characters.
NSA210 User’s Guide
67
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
• Unicode is supported for share names, although your FTP client must support
UTF-8. Full support should be available in all Windows versions after Windows
2000.
3.4.8 Application Zone
Administrators can click Application Zone to go to a screen where you can enable or disable various applications for file sharing and downloading.
Figure 54 Application Zone
68
The following table describes the labels in the this screen.
Table 12 Application Zone
LABEL
Name
Description
Management
Page
Enable
DESCRIPTION
This is the name of the application.
This is a brief description of the application. See
for more information.
Click this link to go the application’s management page where you can
configure settings for it. See Chapter 9 on page 197 for more
information.
Select a disabled application and click this to turn on the application.
Some applications are always enabled and cannot be disabled.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Table 12 Application Zone (continued)
LABEL
Disable
Pause
Resume
DESCRIPTION
Select an enabled application and click this to turn off the application.
Select the Flickr or Youtube Uploadr entry and click this to cancel all uploading. Some applications are always enabled and cannot be disabled.
Select the Flickr or Youtube Uploadr entry and click this to pause current uploading. Resume will resume current uploading.
Select the Flickr or Youtube Uploadr entry and click this to resume current uploading.
3.4.9 System Settings
Click System > Settings to open the following screen. Use this screen to change general settings and an account password.
Figure 55 System > Settings
NSA210 User’s Guide
69
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 13 System > Settings
LABEL
Player
DESCRIPTION
For Windows computers your browser may need VLC and
Windows Media Player installed to play music and video files. For
Mac your browser may need VLC and QuickTime.
Double Click Behavior
Setting
Slide Effect
Slide Interval
Video Playback
Account Name
Old Password
New Password
Password (Confirm)
Language
Go to system administration page
Apply
Reset
Cancel
This field shows whether or not the plugins are installed. If you need to install either, click the related link.
To get the VLC plugins, you have to download and install VLC
(use the .exe file) and select the Mozilla plugin option.
Select Replace current playlist and start to play to have double clicking a song cause the NSA to immediately stop any currently playing song and start playing the double-clicked song.
Select Append to current playlist to have double clicking a song add a song to the end of the current playlist.
Enable the Ken Burns effect to have the NSA automatically pan and zoom photos in slideshows. Disable it to display photos in slideshows normally.
Select how long to display each image in a slideshow before changing to the next.
Select Play Next to play the rest of the video files in a folder. So for example, a folder has video files 1~10 and you play video 3.
When video 3 finishes the device continues playing the rest of the videos in the folder (4~10). It does not loop back and play videos 1 and 2.
Type the user name of the account for which you want to change the password.
Type the user’s current password.
Create a new password for the user. You can type from one to 14 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example) ASCII characters.
You must type the exact same password that you just typed in the above field.
Select the Web Configurator language from the drop-down list box.
This link appears when you are logged in as the administrator.
Click it to open the advanced administration screens. See
for more on the advanced administration screens.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to refresh the screen.
Click this to exit the screen without saving your changes.
70
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.5 Administration Screens
The System > Administration link displays when you log in as the administrator.
Click System > Administration in the Home screen to open the advanced administration screens.
The Status screen is the first advanced administration screen that displays.
Figure 56 Status
1
2
3
4
3.5.1 Global Administration Icons
The icons and language label at the top-right of the screen (
1
) are visible from most of the administration screens. The following table describes the ‘global’ icons and labels.
Table 14 Global Labels and Icons
LABEL/ICON DESCRIPTION
Language
Help
About
Home
Logout
Select the Web Configurator language from the drop-down list box.
Click this to open web help specific to the screen you are in.
Click this to view the model name, firmware version and copyright.
Click this to return to the Home screens.
Click this at any time to exit the Web Configurator. This is the same as clicking the Logout link at the bottom of the navigation panel.
NSA210 User’s Guide
71
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.5.2 Navigation Panel
The navigation panel on the left of the Web Configurator screen (
2
) contains screen links. Click a link to display sub-links. There are no sub-links for the Status screen. Certain screens also contain hyper links that allow you to jump to another screen.
The following table describes the navigation panel screens.
Table 15 Screens Summary
LINK
Status
SCREEN
System
Setting
Storage
Network
Server Name
Date & Time
Volume
TCP/IP
UPnP Port
Mapping
PPPoE
FUNCTION
This screen shows system information, the status of the volumes, and the users who are currently using the NSA.
Specify the NSA’s server name and workgroup name.
Chose a time zone and/or allow the NSA to synchronize with a time server.
View volume and disk information and create and edit volumes. A volume is a storage area that can span one or more internal disks or a single external (USB) disk.
Assign the NSA a dynamic or static IP address and DNS information.
Configure your Internet gateway to allow access from the WAN
(Internet) to services on the NSA.
Configure PPPoE settings for a direct Internet connection.
72
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Table 15 Screens Summary (continued)
LINK SCREEN
Applications FTP Server
FUNCTION
Enable FTP file transfer to/from the NSA, set the number of FTP connections allowed, an FTP idle timeout, and the character set.
Sharing
Maintenance
Media Server Enable or disable the sharing of media files and select which shares to share.
Have the NSA handle large file downloads.
Download
Service
Web Publishing Let people use a web browser to access files in shares without logging into the Home screens.
Broadcatching Subscribe the NSA to feeds to download frequently updated digital content like TV programs, radio talk shows, Podcasts (audio files), YouTube videos, or even
BitTorrents.
Print Server
Copy/Sync
Button
Package
View and manage the NSA’s list of printers and print jobs.
Copy or synchronize files between a USB device and the
NSA.
Set up more useful applications in your NSA. The NSA can download multiple packages/files at once and automatically goes through all the installation steps.
Auto Upload -
Flickr/YouTube
Auto Upload -
FTP Uploadr
Users
Upload files in selected shares to your Flickr and/or
YouTube accounts.
Upload files in selected shares to FTP servers.
Groups
Shares
Power
Log
View, create and edit administrator and user accounts to let people use the NSA.
View, create and edit groups. Groups allow you to organize users into specific groups. You can create shares accessible only by the group members.
View, create and edit shares. Shares are shared folders to which you can allow specific users read/write access rights.
Configure power saving settings for the NSA and have the NSA turn itself off and on or reboot according to the schedules you configure.
View the NSA’s logs and configure how you want to receive the log reports.
Logout
Configuration
SSL
FW Upgrade
Shutdown
Back up and/or restore the NSA configuration file.
Configure HTTPS and the NSA’s SSL certificate.
Upload/upgrade new firmware to your NSA.
Restart the NSA or shut it down.
Click this to exit the Web Configurator. This is recommended to prevent unauthorized administrator access to the NSA.
NSA210 User’s Guide
73
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
3.5.3 Main Window
The main window
(
3
)
shows the screen you select in the navigation panel. It is discussed in the rest of this document.
3.5.4 Status Messages
The message text box at the bottom of the screen
(
4
)
displays status messages as you configure the NSA.
3.5.5 Common Screen Icons
The following table explains some icons that appear in several configuration screens.
Table 16 Common Configuration Screen Icons
ICON DESCRIPTION
Edit
Click this to go to a screen where you can change the configuration settings of an entry.
Delete
Click this to delete an entry from the list.
Edit
Click this to jump to related item’s configuration screen.
Refresh
Click this to refresh the data for the field or value with which it is associated.
User
See the chapter on user accounts for detailed information on variants of this icon.
Share
See the chapter on shares for detailed information on variants of this icon.
Healthy
This represents a healthy volume.
Degraded
This represents a degraded RAID 1 volume. Replace the faulty disk. If the replacement disk does not contain any partition, the NSA automatically restores the volume. If the replacement disk already contains a volume, you need to delete the volume and then click the Repair icon to fix the degraded
RAID volume.
74
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
Table 16 Common Configuration Screen Icons (continued)
ICON DESCRIPTION
Down
This represents a down volume.
Scan Disk
Click this to scan a hard disk for file system errors.
Eject
Click this before you remove an external hard drive so that you do not lose data that is being transferred to or from that hard drive.
Locate
Click this to cause the LED on the external storage device to blink.
Repair
If you replace a faulty disk with a disk that contains a volume, you need to delete the volume and then click this to fix the degraded RAID volume.
3.5.6 Session Example (Windows)
Open Windows Explorer and type two back slashes followed by the NSA name or
IP address. Initially you can only read and write to the Public, Video, Music, and
Photo folders until you create other shares on the NSA. This session is then displayed as shown in the following figure.
Session Example (Windows)
NSA210 User’s Guide
75
Chapter 3 Web Configurator Basics
76
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
4
Tutorials
4.1 Overview
This chapter provides tutorials that show how to use the NSA.
•
Windows 7 Network , see page 77
•
Windows 7 Network Map , see page 81
•
Playing Media Files in Windows 7
, see
•
Windows 7 Devices and Printers , see page 83
•
, see
•
Deleting a Volume , see page 92
•
, see
•
Download Service Tutorial , see page 103
•
Broadcatching Tutorial , see page 119
•
Copy and Flickr Auto Upload Tutorial , see page 124
•
, see
•
Web Configurator’s Security Sessions , see page 130
•
Using FTPES to Connect to the NSA , see page 142
•
, see
•
How to Use BackupPlanner , see page 146
4.2 Windows 7 Network
To see your NSA in a Windows 7 home or work network:
77
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
1
Click Start > Control Panel. Set View by to Category and click Network and
Internet.
2
Click View network computers and devices.
78
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
The NSA icon displays twice because the NSA is both a media server and a storage device. Double-click either NSA icon to open the Web Configurator login screen.
4.2.1 If the NSA Icon Does Not Display
The network containing the NSA must be set as a home or work network in order for the NSA icons to display. If the network containing the NSA displays as
“Public”:
1
Click Network and Sharing Center and then the network’s link (circled in the figure).
NSA210 User’s Guide
79
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
Use the Set Network Location screen to set the network’s location to home or work.
4.2.2 NSA Icon Right-click Options
Right-click the NSA’s icon to see these options:
• Install/Uninstall: Click Install to add the NSA as a device in your computer.
After you install the NSA you can see it in the computer’s list of devices (see
Section 4.5 on page 83 . Click Uninstall to remove the NSA from the list of
devices installed in your computer.
• View device web page opens the Web Configurator login screen.
• Create shortcut adds a desktop shortcut to the Web Configurator login screen.
80
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
• Properties opens a window of NSA details and troubleshooting information.
• Manufacturer identifies the company that produced the NSA.
• Model identifies the NSA model.
•
Model number
identifies the NSA model number.
• Device webpage shows the IP address for accessing the Web Configurator.
• Serial number is unavailable because the NSA does not have one.
• MAC address is the NSA’s unique physical hardware address (MAC). You need the MAC address to register the product at myZyXEL.com. Customer support may also request it for troubleshooting purposes.
• Unique identifier is a unique UPnP ID that the NSA generated.
• IP address is the NSA’s IP address. It is also the IP address for accessing the
Web Configurator.
4.3 Windows 7 Network Map
To see your NSA in a Windows 7 home or work network map:
NSA210 User’s Guide
81
Chapter 4 Tutorials
1
Click Start > Control Panel > View network status and tasks (or Network
and Sharing Center if you view the Control Panel by icons).
82
2
Click See full map (1 in the figure).
The network containing the NSA must be set as a home or work network in order to use the full map feature. If the network containing the NSA displays as “Public”, click the network’s link (2 in the figure, although it is already set to home here) and use the Set Network Location screen to set the network’s location to home
1
2
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Double-click the NSA’s icon to open the Web Configurator login screen. See
Section 4.2.2 on page 80 for the NSA icon’s right-click options.
4.4 Playing Media Files in Windows 7
In Windows 7, the NSA automatically displays as a library in Windows Media
Player.
Figure 57 NSA in Windows Media Player
4.5 Windows 7 Devices and Printers
After you use the NSA’s network icon’s install option you can manage the NSA from the Windows 7 Devices and Printers folder.
Click Start > Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers.
Select the NSA icon to display information about the NSA. Double-click the NSA
NSA210 User’s Guide
83
Chapter 4 Tutorials
icon to open a properties window (see page 81
). Right-click the icon to display these options:
84
• Create shortcut has Windows make a desktop shortcut to this screen.
• Troubleshoot opens Windows’ device troubleshooting wizard.
• Remove device removes the NSA from the Windows 7 Devices and Printers folder.
• Properties opens a window of NSA details and troubleshooting information
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.5.1 Windows 7 Desktop Shortcut
This is the NSA’s desktop shortcut. Double-click it to open a properties window
(see
page 81 ). Right-click it to display the options shown here.
1
About the right-click options:
• Open file location takes you to the Windows 7 Devices and Printers folder.
• Restore previous versions is the Windows 7 option for restoring a file or folder. It does not apply to this shortcut.
• Send to give you options for copying the shortcut to another location.
• Cut removes this shortcut so you can paste it somewhere else.
• Copy copies the shortcut so you can paste it somewhere else.
• Create shortcut has Windows make a desktop shortcut to this icon.
• Delete sends the shortcut to the recycle bin.
• Rename lets you change the name of the shortcut.
• Troubleshoot opens Windows’ device troubleshooting wizard.
• Remove device removes the NSA from the Windows 7 Devices and Printers folder.
• Properties opens a window of details about the shortcut.
NSA210 User’s Guide
85
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.6 Creating a Volume
This section shows you how to create a volume on your NSA.
Creating a volume deletes all existing data in the SATA or eSATA hard disk. Make sure you have a backup of your existing data before following the steps in this section.
Your NSA has a single bay for a SATA (Serial Advanced Technology Attachment) hard disk. The firmware installed during hard disk initialization (
29 ) automatically creates a JBOD volume on your SATA hard disk. JBOD is the
default storage method if you are using a single hard disk for your NSA.
This JBOD volume shows up in the Storage > Volume screen ( Section 7.4 on page 173 ) as follows.
When you attach an eSATA hard disk to your NSA, you can configure this volume as: 1) a backup to your SATA hard disk (RAID 1); or 2) as a separate storage drive (either another JBOD or a PC Compatible Volume).
4.6.1 Creating a RAID 1 Volume
This storage method allows recovery of data if your hard disk fails. To create a
RAID 1 volume, you must connect an eSATA hard disk to your NSA. There are two ways to create a RAID 1 volume:
• Click the Migrate button - This is a quick way to create a RAID 1 volume. Use this to automatically synchronize data in the internal hard disk to the eSATA hard disk.
• Click the Create a SATA volume button - Use this if there are no existing volumes in your NSA.
86
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.6.2 Migrate Button
Do the following steps to create a RAID 1 volume.
1
Once you attach the eSATA hard disk to the NSA, the Storage > Volume screen shows the Migrate button.
2
Click the
Migrate
button and you can see the following progress bar. Wait for up to
10 minutes for the RAID 1 volume to be created.
4.6.3 Create a SATA Volume Button
If you do not have an existing volume in the Storage > Volume screen, do the following steps to create a RAID 1 volume.
1
In the Storage > Volume screen, click Create a SATA Volume.
2
In the Disk Configuration screen, you can select the storage method.
• Type in the Volume Name for your RAID 1 volume. The volume name can be 1 to 31 characters (a-z, 0-9, " " [spaces], "_", and ".").
• Choose RAID 1 and click Apply.
NSA210 User’s Guide
87
Chapter 4 Tutorials
This deletes all existing data in the eSATA hard disk. Make sure you have a backup of any existing data in the hard disk.
88
The NSA starts creating the volume and you can see the following progress bar.
Wait for 2 minutes for the RAID 1 volume to be created.
3
The Storage > Volume screen displays with your RAID 1 volume.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.6.4 Creating a PC Compatible Volume
You can use your eSATA hard disk as a separate storage volume. The following section shows you how to create a PC Compatible Volume. Use this storage method if you have an eSATA hard disk that will be connected to a Windows computer when it is not connected to the NSA. However, the computer’s platform
(for example, Windows XP SP2) should support the file system you selected for the eSATA hard disk.
1
Connect the eSATA hard disk to your NSA and go to the Storage > Volume screen. Click Create a SATA Volume.
2
In the Disk Configuration screen, you can select the storage method.
• Type in the Volume Name for your PC Compatible volume. The volume name can be 1 to 31 characters (a-z, 0-9, " " [spaces], "_", and ".").
• Choose PC Compatible Volume.
• Select the File System you want to use (NTFS in this example). Make sure this file system is supported by the Windows platform you are using in your
computer. Refer to Section 7.5.6 on page 183 for file systems supported by your
NSA. Click Apply.
This deletes all existing data in the eSATA hard disk. Make sure you have a backup of any existing data in the hard disk.
NSA210 User’s Guide
89
Chapter 4 Tutorials
90
The NSA starts creating the volume and you can see the following progress bar.
Wait for 2 minutes for the volume to be created.
3
The Storage > Volume screen displays with your PC Compatible Volume.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.6.4.1 Checking Your PC Compatible Volume
The files in the eSATA hard disk that you configured as a PC Compatible Volume should be accessible when you connect the eSATA hard disk to your computer.
You can configure the features of your NSA to save files to your eSATA hard disk.
For example, you can refer to
Section 4.10 on page 119 to use the
Broadcatching feature of your NSA to download files to your eSATA disk.
1
When asked for the Location of Downloaded Files, make sure you save the completed files to the eSATA hard disk (Volume 2 in this example).
2
The files downloaded by the NSA should be in the Volume 2 folder. You can check this when you access the Volume 2 folder from My NSA > Share Browser screen as follows.
NSA210 User’s Guide
91
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Disconnect the eSATA hard disk from the NSA. Connect the eSATA hard disk to your computer. On some systems, you can see the following notification.
4
The computer assigns a letter to the eSATA hard disk (drive F in this example) that is accessible from the My Computer screen. Double click the eSATA drive and check your files. They should be the same files that are in the My NSA > Share
Browser screen.
4.7 Deleting a Volume
Delete an existing volume in your NSA by doing the following steps.
1
In the Storage > Volume screen, select the volume you want to delete and click the delete icon.
92
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
A confirmation window appears as follows. Click Yes.
This deletes all existing data in the volume. Make sure you have a backup of any existing data in the hard disk.
4.8 File Sharing Tutorials
The following sections cover using the NSA for file sharing. This chapter assumes you have already followed the Quick Start Guide instructions to perform initial setup and configuration (so you have a working volume). See the rest of this
User’s Guide for details on configuring the NSA’s various screens.
4.8.1 Creating a User Account
Bob wants to create accounts for his sons Jimmy and Kevin. This is how he would do it.
NSA210 User’s Guide
93
Chapter 4 Tutorials
1
Log into the NSA Web Configurator (see
Section 3.3 on page 54 ) and click
System > Administration to go to the configuration screens.
1
Click Sharing > Users to open the Users screen. Then click Add User.
Users
94
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
Configure the screen as follows and write down the username and password to give to Jimmy. If the username and password are the same as Jimmy’s Windows login, Jimmy will not need to enter a username and password when he logs into his share from his computer. Set the Account Type to User so Jimmy doesn’t get to configure the whole NSA. Click Apply to create the account.
Users > Create Example
3
The account now displays in the Users screen.
Users (Account Created)
Now that Bob has created Jimmy’s account, he can go through the steps again to create another account for Kevin. After both accounts are created, he can go to
Section 4.8.2 on page 96 to create shares for Jimmy and Kevin.
NSA210 User’s Guide
95
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.8.2 Creating a Share
Suppose Bob has already created separate accounts for his sons Jimmy and Kevin.
Now Bob wants to create a share for each son. He also wants to make sure that each son can only access his own share (to keep them from deleting each other’s files). This is how he would do it.
1
In the NSA’s administration Web Configurator screens, click Shares > Add
Share. Click Add Share to create a new share.
Shares
2
Specify a name for the share and select which volume it should be on. Configure the screen as follows. Then click Edit.
Shares > Add Share Example
96
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Configure the screen as follows to give Jimmy full access right to the share. Then click Apply to create the share.
Shares > Add Share > Share Access > Advanced Example
Now that Bob has created Jimmy’s share, he can go through the steps again to create another share for Kevin.
4.8.3 Creating a Group
After creating user accounts for Jimmy and Kevin, Bob wants to create a group for his sons and another one for the parents. Bob can assign access rights to his sons’ group for certain shares such as a cartoons share and allow only the parents’ group to access the scary movie share. This is how he would create the group.
1
In the NSA’s administration Web Configurator screen, click Groups > Add Group.
Groups
NSA210 User’s Guide
97
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
Specify a name for the group. Select the user(s) you want to add to the group from the Available User(s) list and click Add Selected User(s). Configure the screen as follows. Then click Apply to create the group.
Groups > Add Group Example
Now that Bob has created a group for Jimmy and Kevin, he can go through the steps again to create another group for the parents. Then he can see the rest of the tutorials for how to use the groups in assigning access rights to shares.
4.8.4 Accessing a Share From Windows Explorer
If you map a NSA share (where data is stored) to a Windows network drive, you can use Windows Explorer to transfer files to and from the NSA as if it was another folder on your computer. Here he maps Jimmy’s share to Jimmy’s computer.
1
Start Windows Explorer and go to the NSA’s server name (“nsa210” is the default) or IP address.
2
Click Tools > Map Network Drive.
NSA Top Level
98
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Select the network drive that you want to map the NSA to from the Drive list box.
This example uses I. Then browse to and select the share on the NSA. Click
Finish.
Map Network Drive
4
Enter the username and password for Jimmy’s account and click OK. You do not need to do this if the username and password are the same as Jimmy’s Windows login.
Enter Network Password
NSA210 User’s Guide
99
Chapter 4 Tutorials
5
After the mapping is done, you can then simply copy and paste or drag and drop files from/to your local computer’s drives to or from this network folder. Just like the NSA’s share was another folder on your computer.
Example Share Mapped (Folders View)
Now that Bob has mapped Jimmy’s share to Jimmy’s computer, he can go through the steps again to map Kevin’s share to Kevin’s computer.
4.8.5 Accessing a Share Using FTP
You can also use FTP to access the NSA. Suppose Jimmy is temporarily using a different computer and wants to access his share without mapping it to the computer. This is how he would do it.
1
Open the FTP client (Windows Explorer is used here) and type “ftp:// username@server” where “username” is the account’s username and “server” is the NSA’s IP address or server name.
FTP Example: Typing the FTP Target
100
NSA210 User’s Guide
2
Enter your password and click Login.
FTP Example: Enter the Password
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Now you can access files and copy files from/to your local computer’s drives to or from this network folder.
FTP Example: Logged In
NSA210 User’s Guide
101
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.8.6 Accessing a Share Through the Web Configurator
You can browse and access files through the Web Configurator.
1
Log into the NSA Web Configurator (see
Section 3.3 on page 54 ) using the
appropriate user name and password (this example uses Jimmy’s) and click File
Browser. Click a share (the Jimmy share in this example) to see the top level of the share’s contents.
102
2
Click a folder’s file name to browse the folder. You can open files or copy them to your computer. You can also create new folders and upload additional files to the share.
3
Click the logout icon when your are done.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.9 Download Service Tutorial
This tutorial covers using the NSA to download a file from the Internet. Use this same procedure for BitTorrent downloads as well as regular HTTP (web) and FTP
downloads. See Section 9.11.2 on page 234
for more on the download service.
4.9.1 Copying/Pasting a Download Link
1
Open your Internet browser (this example uses Internet Explorer).
2
Find a download link for the file you want. In this example, www.zyxel.com has a
Download Now link for downloading a datasheet for ZyXEL’s GS-2024 (an
Ethernet switch).
Download Link Example
Note: Make sure the link opens either the file you want or a pop-up window about how to handle the file.
Note: It is also OK for the link to open a .torrent file. If you are redirected to a screen that says the download should start in a few seconds, there may be a link to click if the download does not start automatically. See if that link opens the file or the pop-up window.
NSA210 User’s Guide
103
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Right-click the download link and select Copy Shortcut in Internet Explorer (or
Copy Link Location in Firefox).
Copy Shortcut
4
Log into the NSA Web Configurator (see
Section 3.3 on page 54 ) using the
administrator account and click Application Zone and the Application Zone >
Download Service link.
104
5
Click Add.
Download Service Tutorial: Download Service
NSA210 User’s Guide
6
Right-click the URL field and select Paste.
Download Service Tutorial: Paste Link
Chapter 4 Tutorials
7
The URL displays in the URL field. Click Apply.
Download Service Tutorial: Apply Pasted Link
8
After a few moments, the download task appears in the Download Service screen’s Active tab.
The download appears in the Completed tab when it is done. By default the NSA
stores all downloads in the admin share’s download folder. See Section 4.8.4 on page 98 ,
Section 4.8.5 on page 100 , or
Section 4.8.6 on page 102 for how to
access a share.
NSA210 User’s Guide
105
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.9.2 Installing the Link Capture Browser Plugin
In addition to copying and pasting a download link to the Download Service screen, you can also install a link capture browser plugin in your web browser. Use the plugin to easily add a download link to the NSA’s download service. See
Section 9.11.3 on page 234 for more on the link capture browser plugin.
Internet Explorer
1
Open the folder containing the link capture browser plugin.
2
Double-click on the plugin to display the following screen. Click I Agree to begin installation.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: IE
106
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Select a location to save the plugin and click Install. Close the screen once the installation is complete.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: IE Installation
4
Open Internet Explorer and locate a download link. In this example, www.zyxel.com has a Download Now link for downloading a user’s guide for
ZyXEL’s NBG410W3G (a 3G wireless router). Right-click on the download link and select NSA Setting.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: IE Setting
NSA210 User’s Guide
107
Chapter 4 Tutorials
5
Enter the NSA’s web address (nsa210 by default) and click Apply. A warning message displays asking for confirmation. Click OK to apply the setting.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: Setting NSA’s Web Address in IE
Firefox
1
Open Firefox.
2
Open the folder containing the link capture browser plugin.
3
To install the plugin, drag and drop the plugin to Firefox.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: Firefox
108
NSA210 User’s Guide
4
The following screen displays. Click Install Now.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: Firefox Installation
Chapter 4 Tutorials
5
You need to restart Firefox after the installation.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: Restart Firefox
NSA210 User’s Guide
109
Chapter 4 Tutorials
6
When Firefox restarts, a message displays to show the installation succeeded. The plugin is installed as an extension in Add-ons. Click Options to configure the
NSA’s web address.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: Firefox Options
7
Enter the NSA’s web address (nsa210 by default) and click OK.
Link Capture Browser Plugin: Firefox Settings
110
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.9.3 Using the Link Capture Browser Plugin
Once you install the plugin, you may begin sending download links to the NSA from your web browser. This example shows how to send a download link to the
NSA’s download service using the link capture browser plugin.
1
Open your Internet browser (this example uses Firefox).
2
Find a download link for the file you want. In this example, www.zyxel.com has a
Download Now link for downloading a user’s guide for ZyXEL’s P-660W-T1 (an
ADSL router).
Link Capture Browser Plugin Example
3
Right-click on the download link and select Send to NSA.
Send to NSA
NSA210 User’s Guide
111
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4
The login screen shows up. Enter your NSA’s login information and click Login to send the link to the download service. A confirmation message displays.
Link Capture Confirmation
5
Log into the NSA Web Configurator (see
Section 3.3 on page 54 ) using the
administrator account and click Application Zone and the Application Zone >
Download Service link.
112
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
6
The download task appears in the Download Service screen’s Active or Queue tab. It may appear in the Completed tab if the NSA already finished downloading the file or it may appear in the Error tab if the NSA failed to download the file.
By default the NSA stores all downloads in the admin share’s download folder.
See Section 4.8.4 on page 98 ,
Section 4.8.5 on page 100 , or
Section 4.8.6 on page 102 for how to access a share.
4.9.4 Configuring the Download Service Preferences
Once you added a list of download tasks to the NSA (see
Section 4.9.3 on page 111 ), you can have the NSA download files during
a specific time period of the day. You can also configure the BitTorrent settings to control bandwidth and optimize download efficiency.
Say you have the NSA turned on all the time, but you only want the NSA download files at night. Here is how you use the download period control feature to set the time range.
1
Click Applications > Download Service > Preferences to open the General
Settings screen.
2
Select Enable Download Period Control and use the arrows to adjust the time period from 23:30 to 09:00. Click Apply to save your changes. The NSA only downloads files within this 9.5-hour period every day.
Note: If you configure the Power On/Off Schedule feature in the Power
Management screen, make sure your active download period does not conflict with the power-off period.
NSA210 User’s Guide
113
Chapter 4 Tutorials
Note: If power failure occurs during the active download period, the NSA will verify whether the downloaded files were damaged. If a file is corrupted, the NSA will download the file again. If the file is intact but not completely downloaded, the
NSA will resume the download task after it restarts.
3
When it is not the download time, you see a message in the Download Service screen, indicating the active download period.
Click Applications > Download Service > Preferences > BitTorrent to open the following screen. Enter the information below and then click Apply.
114
Here is a list of BitTorrent settings you want to configure for your NSA:
• Limit the maximum upload rate to 20 KB/s.
Enter this value in the Max. upload rate field.
• Actively download three torrent files but only upload one at a time.
Enter 3 in the Maximum Number of Active Torrents field and enter 1 in the
Maximum Number of Seeding Jobs field.
• Keep sharing until the NSA has shared equal or greater amount of the downloaded files.
Select the check box and enter 100 in the Upload/Download Ratio field.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
• Click Edit IP Filter. Use an online IP filter table from http:// www.bluetack.co.uk/config/level1.gz for example to protect BitTorrent downloads.
Enter the URL in the Update IP Filter from the Internet Every Week field.
4.9.5 Using Download Service Notification
Use an RSS feed reader on your computer to keep track of files the NSA has downloaded. The following examples show how to subscribe to the NSA’s
download service notifications. See Section 9.11.4 on page 235
for more on download service notifications.
Some RSS readers may not support the NSA’s download service notifications. For example, Google Reader cannot support this feature if the NSA has a private IP address.
Note: It is recommended to subscribe to the download service notifications using the built-in reader in Internet Explorer 7 or higher, or Firefox.
You have to activate this feature in the Download Service screen. Click
Applications > Download Service to open the following screen. Select Enable
Download Notify and click Apply.
Download Service Notification: Activation
NSA210 User’s Guide
115
Chapter 4 Tutorials
Internet Explorer 7 Example
1
After you activate download service notification, click the RSS feed icon.
Download Service Notification: RSS Feed Icon
2
The following screen displays. Select Subscribe to this feed.
Subscribe to Download Service Notifications
3
The following screen displays. Click Subscribe.
Add the RSS Feed
116
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4
Click the Favorite icon on your browser and select the Feeds tab to check the updates of your NSA’s download list.
Download Service Notification
Firefox Example
1
After you activate download service notification, click the RSS feed icon.
Download Service Notification: RSS Feed Icon
2
The following screen displays. Select LiveBookmarks from the drop-down list and click Subscribe Now.
Subscribe to Download Service Notifications
NSA210 User’s Guide
117
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
The following screen displays. Select Bookmarks Menu and click Add.
Add the RSS Feed
4
From the Firefox’s Bookmarks Menu, select Download Notify to check the updates of your NSA’s download list.
Download Service Notification
118
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.10 Broadcatching Tutorial
Use broadcatching to have the NSA download frequently updated digital content like TV programs, radio talk shows, Podcasts (audio files), and blogs. This example shows how to subscribe the NSA to the CNET TV Internet television channel. See
for more on the broadcatching service.
1
Open your Internet browser (this example uses Firefox).
2
Find the link for the RSS feed containing the channel you want to add. In this example, http://reviews.cnet.com/4520-11455_7-6333605-1.html has an RSS link for subscribing to the CNET Live podcast. However this is not the link for the actual RSS feed. Click the link to go to another screen that has RSS feed links.
Broadcatching Link Example
Note: Make sure the link goes to the actual RSS feed instead of to another list of links or information about the channel.
One way to test this is by clicking the link. Clicking an actual RSS feed link opens a screen of XML code (in browsers without an RSS feed aggregator) or a window where you can add the RSS feed (in browsers with an RSS feed aggregator).
NSA210 User’s Guide
119
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Right-click the download link and select Copy Link Location in Firefox (or Copy
Shortcut in Internet Explorer).
Copy Link Location
120
4
Log into the NSA Web Configurator (see
Section 3.3 on page 54 ) using the
administrator account and click Administration > Applications >
Broadcatching.
5
Click Add Channel.
Broadcatching Tutorial: Broadcatching
NSA210 User’s Guide
6
Right-click the URL field and select Paste.
Broadcatching Tutorial: Paste Link
Chapter 4 Tutorials
7
The URL displays in the URL field.
8
Select a policy for what items to download. This example uses Manually Choose
Items for Download so you will be able to select individual items to download later.
9
Select a policy for what items to delete. This example keeps the most recent 10 items.
10
Click Apply.
Broadcatching Tutorial: Apply Pasted Link
NSA210 User’s Guide
121
Chapter 4 Tutorials
11
After a few moments, the channel appears in the Broadcatching screen where you can select items you want to download. The NSA saves the items you download in a folder named after the channel. By default, the channel folders are created in the admin share’s download folder. The NSA’s media server feature makes it easy for users on your network to play the broadcatching files you download. See
Section 9.11.1 on page 232 for more on the media server.
4.11 Printer Server Tutorial
Do the following to have the NSA let computers on your network share a printer.
See www.zyxel.com for a list of compatible printers.
1
Make sure the NSA is on and the SYS light is on steady (not blinking).
2
Use a USB cable to connect the printer’s USB port to one of the NSA’s USB ports.
Make sure the printer is also connected to an appropriate power source.
Printer Sharing
122
NSA
3
Turn on the printer.
4
The NSA detects the printer after a few moments.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
5
On your computer, open your CIFS file sharing program (Windows Explorer for example) and browse to the NSA. Double-click the printer’s icon.
Printer Connected to NSA: Windows Explorer
6
If you get a warning screen, click the option that lets you continue (Yes in this example).
Printer Connected to NSA: Windows Explorer Warning
7
If your computer does not already have the printer’s driver installed, you will need to install it. In this example, click OK.
Printer Driver Needed
8
Use the wizard screens to install the printer driver on the computer. You may need to get the file from the printer’s CD or the printer manufacturer’s website (the driver is not installed on the NSA).
Note: You must install the printer driver on each computer that will use the printer.
Applications > Print Server
NSA210 User’s Guide
123
Chapter 4 Tutorials
After the driver installation finishes, the computer is ready to use the printer.
Select the printer in an application to use it to print. Browse to the NSA using a
CIFS program (like Windows Explorer) and double-click the printer’s icon to open the printer’s queue of print jobs.
Printer Screen in Windows Explorer
Note: Repeat steps
to
on your other computers so they can also use the printer.
4.12 Copy and Flickr Auto Upload Tutorial
Amy received some photos taken during her best friend’s wedding and saved the files on a USB disk. She wants to save a copy of the photos in the NSA and upload the photos to her Flickr account.
Amy has to activate the NSA’s auto upload feature. See
for more details on setting up a Flickr account for auto upload. In this example
Amy select the NSA’s photo share for auto upload.
This is how Amy would transfer the files from her USB disk to the NSA.
1
Click Applications > Copy/Sync Button in the navigation panel to open the screen.
2
Configure the copy settings as shown and click Apply.
Copy Tutorial: Copy Settings
124
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Press and release the COPY/SYNC button on the NSA’s front panel to start copying files.
4
The copied files can be found in a new folder in the photo share. The name of this folder is the date (yyyy-mm-dd) and time (hh:mm:ss) when the folder is created.
Copy Tutorial: Copied Files
5
The NSA also automatically uploads the copied files to Flickr.
Copy Tutorial: Auto Upload to Flickr
4.13 FTP Uploadr Tutorial
FTP Uploadr can automatically upload files saved on the NSA to a remote FTP server. Amy wants to share files on her NSA with Susan. They each have an NSA
NSA210 User’s Guide
125
Chapter 4 Tutorials at home, so Susan has to set her NSA as an FTP server for Amy to automatically send files using FTP Uploadr.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial
Amy’s NSA
Susan’s NSA
To set the NSA as an FTP server, click Applications > FTP to open the FTP screen. Select Enable FTP and click Apply.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial: Enable FTP
126
Susan also has to create a user account and share on her NSA for Amy to upload files. The share is used for files uploaded from Amy’s NSA. Amy will then use the following information to configure FTP Uploadr on her NSA.
Table 17 FTP Uploadr Tutorial: FTP Server Information
FTP Domain Name or IP
Address example2.com
FTP User Name
FTP Password
Share (Remote Path)
Amy xxxxx
Amy
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
This is how Amy would set up the NSA’s FTP Uploadr.
1
Click Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr to open the FTP Uploadr screen. Select Enable FTP Uploadr and click Apply to turn on FTP Uploadr.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial: Enable FTP Uploadr
2
Click Add Server.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial
3
Enter the information as describe in
Table 17 on page 126 . Click Apply to add the
server.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial: Add Server
NSA210 User’s Guide
127
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4
In the FTP Uploadr screen, click Preferences to configure the auto upload settings.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial: Preferences
5
Amy wants to share video files with Susan. In the Preferences screen, click the
Add button and select video from the Shares drop-down list box, enter a forward slash in the Path field and click Apply to add the share to the Folder Watch List.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial: Folder Watch List
128
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
6
Amy also set the Bandwidth Limit to 20KB/s so that the upload doesn’t slow down her Internet connection.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial: Bandwidth Limit
Now Amy has set up FTP Uploadr to send files to Susan’s NSA. Every time Amy adds new files or renames files in the video share, these new or modified files will be uploaded automatically to the Amy share on Susan’s NSA.
Similarly, Susan can go through the steps described above to configure FTP
Uploadr on her NSA. Once Susan completes the setup, Amy can also receive files from Susan’s NSA.
FTP Uploadr Tutorial: Exchange Files
Amy’s NSA
Susan’s NSA
NSA210 User’s Guide
129
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.14 Web Configurator’s Security Sessions
These tutorials show you how to configure security for the NSA’s Web Configurator sessions. You will customize the NSA’s self-signed SSL certificate and distribute it to your users.
4.14.1 Customizing the NSA’s Certificate
1
Click Maintenance > SSL and then select Edit a self-signed CA certificate and click Edit.
Maintenance > SSL
130
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
Next, let’s modify the certificate by changing the Common Name to this NSA’s host name of “nsa210”, the Organization to “Test” and the Key Length to 2048.
Maintenance > SSL > Edit a Self-Signed Certificate
3
The NSA restarts its network services and returns you to the login screen.
Maintenance > SSL > Edit a Self-Signed Certificate
NSA210 User’s Guide
131
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.14.2 Downloading and Installing Customized Certificate
1
Log in and return to Maintenance > SSL. Under Modify the Existing
Certificate, click Download.
Maintenance > SSL
132
2
Save the file to your computer.
Downloading the NSA’s Certificate
NSA210 User’s Guide
3
Find the certificate file on your computer and double-click it.
Downloading the NSA’s Certificate
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4
Install the certificate. The rest of the steps in this section are an example of installing a certificate in Windows. See
Appendix D on page 463 for other
examples. In the Certificate dialog box, click Install Certificate.
Certificate
NSA210 User’s Guide
133
Chapter 4 Tutorials
5
In the Certificate Import Wizard, click Next.
Certificate Import Wizard: Welcome
6
Leave Automatically select certificate store based on the type of
certificate selected and click Next.
Certificate Import Wizard: Certificate Store
134
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
7
In the Completing the Certificate Import Wizard screen, click Finish.
Certificate Import Wizard: Finish
8
If you are presented with another Security Warning, click Yes.
Security Warning
9
Finally, click OK when presented with the successful certificate installation message.
Certificate Import Wizard: Successful
NSA210 User’s Guide
135
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.14.3 Turn on the NSA’s Web Security
Now that you have customized the NSA’s certificate and installed it in your computer, you can turn on security for your Web Configurator sessions. This example uses Firefox 3.0. See
Appendix D on page 463 for more information on
browsers and certificates.
1
Close your web browser and open it again to reset its session with the NSA. Log in and click Maintenance > SSL. Select Force HTTPS and click Apply.
Maintenance > SSL
136
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
A warning screen pops up if applying your change may disconnect some users.
Click Apply to continue.
Maintenance > SSL > Force HTTPS Warning
3
The NSA logs you out and automatically redirects your formerly non-secure
(HTTP) connection to a secure (HTTPS) connection. Your browser may give you a warning about the device’s public key certificate. Add an exception to allow your browser to bypass the warning.
Firefox: Secure Connection Failed
NSA210 User’s Guide
137
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4
Click Add Exception.
Firefox: Secure Connection Failed
5
Click Get Certificate.
Firefox: Add Security Exception
138
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
6
Before you add an exception, verify that the device to which you are trying to connect is providing the correct certificate. Click View.
Firefox: Add Security Exception
NSA210 User’s Guide
139
Chapter 4 Tutorials
7
The SHA1 fingerprint must match the NSA’s certificate you downloaded from the
NSA to your computer. (Double-click the NSA’s certificate file and then click
Details and look at the Thumbprint). Click Close.
Firefox: Add Security Exception
140
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
8
If the certificate fingerprints match, click Confirm Security Exception, otherwise click Cancel.
Firefox: Add Security Exception
9
The login screen displays.
HTTPS Login
Now, anyone who connects to the NSA’s Web Configurator screens will automatically do so by HTTPs. Use a secure method to let your users know the correct fingerprint for the NSA’s certificate so they can check it before adding a security exception (as in steps
on pages
to
). See the next section for how to use FTPES with the NSA for secure FTP transfers.
NSA210 User’s Guide
141
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.15 Using FTPES to Connect to the NSA
This section covers how to use FTP over Explicit TLS/SSL with the NSA for secure
FTP transfers. Before you go through this section, read Section 4.14 on page 130
to configure HTTPS. This example uses FileZilla.
1
Open FileZilla and click File > Site Manager > New Site.
• Configure the Host field with the NSA’s address.
• Set the Servertype to FTPES - FTP over explicit TLS/SSL.
• Configure the account name and password.
• Click Connect.
FileZilla Site Manager
142
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
A security warning screen displays. The SHA1 fingerprint must match the NSA’s certificate you downloaded from the NSA to your computer. (Double-click the
NSA’s certificate file and then click Details and look at the Thumbprint). If they match, click OK.
FileZilla Unknown Certificate Warning
The shares and folders to which Gonzo has access display. Now you can use FTP to securely transfer files to or from the NSA. Use a secure method to let your users know the correct fingerprint for the NSA’s certificate so they can check it before adding a security exception.
4.16 Using a Mac to Access the NSA
This tutorial shows you how to find the NSA on Mac OS X 10.5 (Leopard).
You can access the NSA in two ways:
• Use the Finder to browse for the NSA, or
• Use the Finder > Go option to connect to the NSA.
NSA210 User’s Guide
143
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.16.1 Finder
1
Open a new Finder window.
2
Select All under the SHARED sidebar. Look for the NSA from the Network list.
144
NSA210 User’s Guide
3
Expand the NSA to display the shares you may access.
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.16.2 Go Menu
4
In the Finder, click Go > Connect to Server.
NSA210 User’s Guide
145
Chapter 4 Tutorials
5
When the Connect to Server dialog box opens, enter smb:// and the NSA’s IP address in the Server Address field. You may also click Browse to have the Mac search for the NSA. Click Connect.
6
Once you establish the connection, you can access the NSA from the Finder or directly from the desktop.
4.17 How to Use BackupPlanner
Note: The screens and links in this section appear only after you have installed and enabled BackupPlanner. BackupPlanner is an application that you can install
using Package Management (see
.)
Use the NSA’s BackupPlanner to have a backup of your files and folders.
Schedule backups for times when the network is not busy (like at night or on weekends). For example, you might do daily backups of important individual files or folders and a weekly general archive. You can save backups to another location so your files can survive even if the original RAID or NSA fails.
146
NSA210 User’s Guide
4.17.1 Creating an Archive Backup
To backup the NSA every week to a remote NSA:
1
Click Protect > Backup > Add Job.
Figure 58 Protect > Backup
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
Identify the backup job and select Archive.
New files are often added to the shares that you need to back up and existing files are not frequently changed so select Incremental. The NSA does a full backup first and later only copies source files that are new and/or modified since the last backup. This example sets the NSA to do another full backup after every four incremental backups.
Figure 59 Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 1
NSA210 User’s Guide
147
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Select the volume1 check box to select all the folders and files.
Select Remote and enter the other NSA’s address, username, password, and share name.
If you want to make sure the remote NSA is reachable, click Test Connection.
Figure 60 Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 2
148
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4
In this example, the target NSA is on the LAN so leave the compression off.
Security is already configured on the target NSA so you can leave the encryption off, too.
Have the NSA keep 3 backups.
Figure 61 Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 3
5
Set the frequency to Weekly. Schedule the backup for 5:00 every Saturday morning.
Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 4
NSA210 User’s Guide
149
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.17.2 Creating a Synchronization Backup
To create a synchronization backup:
1
Click Protect > Backup > Add Job.
Figure 62 Protect > Backup
Name the backup job and select Synchronization.
You want only your current set of files in the remote NSA’s folder, so you select
Mirror to make the target folder identical to the source folder. The NSA deletes any other files in the target folder.
Figure 63 Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 1
150
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
Select the folder that needs to be mirrored (your Private folder in this example) and Remote.
• Enter the other NSA’s address and administrator password.
• Click Show target content to display the remote NSA’s contents.
• Select the destination on the remote NSA (Backups in this example).
• Click Next.
Figure 64 Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 2
3
Click OK in the warning dialog box.
Figure 65 Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 3
4
For this example, assume the connection to the German branch office is a good one and not many files need to be backed up so leave the compression off.
NSA210 User’s Guide
151
Chapter 4 Tutorials
• Turn on the encryption to protect these sensitive files during the transfer. The final files stored on the remote NSA will be unencrypted (usable).
• Restrict the bandwidth usage to 256 KB/s to stop the archives from using all of your network connection’s available bandwidth.
• You don’t have to configure a purge policy for a synchronization backup.
• Click Next.
Figure 66 Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 3
5
Schedule the backup to occur every morning at 3:00 and click Done.
Figure 67 Protect > Backup > Add Job: Step 4
152
You do not need to use a special restore process to use the files a synchronization backup creates. The copy of files that the NSA creates on the other NSA’s Backups share can be used directly by anyone with access to that share.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
4.17.3 Restoring Archived Files by Backup Job
If you have backup jobs for which the NSA has already performed backups, you can restore the files based on the backup job. Do the following:
1
Click Protect > Backup screen, select a backup job and click Restore Archive.
Figure 68 Protect > Backup
2
Select which backup to use and click Next.
Figure 69 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 1
NSA210 User’s Guide
153
Chapter 4 Tutorials
3
Select the share where you have stored your the backup you want to restore and click Next.
Figure 70 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 2
154
4
Select the original location and click Done.
Figure 71 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 3
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 4 Tutorials
5
The NSA restores the files into the share. When it finishes you can access the files.
Figure 72 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Progress
4.17.4 Restoring by Backup Files
If you deleted an archive backup job or the NSA or the RAID array containing the backup job failed you cannot restore archived files by the backup job. In this example, the NSA’s RAID array failed. You’ve replaced the hard drives and reconfigured the RAID. To restore by backup files:
1
Click Protect > Restore. Specify where the archive files are located. In this example, enter “192.168.3.2” as the IP address, “admin” as the account name,
“1234” as the password, and “Backups” as the share name. Click Test
Connection. Click Next.
Figure 73 Protect > Restore: Step 1
NSA210 User’s Guide
155
Chapter 4 Tutorials
2
Select the backup job and backup time and click Next.
Figure 74 Protect > Restore: Step 2
3
Select everything in the share except the recycle folder. Click Next.
Figure 75 Protect > Restore: Step 3
156
NSA210 User’s Guide
4
Browse to the folder where you want to put the files. Click Done.
Figure 76 Protect > Restore: Step 4
Chapter 4 Tutorials
5
The NSA restores the files and you can use them again.
NSA210 User’s Guide
157
Chapter 4 Tutorials
158
NSA210 User’s Guide
P
ART
II
Technical Reference
159
160
C
H A P T E R
5
Status Screen
5.1 Overview
This chapter describes the Status screen, which is the first advanced administration screen that displays.
5.2 The Status Screen
Click Administration in the Home screens ( Section 3.5 on page 71 ) to open the
Web Configurator. You can also view the status screen, by clicking Status on the top-left of the navigation panel.
NSA210 User’s Guide
161
Chapter 5 Status Screen
Figure 77 Status
162
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 18 Status
LABEL
System Information
Server Name
DESCRIPTION
Model Name
Firmware Version
MAC Address
Media Server
Status
This displays the name which helps you find the NSA on the network. Click the Edit icon to go to the screen where you can configure this.
This displays which model this NSA device is.
This is the NSA firmware version. Click the Edit icon to go to the
Maintenance > FW Upgrade screen from which you can upload/upgrade new firmware.
This displays the NSA’s unique physical hardware address
(MAC). You need the MAC address to register the product at myZyXEL.com. Customer support may also request it for troubleshooting purposes.
This shows whether the media server function is enabled or disabled. It must be enabled for media clients to play content files stored on the NSA. Click the Edit icon to go to the screen where you can configure this.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 5 Status Screen
Table 18 Status (continued)
LABEL
FTP Server Status
Web Publishing
Status
UPS
CPU Usage
DESCRIPTION
This shows whether the FTP server function is enabled or disabled. It must be enabled to use FTP file transfer to/from the
NSA. Click the edit icon to go to the screen where you can configure this.
This shows whether the Web server function is enabled or disabled. It must be enabled to use HTTP to access shares on the NSA. Click the Edit icon to go to the screen where you can configure this.
This shows the Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) capacity.
Click the Edit icon to go to the screen where you can configure this.
This displays a summary of CPU usage by all current processes.
Click the Refresh icon to update this display. It also automatically updates itself every 10 seconds.
CPU Temperature
Fan Speed
Memory Usage
Volume Status
SATA Volume
USB Volume
Status
Note: If too many users are using the NSA then the NSA may appear sluggish.
This displays the current temperature near the NSA’s CPU. The
NSA generates an emergency log if the temperature goes out of the normal operating range. If the temperature goes even higher, the NSA shuts down automatically to avoid damage from overheating. If the NSA overheats, make sure the fans are working and it is in a well ventilated place.
Click the Refresh icon to update this display. It also automatically updates itself every 60 seconds.
This is the RPM (Rotations Per Minute) of the NSA’s fans.
Click the Refresh icon to update this display. It also automatically updates itself every 60 seconds.
This shows how much of the NSA's total memory is being used.
Click the Refresh icon to update this display. It also automatically updates itself every 10 seconds.
A volume is a storage area on a single disk or spread across a number of disks within a single file system.
This displays the volumes created on the hard drives installed in the NSA.
Click the Edit icon to open the Storage screen. You can create
and edit the NSA’s internal volume. See Chapter 7 on page 171
for more details.
This displays the volumes created on USB hard drives connected to the NSA. USB disks are numbered in the order that you insert
USB devices.
Click the Edit icon to open the Storage screen. You can create
and edit the external volume. See Chapter 7 on page 171
for more details.
This icon indicates whether the volume is healthy, degraded, or down.
NSA210 User’s Guide
163
Chapter 5 Status Screen
Table 18 Status (continued)
LABEL
Name
Configuration
File System
Disk(s)
Disk Usage
Active Sessions
Type
Share Name
Username
Connected At
IP Address
DESCRIPTION
This field shows the name for the volume.
This field (also known as Type) shows what type of data storage system (a RAID type or JBOD) an internal volume is using.
This field shows what file system an external (USB) volume is using.
For internal drives, this shows which hard drive bays are included in the volume. For external drives, this field shows
Front USB for the front USB port and Rear USB for the rear
USB port.
This field shows total disk size, the percentage of the disk being used and the percentage that is available.
This shows how many users are currently connected to the NSA.
This shows whether it’s a Windows/CIFS, web (Web
Configurator), or FTP connection to the NSA.
This displays the shared folder name on the NSA that the user is connected to for CIFS sessions and is blank for FTP and web sessions.
This displays the name of the user connected to the NSA if one is defined. ANONYMOUS FTP displays if a username is not defined for the user’s connection.
This displays the date and time the user last connected to the
NSA in year, month, day, hour, minute, second format.
This displays the IP address of the computer connected to the
NSA.
164
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
6
System Setting
6.1 Overview
This chapter gives an overview of the various features included in the system setting screens. You can identify your NSA on the network and set the time that the NSA follows for its scheduled tasks/logs.
6.2 What You Can Do
• Use the Server Name screen (
Section 6.4 on page 166 ) to specify the NSA’s
server and workgroup names.
• Use the Date/Time screen (
Section 6.5 on page 167 ) to set up date/time and
choose a time zone for the NSA.
6.3 What You Need to Know
Windows/CIFS
Common Internet File System (CIFS) is a standard protocol supported by most operating systems in order to share files across the network.
• CIFS is included by default in Windows operating systems.
• You can use Samba with Linux to use CIFS.
• CIFS transfers use security.
Time Lag
Time lag occurs when the time on the NSA falls behind the time on the time server. This may happen if:
• the time server is no longer reachable
• if the NSA is shut down often (the NSA internal battery keeps time when the
NSA is shut down and this may cause possible variance)
NSA210 User’s Guide
165
Chapter 6 System Setting
• power surges occur.
The NSA gives no warning if time lag occurs. You should resynchronize the time after a power surge or after you have shut down the NSA several times.
6.4 The Server Name Screen
Click System Setting > Server Name to open the following screen. Use this screen to configure your CIFS settings. In this screen you can set your server name and specify if your NSA is a part of a workgroup.
Note: CIFS cannot be disabled on the NSA.
Figure 78 System Setting > Server Name
166
The following table describes the labels in these screens.
Table 19 System Setting > Server Name
LABEL
Server Name
DESCRIPTION
Enter a name to identify your NSA on the network in this field.
Description
Workgroup Name
Prevent NSA From
Being Master Browser
You can enter up to 15 alphanumeric characters with minus signs allowed but not as the last character. The name must begin with an alphabet (a-z) and is NOT case sensitive.
Add text here to describe the NSA if the Server Name field is not enough. Use up to 61 characters. You can use all characters except the following: /\:|[]<>+;,?=*"~.
Type your workgroup name in this field. A workgroup is a group of computers on a network that can share files.These user accounts are maintained on the NSA.
You can enter up to 15 alphanumeric characters with minus signs allowed but not as the last character. The name must begin with an alphabet (a-z) and is NOT case sensitive.
Select this option if computers in your workgroup are named with non-English characters (such as Chinese and Russian).
When you perform a search in the workgroup, this option allows you to locate computers named with non-English characters.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 6 System Setting
Table 19 System Setting > Server Name (continued)
LABEL
Apply
Reset
DESCRIPTION
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore previously saved settings.
6.5 The Date/Time Screen
Use this screen to select a time zone and a time server from which your NSA can get the time and date. This time is then used in NSA logs and alerts.
Click the System Setting link in the navigation panel and then click the Date/
Time link to access the Date/Time screen.
Figure 79 System Setting > Date/Time
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 20 System Setting > Date/Time
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Current System Date Time Setting
Current Time This field displays the time used by your NSA for its logs and alerts.
Current Date This field displays the date used by your NSA for its logs and alerts.
Date Time Setup
NSA210 User’s Guide
167
Chapter 6 System Setting
Table 20 System Setting > Date/Time (continued)
LABEL
Manual
DESCRIPTION
Select this radio button to enter the time and date manually.
When you enter the time settings manually, the NSA uses the new setting once you click Apply.
Note: If you enter time settings manually, they revert to their defaults when power is lost.
New Date (yyyymm-dd)
New Time
(hh:mm:ss)
This field displays the last updated date from the time server or the last date configured manually.
When you set Time and Date Setup to Manual, enter the new date in this field and then click Apply.
This field displays the last updated time from the time server or the last time configured manually.
When you set Time and Date Setup to Manual, enter the new time in this field and then click Apply.
Get from Time Server Select this check box to have the NSA get the time and date from the time server you select in the Time Server Address field.
Time Server
Address
Select a time server from the drop-down list box or select
Specify my own time server and enter the time server you wish to use in the field below. Check with your ISP/network administrator if you are unsure of this information.
Synchronize Now Click this for the NSA to retrieve the correct time from the configured time server right away.
Time Zone
Time Zone
Manual Daylight
Saving
Choose the time zone of your location. This will set the time difference between your time zone and Greenwich Mean Time
(GMT).
Daylight saving is a period from late spring to fall when many countries set their clocks ahead of normal local time by one hour to give more daytime light in the evening.
Select this option to manually enter Daylight Saving Time settings. Clear this option to have the NSA automatically retrieve
Daylight Saving Time settings from the Internet. The NSA will download a new daylight saving resource file from the Internet every month.
168
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 6 System Setting
Table 20 System Setting > Date/Time (continued)
LABEL
Start Date
DESCRIPTION
Configure the day and time when Daylight Saving Time starts if you selected Enable Daylight Saving. The hour field uses the
24 hour format. Here are a couple of examples:
End Date
Offset
Apply
Reset
Daylight Saving Time starts in most parts of the United States on the second Sunday of March. Each time zone in the United
States starts using Daylight Saving Time at 2 A.M. local time. So in the United States you would use March, Second, Sunday, at
2:00.
Daylight Saving Time starts in the European Union on the last
Sunday of March. All of the time zones in the European Union start using Daylight Saving Time at the same moment (1 A.M.
GMT or UTC). So in the European Union you would select March,
Last, Sunday. The time you specify depends on your time zone.
In Germany for instance, you would type 2 because Germany's time zone is one hour ahead of GMT or UTC (GMT+1).
Configure the day and time when Daylight Saving Time ends if you selected Enable Daylight Saving. The o'clock field uses the 24 hour format. Here are a couple of examples:
Daylight Saving Time ends in the United States on the first
Sunday of November. Each time zone in the United States stops using Daylight Saving Time at 2 A.M. local time. So in the United
States you would select November, First, Sunday, at 2:00.
Daylight Saving Time ends in the European Union on the last
Sunday of October. All of the time zones in the European Union stop using Daylight Saving Time at the same moment (1 A.M.
GMT or UTC). So in the European Union you would select
October, Last, Sunday. The time you specify depends on your time zone. In Germany for instance, you would type 2 because
Germany's time zone is one hour ahead of GMT or UTC
(GMT+1).
Specify by how many hours to change the time for Daylight
Saving Time.
Click this to save your changes. If you configured a new time and date, Time Zone and Daylight Saving at the same time, all of the settings take affect.
Click this to restore previously saved settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
169
Chapter 6 System Setting
170
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
7
Storage
7.1 Overview
Several NSA features require a valid internal volume. This chapter covers the management of volumes and disks (both internal and external).
7.2 What You Can Do
Use the Storage screen (
) to create and edit volumes in the NSA. You can view information on all volumes, create internal and external volumes, and configure the volume’s properties.
7.3 What You Need to Know
Disk
The NSA requires an initialized SATA (Serial Advanced Technology Attachment) hard disk to function. Refer to the Quick Start Guide for steps on how to initialize the hard disk.
SATA or Serial ATA (Advanced Technology Attachment) is a computer bus technology that allows high-speed data transfer to and from hard disks.
An eSATA (external SATA) hard disk has the same specifications as a SATA hard disk but is attached to the NSA using a cable. It can be used either to expand storage or backup data. The eSATA hard disk is optional.
You can attach one SATA and one eSATA to the NSA hard disk tray. Both SATA and eSATA hard disks are treated by the NSA as internal disks/volumes (refer to
).
The NSA can work with up to two USB hard disks. The USB-attached storage disks are treated by NSA as external disks/volumes (refer to
NSA210 User’s Guide
171
Chapter 7 Storage
Volume
A volume is a storage area on a disk or disks. You can create volumes on the internal disks and external disks attached to the USB port(s). You can spread a volume across internal disks but not between internal and external disks.
An internal disk/volume is the disk/volume that is physically installed in the NSA hard disk tray. The external disk/volume refers to disk drive(s) attached to NSA’s
USB port(s).
Storage Methods
The NSA uses the following storage methods:
• RAID (Redundant Array of Independent Disks)
• PC Compatible Volume
• JBOD (Just a Bunch of Disks)
The storage method you use depends on how many disks you have and how many volumes you want to create. It’s important that you consider this carefully as all data is deleted when you re-create a volume. See
details on choosing a storage method.
Note: By default, the internal hard disk (SATA) you attach to the NSA is configured as
JBOD and cannot be modified. You can attach a second internal hard disk (an eSATA hard disk) and configure the storage method of the internal hard disks
(both SATA and eSATA).
Finding Out More
See Section 7.5 on page 179 for more technical background information on
storage.
172
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 7 Storage
7.4 The Storage Screen
The Storage screen allows you to create and edit volumes in the NSA.
Click Storage > Volume in the navigation panel to display the following screen.
Use this screen to display SATA (internal) and USB (external) volumes on the NSA.
Note: It is recommended to scan the volume every three months or 32 reboots.
Figure 80 Storage > Volume
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 21 Storage > Volume
LABEL
SATA/USB Volume
DESCRIPTION
These tables display information on all internal SATA volumes
(created on NSA internal disk drives) and external volumes
(created on external disk drives attached to the NSA USB ports).
Create a SATA Volume Click this to format internal hard drives and create a new volume. All data on the disk(s) will be lost.
Create a USB Volume Click this to format an external hard drive and create a new volume. All data on the disk will be lost.
Status
Volume
Disk Configuration
This field shows whether the volume is Healthy, Resync,
Recovering, Degraded, or Down. See Section 7.5.3 on page
181 for details on a volume’s status.
The NSA creates the volume name automatically. You can edit it.
File System
This field shows which disks and data storage system the volume is using.
This field displays the file system that an external (USB) volume is using.
NSA210 User’s Guide
173
Chapter 7 Storage
Table 21 Storage > Volume (continued)
LABEL
Disk(s)
DESCRIPTION
Click or roll your mouse over a link in this column to display the following details about the hard drive located in the corresponding hard drive bay.
Capacity
Actions
Type: Whether it is an internal or external (USB) hard drive.
Model Name: This is the hard disk number that identifies the disk.
File System: The file system that an external volume is using
Capacity: The total storage space on the disk.
This field shows total disk size, the percentage of the volume being used and the percentage that is available.
This field displays icons allowing you to edit, scan, repair or delete a volume. You can also locate or eject an external volume.
Note: If you delete a volume, all data in the volume disk(s) is erased.
You see a warning screen before you delete a volume.
Figure 81 Delete a Volume Warning Screen
7.4.1 Creating a SATA Volume
Note: An eSATA hard disk is required in order to create a SATA volume. Otherwise, the NSA shows an error “No disk is available for creating new volume.” The
SATA hard disk is configured as a JBOD volume by default.
174
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 7 Storage
Click the Create a SATA Volume button in the Storage > Volume screen as shown in
Section 7.4 on page 173 to open the following screen. Use this screen to
create a new NSA internal disk drive volume.
Note: Creating a volume formats the hard drive. All data on the disk will be lost.
Figure 82 Storage > Volume > Create a SATA Volume
NSA210 User’s Guide
175
Chapter 7 Storage
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 22 Storage > Volume > Create a SATA Volume
Volume Name
JBOD
PC Compatible
Volume
Type a volume name from 1 to 31 characters. To avoid confusion, it is highly recommended that each volume use a unique name.
Acceptable characters are all alphanumeric characters, " " [spaces],
"_" [underscores], and "." [periods].
The first character must be alphanumeric (A-Z 0-9).
The last character cannot be a space " ".
For an external volume, type a volume name from 1 to 32 single-byte
(no Chinese characters allowed for example) ASCII characters. The name cannot be the same as another existing external volume.
Use this if you want maximum storage capacity and/or you have other means of protecting your data. JBOD is the only option if you only have one disk installed.
Select which disks should make up this volume. A disk can only belong to one volume. You do not need to select anything if only one hard disk is installed.
• Internal Disk - This refers to the hard disk you installed inside the NSA.
• External Disk - This refers to the eSATA hard disk that you can attach as a second drive to your NSA.
This type is only available if you have attached an eSATA hard disk to your NSA.
A primary partition is created on the eSATA hard disk.
Use this to make your eSATA hard disk readable by other computer systems. However, the computer’s platform (for example, Windows XP
SP2) should support the file system you selected for the eSATA hard disk.
• External Disk - This is checked automatically. It refers to the eSATA hard disk that you can attach as a second drive to your
NSA.
• File System - Select the file system you want the new volume to use.
Windows file systems include:
NTFS: Recommended for volumes greater than 40 GB.
FAT32: Newer, and more efficient than FAT16. Supports a volume size of up to 32 GB (Giga Bytes) and individual file sizes of up to 4
GB.
FAT16: Compatible with older Windows operating systems.
Supports volume and file sizes of up to 2 GB.
Linux file systems include:
EXT2: Most commonly used on Linux platforms.
EXT3: The same as EXT2, but adds a journaled file system and is more robust.
ReiserFS: Offers better performance for small files.
XFS: Allows expansion for mounted volumes.
176
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 7 Storage
Table 22 Storage > Volume > Create a SATA Volume (continued)
RAID 1
Apply
Cancel
Use this if you want to mirror all data on one disk to the other disk.
This is only available when you have two hard disks installed (that is, the hard disk inside the NSA and an eSATA hard disk attached to the
NSA.
The External Disk and Internal Disk boxes are automatically checked.
Click this to save your changes and create the volume.
Click this to exit this screen without saving your changes or creating a volume.
Note: Once you create the first volume on the NSA, it is recommended to restart the
NSA for better performance.
7.4.2 Editing a Volume
Click an internal volume’s Edit icon in the Storage > Volume screen as shown in
to open the following screen. Use this screen to change the volume’s name.
Figure 83 Storage > Volume > Edit
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 23 Storage > Volume > Edit
LABEL
Volume Name
DESCRIPTION
For an internal volume, type a volume name from 1 to 31 characters. To avoid confusion, it is highly recommended that each volume use a unique name.
Acceptable characters are all alphanumeric characters and " "
[spaces], "_" [underscores], and "." [periods].
The first character must be alphanumeric (A-Z, 0-9).
Apply
Cancel
The last character cannot be a space " ".
For an external volume, type a volume name from 1 to 32 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example) ASCII characters. The name cannot be the same as another existing external volume.
Click this to save your changes and rename the volume.
Click this to close this screen without saving your changes.
NSA210 User’s Guide
177
Chapter 7 Storage
7.4.3 Creating a USB Volume
Click the Create a USB Volume button in the Storage > Volume screen as shown in
Section 7.4 on page 173 to open the following screen. Use this screen to
create a new NSA external disk drive volume.
Note: Creating a volume formats the drive. All data on the disk will be lost.
Figure 84 Storage > Volume > Create a USB Volume
178
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 24 Storage > Volume > Create a USB Volume
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Volume Name Type a volume name from 1 to 31 characters. The name cannot be the same as another existing external volume.
Available
Disk(s)
File System
Acceptable characters are all alphanumeric characters and " " [spaces],
"_" [underscores], and "." [periods].
The first character must be alphanumeric (A-Z 0-9).
The last character cannot be a space " ".
Select the external (USB) device upon which you want to create the volume.
Select the file system you want the new volume to use.
Windows file systems
NTFS: Recommended for volumes greater than 40 GB.
FAT32: Newer, and more efficient than FAT16. Supports a volume size of up to 2 TB (Tera Bytes) and individual file sizes of up to 4 GB.
FAT16: Compatible with older Windows operating systems. Supports volume and file sizes of up to 2 GB.
Linux file systems
EXT2: Most commonly used on Linux platforms.
EXT3: The same as EXT2, but adds a journaled file system and is more robust.
ReiserFS: Offers better performance for small files.
XFS: Allows expansion for mounted volumes.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 7 Storage
Table 24 Storage > Volume > Create a USB Volume (continued)
LABEL
Apply
Cancel
DESCRIPTION
Click this to save your changes and create the volume.
Click this to exit this screen without saving changes.
7.5 Storage Technical Reference
This section provides some background information about the topics covered in this chapter.
7.5.1 Choosing a Storage Method for a Volume
The following is a guide to help you choose a storage method for the various
number of disks supported on the NSA. See Section 7.5.2 on page 180 for
theoretical background on JBOD and the RAID levels used on the NSA. Typical applications for each method are also shown there.
One Disk
If you only have one disk, you must use JBOD. All disk space is used for your data
- none is used for backup. If the disk fails, then you lose all the data on that volume (disk). You can add another disk to your one-disk JBOD volume later without having to re-create shares, access rights, and so on. Alternatively, you could create a different JBOD volume if you install a second disk. (and create new shares, access rights and so on).
Two Disks:
You may choose JBOD, PC Compatible Volume or RAID 1. With two disks you could create:
• up to two JBOD volumes
• one PC Compatible volume + one JBOD
• one RAID 1 volume
• Choose JBOD for flexibility and maximum usage of disk space for data.
• Choose RAID 1 if data security is more important than performance. Since
RAID 1 mirrors data onto a second disk, you can recover all data even if one disk fails.
NSA210 User’s Guide
179
Chapter 7 Storage
7.5.2 Storage Methods
This section contains theoretical background on JBOD, PC Compatible Volume and the RAID levels used on the NSA. Redundant Array of Independent Disks (RAID) is a method of storing data on multiple disks to provide a combination of greater capacity, reliability, and/or speed.
These are some terms that you need to know in order to understand storage systems.
• Mirroring
In a RAID system using mirroring, all data in the system is written simultaneously to two hard disks instead of one. This provides 100% data redundancy as if one disk fails the other has the duplicated data. Mirroring setups always require an even number of drives.
• Duplexing
Like in mirroring, all data is duplicated onto two distinct physical hard drives but in addition it also duplicates the hardware that controls the two hard drives (one of the drives would be connected to one adapter and the other to a second adapter).
RAID 1
RAID 1 creates an exact copy (or mirror) of a set of data on another disk. This is useful when data backup is more important than data capacity. The following figure shows two disks in a single RAID 1 volume with mirrored data. Data is duplicated across two disks, so if one disk fails, there is still a copy of the data.
Table 25 RAID 1
A1
A2
A3
A4
A1
A2
A3
A4
DISK 1 DISK 2
As RAID 1 uses mirroring and duplexing, a RAID 1 volume needs an even number of disks (two or four for the NSA).
RAID 1 capacity is limited to the size of the smallest disk in the RAID array. For example, if you have two disks of sizes 150 GB and 200 GB respectively in one
RAID 1 volume, then the maximum capacity is 150 GB and the remaining space
(50 GB) is unused.
180
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 7 Storage
Typical applications for RAID 1 are those requiring high fault tolerance without need of large amounts of storage capacity or top performance, for example, accounting and financial data, small database systems, and enterprise servers.
RAID 1 and Data Protection
If a hard disk fails and you’re using a RAID 1 volume, then your data will still be available (but at degraded speeds until you replace the hard disk that failed and resynchronize the volume). However, RAID cannot protect against file corruption, virus attacks, files incorrectly deleted or modified, or the NSA malfunctioning.
Here are some suggestions for helping to protect your data.
• Place the NSA behind a hardware-based firewall. It should have stateful packet inspection, IDP (Intrusion Detection and Prevention), and anti-virus (like
ZyXEL’s ZyWALL UTM products for example).
• Use anti-virus software on your computer to scan files from others before saving the files on the NSA.
Keep another copy of important files (preferably in another location).
7.5.3 Volume Status
You (the administrator) can see the status of a volume in the Status or Storage screens.
The NSA has the following classifications for the status of a volume:
• Healthy if all disks in the volume are OK and the file system is functioning properly.
• OK means the USB connected device is functioning properly.
• Resync when you create a RAID 1 volume.
• Recovering appears when repairing a RAID 1 volume. (A RAID 1 volume was once degraded, but you have installed a new disk and the NSA is restoring the
RAID 1 volume to a healthy state.)
• Degraded when a volume is currently down, but can be fixed. Data access may be slower from a degraded volume, so it’s recommended that you replace the faulty disk and repair the volume as soon as you can.
• Inactive when a disk is missing from a two-disk JBOD volume. The volume is unusable. If you removed one of the disks you should be able to re-install it and use the volume again (as long as you did not change anything on the disk). If a disk has failed, you need to replace it and re-create the whole volume. All data will be lost. See page
387 for how to install or replace a hard drive.
• Down when a volume is down and can not be fixed.
A down RAID volume cannot be used until you repair or replace the faulty disk(s) in the volume. Degraded means one of the disks in the RAID volume is not
NSA210 User’s Guide
181
Chapter 7 Storage available but the volume can still be used. For a degraded volume, you should replace the faulty disk as soon as possible to obtain previous performance. See your Quick Start Guide for more information on replacing a disk.
If it’s down, then the only indication is that you can no longer transfer files to/from the shares in the down volume.
Note: There is no explicit message from CIFS that tells users their volume is degraded or down.
7.5.4 Volumes and RAID
Note: Back up your data before deleting or re-creating a volume!
If you originally have one disk configured as JBOD, and you then install another disk and want to configure the two disks to use RAID 1, you should first back up all your data on the two disks (see the Memeo Autobackup utility on the included
CD) and then restore your data later after you create the new volume type.
Below is a table that summarizes some attributes of RAID 1 as supported on the
NSA. For capacity and storage efficiency, “S” is the size of the smallest drive in the array, and “N” is the number of drives in the array.
Performance rankings are approximations.
Table 26 RAID 1 Quick Overview
RAID Level 1
Number of Disks
Capacity
Storage
Efficiency
Fault Tolerance
Availability
Read
Performance
Write
Performance
2
S*N/2
50%
YYYY
YYYY
YYY
YYY
7.5.5 Disk Replacement Restrictions
Note: If you’re using RAID 1 and the hard disk inside the NSA fails but the eSATA hard disk is still working, you can remove the hard disk inside the NSA and install the eSATA hard disk inside the NSA. Your NSA runs normally again, but you will need to have another eSATA hard disk attached to the NSA in order to employ RAID 1.
182
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 7 Storage
See the Quick Start Guide for information on replacing disks in the NSA. When replacing a disk in a degraded or down RAID volume, the new disk must be at least the same size or bigger than the other disks that are already in the RAID volume, so as all data in the volume can be restored.
For example, if you have RAID with 250 GB disks, you must put in a 250 GB or bigger disk as a replacement in order to restore all original data in that volume. If you put a bigger disk, the extra space on the disk will not be used.
Note: The NSA automatically repairs a degraded RAID if you insert an empty disk without an existing file system. Otherwise, when you replace a disk you must go to the Storage > Internal Volume > RAID screen, select the degraded array, and click Repair.
Resynchronizing or Recovering a RAID 1 Volume
Resynchronizing or recovering a RAID 1 volume that was down is done block-byblock, so the time it takes depends more on the size of your hard drive(s) than the amount of data you have on them.
Note: Do not restart the NSA while the NSA is resynchronizing or recovering a volume as this will cause the synchronization to begin again after the NSA fully reboots.
You can access data on a RAID volume while it is resychronizing or recovering, but it is not recommended.
7.5.6 External Disks
You may connect USB storage devices that support the following file systems to the NSA.
• Windows File Systems: NTFS, FAT32 and FAT16.
• Linux File Systems: ReiserFS, EXT2, EXT3, and XFS.
NSA210 User’s Guide
183
Chapter 7 Storage
184
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
8
Network
8.1 Overview
This chapter discusses the network configuration screens. The Network screens allow you to configure TCP/IP and PPPoE settings for the NSA.
8.2 What You Can Do
• Use the TCP/IP screen (
) to assign the NSA a dynamic or static IP address and DNS information.
• Use UPnP port mapping (
Section 8.5 on page 190 ) to automatically configure
your Internet gateway’s firewall and Network Address Translation (NAT) to allow access to the NSA from the Internet.
• Use the PPPoE screen ( Section 8.6 on page 194 ) to configure PPPoE settings for
a direct Internet connection.
8.3 What You Need to Know
IP Address
The NSA needs an IP address to communicate with other devices on your network.
The NSA can get an IP address automatically if you have a device on your network that gives them out. Or you can assign the NSA a static (fixed) IP address.
DNS Server Address
A DNS (Domain Name System) server maps domain names (like www.zyxel.com) to their corresponding numerical IP addresses. This lets you use domain names to access web sites without having to know their IP addresses. The NSA can receive the IP address of a DNS server automatically (along with the NSA’s own IP address). You can also manually enter a DNS server IP address in the NSA.
185
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 8 Network
PPPoE
Point-to-Point Protocol over Ethernet (PPPoE) allows the NSA to establish a direct
Internet connection if you do not have a router. PPPoE is a dial-up connection. You need a username and password from your Internet Service Provider (ISP) to set up the connection.
Jumbo Frames
Jumbo frames are Ethernet frames larger than 1500 bytes. They enable data transfer with less overhead. The bigger the frame, the better the network performance. Your network equipment such as computers, switches and routers must be capable of supporting jumbo frames. You also need to enable jumbo frames in all related network devices.
To use jumbo frames, your LAN must support 1 Gbps transmissions (Gigabit
Ethernet). All of your network devices (computer Ethernet cards and switches, hubs, or routers) must also support the same size of jumbo frames that you specify in the NSA.
Note: If you enable jumbo frames on the NSA in a network that does not support them, you will lose access to the NSA. If this occurs, you will have to restore the factory default configuration. Push the RESET button on the NSA’s rear panel and release it after you hear a beep.
186
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 8 Network
In the following example, the NSA has jumbo frames enabled and set to 8KB frames. This means the computer, notebook computer, and switch must also have jumbo frames enabled and be capable of supporting 8KB frames.
Figure 85 Jumbo Frames
8.4 The TCP/IP Screen
Use the TCP/IP screen to have the NSA use a dynamic or static IP address, subnet mask, default gateway and DNS servers.
Click Network > TCP/IP in the navigation panel to open the following screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
187
Chapter 8 Network
Note: If you change the NSA’s IP address, you need to log in again after you apply changes.
Figure 86 Network > TCP/IP
188
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 27 Network > TCP/IP
LABEL
IP Address
Dynamic
DESCRIPTION
Select this option to have the NSA get IP address information automatically.
Static
If no IP address information is assigned, the NSA uses Auto-IP to assign itself an IP address and subnet mask. For example, you could connect the NSA directly to your computer. If the computer is also set to get an IP address automatically, the computer and the NSA will choose addresses for themselves and be able to communicate.
Select this option for the NSA to use fixed TCP/IP information. You must fill in the following fields.
IP Address Type an IP address in this field.
IP Subnet Mask Type an IP subnet mask in this field.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 8 Network
Table 27 Network > TCP/IP (continued)
LABEL
Default
Gateway
DESCRIPTION
Type a default gateway address in this field.
DNS
Dynamic
Static
DNS (Domain Name System) is for mapping a domain name to its corresponding IP address and vice versa. If you have the IP address(es) of the DNS server(s), enter them.
Select the option to have the NSA get a DNS server address automatically.
Select this option to choose a static DNS server address. Type the
DNS server IP address(es) into the fields below.
Primary DNS
Server
Secondary
DNS Server
Type a primary DNS server IP address.
Type a secondary DNS server IP address.
HTTP (Web Configurator)
Enable Another
Web Configuration
Port
Jumbo Frames
Select this to configure an additional HTTP port for accessing the Web
Configurator. Specify a number in the Port Number field.
Jumbo frames improve network performance. You must have a 1
Gbps (Gigabit Ethernet) network that supports jumbo frames. Select the largest size of frame that all of your network devices (including computer Ethernet cards and switches, hubs, or routers) support.
When enabled, you can choose between 4 KB, 8 KB, and 9 KB frame sizes.
Network
Diagnostic Tool
Apply
Reset
Note: If you enable jumbo frames on the NSA in a network that does not support them, you will lose access to the NSA. If this occurs, you will have to restore the factory default configuration. Push the RESET button on the NSA’s rear panel and release it after you hear a beep.
Use this section to test the network connection to a particular IP address or domain name. Select an address or type it into the field.
Then click Ping to have the NSA send a packet to test the network connection.
• Successfully pinged host - The NSA is able to “ping” the host, the network connection is OK.
• Unable to ping host - The NSA is able to “ping” the selected host.
Click this to save your TCP/IP configurations. After you click Apply, the NSA restarts. Wait until you see the Login screen or until the
NSA fully boots and then use the NAS Starter Utility to rediscover it.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
189
Chapter 8 Network
8.5 UPnP Port Mapping Screen
Use UPnP (Universal Plug and Play) port mapping to allow access from the WAN to services you select on the NSA. It is recommended that you place the NSA behind an Internet gateway firewall device to protect the NSA from attacks from the
Internet (see
RAID 1 and Data Protection on page 181 for firewall type
suggestions). Many such Internet gateways use UPnP to simplify peer-to-peer network connectivity between devices. UPnP can automatically configure the
Internet gateway’s firewall and Network Address Translation (NAT) to allow access to the NSA from the Internet.
Figure 87 UPnP for FTP Access
192.168.1.20
a.b.c.d
TCP: 21
TCP: 21
In the above example, UPnP creates a firewall rule and NAT port forwarding mapping to send FTP traffic (using TCP port number 21) from the public IP address a.b.c.d to the NSA’s private IP address of 192.168.1.20.
Use the NSA’s UPnP Port Mapping screen to configure the UPnP settings your
Internet gateway uses to allow access from the WAN (Internet) to services you select on the NSA. You can also set which port Internet users need to use in order to access a specific service on the NSA.
Note: To use UPnP port mapping, your Internet gateway must have UPnP enabled.
If your Internet gateway supports Port Address Translation (PAT is sometimes included with a port forwarding feature), you can have the Internet users use a different TCP port number from the one the NSA uses for the service.
Figure 88 UPnP Port Address Translation for FTP Example
192.168.1.20
a.b.c.d
TCP: 21
TCP: 2100
In the above example, the Internet gateway uses PAT to accept Internet user FTP sessions on port 2100, translate them to port 21, and forward them to the NSA.
190
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 8 Network
8.5.1 UPnP and the NSA’s IP Address
It is recommended that the NSA use a static IP address (or a static DHCP IP address) if you will allow access to the NSA from the Internet. The UPnP-created
NAT mappings keep the IP address the NSA had when you applied your settings in the UPnP Port Mapping screen. They do not automatically update if the NSA’s IP address changes.
Note: WAN access stops working if the NSA’s IP address changes.
For example, if the NSA’s IP address was 192.168.1.33 when you applied the
UPnP Port Mapping screen’s settings and the NSA later gets a new IP address of
192.168.1.34 through DHCP, WAN access stops working because the Internet gateway still tries to forward traffic to IP address 192.168.1.33. Since you can no longer access the NSA from the WAN, you would have to access the NSA from the
LAN and re-apply your UPnP Port Mapping screen settings to update the
Internet gateway’s UPnP port mappings.
Figure 89 UPnP Using the Wrong IP Address
192.168.1.34
a.b.c.d
192.168.1.33
8.5.2 UPnP and Security
UPnP’s automated nature makes it easier to use than manually configuring firewall and NAT rules, but it is also less secure. Using UPnP may make your network more susceptible to snooping and hacking attacks.
8.5.3 The NSA’s Services and UPnP
This section introduces the NSA’s services which an Internet gateway can use
UPnP to allow access to from the Internet.
BitTorrent
BitTorrent is a distributed peer-to-peer file-sharing protocol that the NSA’s download service can use. Using UPnP port mapping for BitTorrent lets BitTorrent work faster.
NSA210 User’s Guide
191
Chapter 8 Network
CIFS (Windows File Sharing)
Common Internet File System (CIFS) is a standard protocol supported by most operating systems in order to share files across the network. Using UPnP port mapping for CIFS allows users to connect from the Internet and use programs like
Windows Explorer to access the NSA’s shares to copy files from the NSA, delete files on the NSA, or upload files to the NSA from the Internet.
If you configure UPnP port mapping to allow CIFS access from the WAN but cannot get it to work, you may also have to configure the Internet gateway to also allow
NetBIOS traffic. See
for more on CIFS.
FTP
File Transfer Protocol is a standard file transfer service used on the Internet. Using
UPnP port mapping for FTP allows remote users to use FTP from the Internet to access the NSA’s shares. A user with read and write access to a share can copy files from the share, delete files from the share, or upload files to the share. See
for more on FTP. If you use UPnP to allow FTP access from the WAN, you may want to use a different WAN port number (instead of the default of port 21) to make it more secure. Remember to tell the remote users to use the custom port number when using FTP to access the NSA.
HTTP (Web Configurator)
You can use UPnP port mapping to allow access to the NSA’s management screens. If you use UPnP to allow Web Configurator access from the WAN, you may want to use a different WAN port number (instead of the default of port 80) to make it more secure. Remember to use the custom port number when accessing the NSA’s Web Configurator from the Internet.
HTTP (Web Published Shares)
This is the NSA’s web publishing feature that lets people access files using a web browser without having to log into the Home screens. Use UPnP port mapping to allow access to these files from the Internet without having to enter a user name or password. See
for more on web publishing.
8.5.4 Configuring UPnP Port Mapping
Click Network > UPnP > Port Mapping to display the UPnP Port Mapping screen.
Use this screen to set how the Internet gateway’s UPnP feature configure’s the
Internet gateway’s NAT IP address mapping and port mapping settings. These settings allow Internet users connected to the Internet gateway’s WAN interface to
192
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 8 Network access services on the NSA. You can set which port Internet users need to use to access a specific service on the NSA.
Note: Some Internet gateways will delete all UPnP mappings after reboot. So if the
Internet gateway reboots, you may need to use this screen again to re-apply the
UPnP port mapping.
Figure 90 Network > UPnP > Port Mapping
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 28 Network > UPnP > Port Mapping
LABEL
LAN
Service Name
LAN Port
WAN
Service Name
DESCRIPTION
Use these fields to specify what port the Internet gateway uses to connect from its LAN port to the service on the NSA.
This read-only field identifies a service on the NSA.
Specify the port number (1~65,536) the Internet gateway needs to use to connect from its LAN port to the service on the NSA. This is the NSA’s internal port number for the service. Changing a service’s port number in this screen also changes it in other NSA screens that display it.
Similarly, changing a service’s port number in another NSA screen also changes it here.
The number below this icon is your Internet gateway’s WAN IP address
(the IP address your Internet gateway uses for connecting to the
Internet).
Use these fields to specify what port Internet users must use to connect to the Internet gateway’s WAN port in order to connect to the service on the NSA.
This read-only field identifies a service on the NSA.
NSA210 User’s Guide
193
Chapter 8 Network
Table 28 Network > UPnP > Port Mapping (continued)
LABEL
Enable WAN
Access
DESCRIPTION
Select this check box to have UPnP configure your Internet gateway to allow access from the Internet to the NSA’s service.
WAN Port
If you clear this check box, people will not be able to access the NSA’s service from the Internet unless you manually configure the Internet gateway’s firewall and NAT rules to allow access.
When you enable WAN access for one of the NSA’s services, specify the port number (1~65,536) Internet uses need to use to connect to the
Internet gateway’s WAN port in order to access the service on the NSA.
Whoever wants to access a service on the NSA from the Internet must use this port number.
Apply
Reset
BitTorrent’s WAN port must be the same as the LAN port.
Make sure there is not another service using TCP protocol with the same
port number. See Appendix C on page 459 for a list of common services
and their associated protocols and port numbers.
If another device is using the same port (the Internet gateway has the same port number mapped to another LAN IP address), the NSA overwrites it when you apply the setting and WAN users can no longer access the other device.
This icon means the service’s LAN and WAN port numbers must be the same.
This icon means another service is using the same port number as this service. Change the port number of one of the services so they use different port numbers.
This icon means another service is using the listed port, but the port the other service is using will be replaced if you apply the setting. The other service will no longer be accessible from the listed port.
Click Apply to save your changes back to the NSA.
Click Reset to begin configuring this screen afresh.
8.6 The PPPoE Screen
Use this screen to configure PPPoE settings for a direct Internet connection.
194
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 8 Network
Click Network > PPPoE in the navigation panel to open the following screen.
Figure 91 Network > PPPoE
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 29 Network > PPPoE
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Status
Status
IP Address
This field displays the status of PPPoE connection.
This field displays the IP address of your PPPoE connection.
IP Subnet Mask This field displays the IP subnet mask of your PPPoE connection.
Configuration
Enable PPPoE
Connection
Username
Select this option to establish a direct Internet connection for the NSA.
You need to enter the username and password as given by your ISP.
Enter the username exactly as your ISP assigned. If assigned a name in the form user@domain where domain identifies a service name, then enter both components exactly as given.
Password
Password
(Confirm)
Apply
Reset
Enter the password associated with the username above.
Retype the password for confirmation.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore previously saved settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
195
Chapter 8 Network
196
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
9
Applications
9.1 Overview
This chapter discusses the features in the Application screens. The NSA contains various applications for file sharing and downloading.
9.2 What You Can Do
• Use the FTP Server screen (
Section 9.4 on page 200 ) to configure settings for
FTP file transfers to/from the NSA.
• Use the Media Server screen ( Section 9.5 on page 202 ) to share files with
media clients.
• Use the Download Service screen ( Section 9.6 on page 206
) to download files from the Internet.
• Use the Web Publishing screen ( Section 9.7 on page 219 ) to publish shares
for people to access files using a web browser.
• Use the Broadcatching screen (
Section 9.8 on page 221 ) to download
frequently updated digital content like TV programs, radio talk shows, Podcasts
(audio files), and blogs.
• Use the Print Server screen (
) to share a printer.
• Use the Copy/Sync Button screen ( Section 9.10 on page 231 ) to transfer files
between a USB device and the NSA.
• Use the Package screen (
) to set up additional applications in your NSA. The NSA can download multiple packages/files at once and automatically goes through all the installation steps.
• Use the Auto Upload screens (
) to upload files in selected shares to your Flickr and/or YouTube accounts.
197
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
9.3 What You Need to Know
FTP
File Transfer Protocol (FTP) is a file transfer service that operates on the Internet.
A system running the FTP server accepts commands from a system running an
FTP client. FTP is not a secure protocol. Your file transfers could be subject to snooping.
FTPES (File Transfer Protocol over Explicit TLS/SSL)
File Transfer Protocol over Explicit TLS/SSL (FTPES) is a file transfer service that uses either TLS (Transport Layer Security) or SSL (Secure Sockets Layer) for secure transfers across the Internet. It requests for a mutual method of encryption from the FTP server for its file transfer sessions. Your FTP client must be set to use FTPES as in the following example.
Figure 92 FTP Client Example
198
Media Server
The media server feature lets anyone on your network play video, music, and photos from the NSA (without having to copy them to another computer). The
NSA can function as a DLNA-compliant media server and/or an iTunes server. The
NSA streams files to DLNA-compliant media clients or computers using iTunes. The
Digital Living Network Alliance (DLNA) is a group of personal computer and electronics companies that works to make products compatible in a home network.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
iTunes Server
The NSA iTunes server feature lets you use Apple’s iTunes software on a computer to play music and video files stored on the NSA. You can download iTunes from www.apple.com.
Download Service
The NSA’s download service downloads files from the Internet directly to the NSA.
You do not have to download to your computer and then copy to the NSA. This can free up your computer’s system resources.
The NSA can download using these protocols.
• HTTP: The standard protocol for web pages.
• FTP: A standard Internet file transfer service.
• BitTorrent: A popular distributed peer-to-peer files sharing protocol.
BitTorrent
The NSA includes a BitTorrent client for fast downloading and sharing of large files
(such as educational public domain videos). With BitTorrent, you share while you’re downloading the file. BitTorrent breaks up the file and distributes it in hundreds of chunks. You start sharing the file as soon as you have downloaded a single chunk.
Web Publishing
Web publishing lets you “publish” shares (containing folders and files) on the NSA so people can access the files using a web browser without having to log into the
Home screens. This way you can share files with others without them having to know and enter a username and password.
For example, if you want to share photos in a FamilyPhotos share, you could “web publish” it and others could use a web browser to access the photos at http://my-
NSA’s-IP-Address/MyWeb/FamilyPhotos.
Broadcatching
Broadcatching is the downloading of digital content from Internet feeds. Use broadcatching to have the NSA download frequently updated digital content like
TV programs, radio shows, podcasts (audio files), and blogs.
NSA210 User’s Guide
199
Chapter 9 Applications
RSS
RSS (Really Simple Syndication) is a format for delivering frequently updated digital content. A channel uses a feed to deliver its contents (items). Subscribe the
NSA to a feed to be able to download the contents.
9.4 FTP Server
Use FTP or FTPES (FTP over Explicit TTL/SSL) to upload files to the NSA and download files from the NSA. Click Applications > FTP to open the following screen.
Figure 93 Applications > FTP
200
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 30 Applications > FTP
LABEL
FTP
Enable FTP
DESCRIPTION
You can use FTP to send files to the NSA or get files from the NSA.
Select this check box to allow users to connect to the NSA via FTP; otherwise clear the check box.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 30 Applications > FTP
LABEL
Connection
Limit
Idle Timeout
Port Number
Enable
Anonymous FTP
Access
DESCRIPTION
Enter the maximum number of concurrent FTP connections allowed on the NSA in this field. The connection limit is 20.
Enter the length of time that an FTP connection can be idle before timing out. The timeout limit is 300 minutes.
This is the port number used by the NSA for FTP traffic.
Select this check box to allow any user to log into the NSA using ‘FTP’ or ‘anonymous’ as a username and no password. Any other name is considered a username, so must be valid and have a corresponding correct password.
Select this check box to assign a port range for FTP clients to use when downloading files from the NSA using passive mode.
Customize the port range for data transfer
Starting Port
Ending Port
Download/Upload
Rate For All Users
(include admin)
The connection limit is restricted to half of the port numbers within the range if this value is smaller than the one configured in the
Connection Limit field. For example, you specified a port range from 1024 to 1029 and configured 10 in the Connection Limit field.
The FTP connection limit will only be 3 (6 ports in the range divided by 2) because it is the smaller value.
Enter the first port number in the range. Choose from 1024 to 65535.
Enter the last port number in the range. Choose from 1024 to 65535.
Select this if you want to limit the download/upload bandwidth for all users who are logged into the NSA, including the administrator.
Download/Upload
Rate For
Anonymous Users
• Max. Download Rate - Enter the download speed (in kilobytes/ s) that the NSA allows for users who are logged into the NSA.
• Max. Upload Rate - Enter the upload speed (in kilobytes/s) that the NSA allows for users who are logged into the NSA.
Select this if you want to limit the download/upload bandwidth for users who log into the NSA using ‘FTP’ or ‘anonymous’ as a username and no password.
Character Set
• Max. Download Rate - Enter the download speed (in kilobytes/ s) that the NSA allows for users who are logged into the NSA.
• Max. Upload Rate - Enter the upload speed (in kilobytes/s) that the NSA allows for users who are logged into the NSA.
The NSA uses UTF-8 (8-bit UCS/Unicode Transformation Format) format for FTP by default. If the NSA’s folders, or file names do not display correctly in your FTP client, select the appropriate language encoding here.
Apply
Reset
This setting applies to all FTP client connections to the NSA. It does not affect your Windows/CIFS connections (it will not correct the character display in Windows Explorer).
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
201
Chapter 9 Applications
9.5 The Media Server Screen
The media server application allows you to share files with media clients.
Click Applications > Media Server to open the following screen. Use this screen to view the media server’s status and rebuild the media server database.
Figure 94 Applications > Media Server > Media Server
202
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 31 Applications > Media Server > Media Server
LABEL
Status
DESCRIPTION
This shows the media server’s current state of activity.
Synchronizing displays while the NSA is building the media database.
Ready means the NSA has finished building the database.
Stopped displays when the media server is dead and for a short time while the media server is restarted before rebuilding the database.
Number of Music
Tracks
This is how many music files the media server has to share out to media clients.
Number of Photos This is how many photo files the media server has to share out to media clients.
Number of Videos This is how many video files the media server has to share out to media clients.
Refresh Click this to update the information in the Status field.
Rebuild Database Click this if the media clients cannot see the files in the media server.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
9.5.1 The Media Server Share Publish Screen
Click Applications > Media Server > Share Publish to open the following screen. Use this screen to select shares to publish (share with media clients like the DMA-2500 and iTunes).
Figure 95 Applications > Media Server > Share Publish
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 32 Applications > Media Server > Share Publish
LABEL
Publish
Share Name
Publish Music
Tracks
Publish Photos
Publish Videos
Apply
Reset
DESCRIPTION
Select this to have the media server share a share’s media files with media clients.
This column lists names of shares on the NSA.
Select this to give media clients access to the share’s music files.
Select this to give media clients access to the share’s photo files.
Select this to give media clients access to the share’s video files.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
9.5.2 The Media Server ID3 Tag Decoding Screen
Click Applications > Media Server > ID3 Tag Decoding to open the following screen. ID3 tags store information about a media file such as the title, artist, album, and genre in the file itself. To help the NSA find the correct character set to decode these tags, use this screen to select which character sets the NSA attempts to use and the order the NSA tries them in.
NSA210 User’s Guide
203
Chapter 9 Applications
Note: It may take some time for the media server to rebuild the database after you change the ID3 tag character set settings. How long it takes depends on how many media files you have. Some of the media files may not appear in the
Home screens until the rebuilding finishes.
Figure 96 Applications > Media Server > ID3 Tag Decoding
204
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 33 Applications > Media Server > ID3 Tag Decoding
LABEL
Media Server
Available
Character Sets
Add Selected
Character Sets
DESCRIPTION
This list box displays the language character sets the NSA can perform.
Select types of character set in the Available Character Sets box and click this to add them to the list of character sets that the NSA should attempt to use to decode ID3 tags in your media files. Use the
[SHIFT] key to select a range of entries. Hold down the [CTRL] key to select multiple individual entries.
Selected
Character Sets
Remove Selected
Character Sets
Apply
Reset
If the NSA is not able to decode a file’s ID3 tags using the selected character sets, it attempts to auto-detect their encoding type.
This list box displays the character sets the NSA can use to decode
ID3 tags in your media files. The NSA attempts to use them in the order listed so select character sets and use the up or down arrow to change their order to match the types of files you have. So if most of your files are German, move the French, German and Italian
(ISO-8859-15) selection to the top of the list.
If the NSA cannot find a match among your selected character sets
(or you have not selected any character sets) it tries to auto-detect which character set the tags are encoded with.
Select character sets in the Selected Character Sets box and click this to have the NSA not attempt to use them to decode ID3 tags in your media files. Use the [SHIFT] key to select a range of entries.
Hold down the [CTRL] key to select multiple individual entries.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
9.5.3 The Media Server iTunes Server Screen
Click Applications > Media Server > iTunes Server to open the following screen. Use this screen to turn the iTunes server on or off.
Figure 97 Applications > Media Server > iTunes Server
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 34 Applications > Media Server > iTunes Server
LABEL
Enable iTunes
Server
Apply
Reset
DESCRIPTION
Check this to let anyone on your network use iTunes to play music files in the published shares.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
9.5.4 The Media Server SqueezeCenter Screen
SqueezeCenter enables you to manage a Logitech's Squeezebox device connected to the NSA.
Click Applications > Media Server > SqueezeCenter to open the following screen. This screen is available when the SqueezeCenter application is installed using Package Management (see
). Use this screen to turn the SqueezeCenter application on or off.
Figure 98 Applications > Media Server > SqueezeCenter
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 35 Applications > Media Server > SqueezeCenter
LABEL
Enable
SqueezeCenter
Apply
Reset
DESCRIPTION
Check this to enable SqueezeCenter.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
205
Chapter 9 Applications
9.6 The Download Service Screen
The Download Service screen allows you to download files from the Internet.
Click Applications > Download Service to open the following screen. Use this screen to manage the NSA’s file downloads.
Note: By default, the NSA saves downloads in the admin share’s download folder.
Figure 99 Applications > Download Service
206
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 36 Applications > Download Service
LABEL
Enable Download
Service
Enable Download
Notify
DESCRIPTION
Use this option (and click the Apply button) to turn the download service off or on. If you turn off the service, all downloads are paused. Files currently downloading are queued. Turning on the download service resumes downloads (or restarts them if they are not able to resume).
Use this option (and click the Apply button) to turn the download
service notification off or on. See Section 9.11.4 on page 235
for more details about this feature.
This RSS feed icon displays when you select and apply the Enable
Download Notify option. At the time of writing, the NSA supports
RSS 2.0 feeds.
Add
Preferences
Refresh
Click this to get and subscribe to the NSA channel feed. This enables you to keep track and download the NSA’s new contents (items).
After you find a file to download, copy the file’s URL. Then log into the
NSA Web Configurator and go to the Applications > Download
Server screen and click this button. A screen opens where you create a new download task. You can paste the file’s URL or use a BitTorrent file.
Click this to open a screen where you can set the default location for saving downloads and configure your BitTorrent settings.
Click this to update the information displayed on the screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 36 Applications > Download Service (continued)
LABEL
Delete
DESCRIPTION
To delete download tasks (or manually clear out completed download tasks), select a download task and click this to remove it from the list. A pop-up screen asks you to confirm. Click Apply to delete or
Cancel to quit. When you delete a download task, you are given the option to delete the associated files. Selecting this option deletes a downloaded file and in the case of a BitTorrent download task, also deletes the related .torrent file.
Pause
Resume
Use your keyboard’s [SHIFT] key to select a range of download tasks.
Use the [CTRL] key and click individual download tasks to select multiple individual download tasks.
Select a downloading item and click this to temporarily stop the download. Paused downloads appear in the Download Service screen’s Inactive tab.
Use your keyboard’s [SHIFT] key to select a range of download tasks.
Use the [CTRL] key and click individual download tasks to select multiple individual download tasks.
Select a paused item and click this to continue downloading the file.
Select a completed item and click this to re-seed a torrent file or download a file again. If you want to re-seed a BitTorrent task, keep the torrent file and the completed file in their original locations.
Task Info
The table lists your downloads. Click a column’s heading to sort the entries by that criteria.
Active
Select an item on the list and click this to display information about the download task. See
Section 9.6.5 on page 218 for more details.
Click this to see the list of files the NSA is currently downloading or sharing with other BitTorrent users. The NSA handles a maximum of
10 active tasks at a time (or fewer depending on how much of the
NSA’s system memory is available). If you add more, they appear in the Inactive tab.
Inactive
Completed
Error
BitTorrent downloads may appear in the Inactive tab for a while before showing in the Downloading tab. The NSA automatically moves completed tasks to the Completed tab.
Click this to see the list of files that are queued (waiting in line) for the NSA to download or the downloads that have been manually paused.
Click this to see the list of files that the NSA has finished downloading.
The Location column shows where a downloaded file is saved on the
NSA. Click on the location link to open the share browser and access the file.
Click this to see the list of files that the NSA was not able to download. The NSA automatically retries unsuccessful download attempts. The download displays in the error tab when the reattempts are also unsuccessful and the NSA stops trying to download the file. To try the download again, use the Add button to create a new download task.
NSA210 User’s Guide
207
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 36 Applications > Download Service (continued)
LABEL
Status
DESCRIPTION
The following icons show the download’s status.
Completed: The NSA has downloaded the whole file.
Seeding: The download is finished and the NSA is allowing other
BitTorrent users to download it.
Downloading: The NSA is getting the file.
Queued: The download is waiting in line for the NSA to download it.
Pause: The download has been manually stopped. Select it and click
Resume to continue it.
Name
Error: The NSA was not able to complete the download. Select it and click Resume to reattempt the download.
This identifies the download file. A “...” indicates an abbreviated name. Hold your cursor over the name to display the full name.
Complete (%) This is the percentage of the file that the NSA has downloaded.
Location This appears in the Completed tab.
Seeds
It displays the path for where the file is saved. Click on the location link to open the share browser and access the file.
Seeds apply to BitTorrent downloads. This is the number of computers that are sharing the complete file that you are downloading.
Peers
This value is in the format “Leeches(Seeds)” where Leeches refer to peers that do not have a complete copy of the file yet and are still downloading; Seeds refer to peers that have the complete file.
Peers apply to BitTorrent downloads. This is the number of other computers that are also downloading (and sharing) the file you are downloading.
This value is in the format “ConnectedPeers(AllPeers)[Health]” where
Connected Peers is the number of computers to which the NSA is connected in order to download the file; AllPeers refer to the total number of computers to which the NSA can connect in order to download the file; Health indicates the availability of the file.
This is how fast the NSA is getting the file. Download
Speed
It is normal for a BitTorrent download to start out with a slow download speed since it has to set up numerous connections. The speed should increase as the download progresses and decrease near the end of the download.
Upload Speed This is how fast the NSA is sending the file to other BitTorrent users.
Time Left This is how much longer (in hours, minutes, and seconds) it should take to finish the download at the current download speed.
208
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 36 Applications > Download Service (continued)
LABEL
Priority
Error Code
DESCRIPTION
This is the download’s priority on the NSA. You can set a currently downloading or queued download to high or automatic priority. You can set a download to high priority to have the NSA try to download it before the other files. However the actual download speed depends more on factors like the speed of you Internet connection, the speed of the download source’s Internet connection, how many others are trying to download at the same time, the peers and seeds available and general network conditions.
This appears in the Error tab.
This shows the tag for the error that occurred.
Error Message This appears in the Error tab.
This message states what went wrong with the download.
9.6.1 Adding a Download Task
Click Applications > Download Service > Add to open the following screen.
Use this screen to specify a file for the NSA to download. Section 4.9 on page 103
provides a tutorial on adding a download task.
Figure 100 Applications > Download Service > Add
NSA210 User’s Guide
209
Chapter 9 Applications
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 37 Applications > Download Service > Add
LABEL
Source
URL
DESCRIPTION
Paste the URL of the file you want to download into this field. The URL can be for an HTTP, FTP, or BitTorrent download.
For a BitTorrent download, you can copy and paste the URL of the
.torrent file. The NSA will automatically download the .torrent file and use it. You do not have to manually download the .torrent file or save it to your computer.
Note: Make sure the link opens either the file you want or a popup window about how to handle the file.
Torrent File
Location of
Downloaded Files
It is also OK for the link to open a .torrent file. If you are redirected to a screen that says the download should start in a few seconds, there may be a link to click if the download does not start automatically.
See if that link opens the file or the pop-up window.
A “torrent” file has information the NSA uses to do a BitTorrent download. A torrent file uses a .torrent extension. If you already have a torrent file saved on your computer, select the Torrent File option and specify its path or click Browse and look for its location.
This shows where the NSA stores new downloads (Put incomplete
downloads in) and where the NSA moves completed downloads
(Move completed downloads to).
The Share column shows the name of the share where the file is downloaded.
The Path column points to the location in the share where the NSA will save the downloaded files.
• BitTorrent jobs are stored in /*/incoming (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• HTTP/FTP jobs are stored in /* (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• All jobs triggered by RSS channels create the subfolder in /* using the channel name where it store all files downloaded from that channel (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
210
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 37 Applications > Download Service > Add
LABEL
Edit
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open the following screen where you can set the default folder location where you “Put incomplete downloads in” and
“Move complete downloads to”:.
• Share - Select the share from the list.
• Path - Type the folder location in the share directly or click
Browse to open the following screen and navigate to the file’s location.
Apply
Cancel
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
to create
• Type - This identifies the item as a folder or file.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
211
Chapter 9 Applications
9.6.2 Configuring General Settings
Click Applications > Download Service > Preferences to open the following screen. Use this screen to set the default location for saving downloads and configure the download period.
Figure 101 Applications > Download Service > Preferences > General Settings
212
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 38 Applications > Download Service > Preferences > General Settings
LABEL
Location of
Downloaded Files
DESCRIPTION
This shows where the NSA stores new downloads (Put incomplete
downloads in) and where the NSA moves completed downloads
(Move completed downloads to).
Edit
The Share column shows the name of the share where the file is downloaded.
The Path column points to the location in the share where the NSA will save the downloaded files.
• BitTorrent jobs are stored in /*/incoming (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• HTTP/FTP jobs are stored in /* (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• All jobs triggered by RSS channels create the subfolder in /* using the channel name where it store all files downloaded from that channel (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
Click this to open the following screen where you can set the default folder location where you “Put incomplete downloads in” and
“Move complete downloads to”:.
• Share - Select the share from the list.
• Path - Type the folder location in the share directly or click
Browse to open the following screen and navigate to the file’s location.
NSA210 User’s Guide
213
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 38 Applications > Download Service > Preferences > General Settings
LABEL DESCRIPTION
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
to create
• Type - This identifies the item as a file or folder.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Download Period
Control
Enable Download
Period Control
Download Service is active in the time period
(hh:mm - hh:mm)
Apply
Reset
Cancel
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
This feature sets the NSA to download files only within a specified time period.
Use the check box to turn the download period control on or off.
Specify the time period for the NSA to download files.
Note: If you also configured the Power On/Off Schedule feature in the Power Management screen, make sure your active download period does not conflict with the power-off period.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
214
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
9.6.3 Configuring the BitTorrent Settings
Click Applications > Download Service > Preferences > BitTorrent to open the following screen. Use this screen to configure BitTorrent settings.
Figure 102 Applications > Download Service > Preferences > BitTorrent
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 39 Applications > Download Service > Preferences > BitTorrent
LABEL
Port Number
DESCRIPTION
Assign a port number for BitTorrent downloads. You can select a number from 2 to 65536. It is recommended to use a port number greater than 1025.
Max. download rate
You may need to limit the bandwidth the NSA uses for BitTorrent downloads if your network’s other Internet applications are not getting enough downstream bandwidth. 0 has the NSA impose no restriction.
Max. upload rate You may need to limit the bandwidth the NSA uses to share files through BitTorrent if your network’s other Internet applications are not getting enough upstream bandwidth. 0 has the NSA impose no restriction.
If you do not allow any uploads, (for example, you set a limit of 1 KB/ s) you will not have a good standing in the BitTorrent community.
Maximum
Number of Active
Torrents
Maximum
Number of
Seeding Jobs
Note: The settings for maximum download/upload rates would not affect peers accessing the NSA from the same LAN.
Specify how many simultaneous BitTorrent downloads are allowed on the NSA. You can enter a number from 1 to 10.
Specify how many simultaneous seeds are allowed on the NSA. Enter a number from 1 to 10. This value cannot exceed the one you configured in the Maximum Number of Active Torrents field.
NSA210 User’s Guide
215
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 39 Applications > Download Service > Preferences > BitTorrent
LABEL
Maximum
Number of Active
Connections
Keep Sharing
While
DESCRIPTION
Specify how many active connections are allowed on the NSA. Enter a number from 1 to 500. This specifies the number of computers that can connect to the NSA to download files being shared by the NSA.
With BitTorrent, the NSA starts sharing a file while you are downloading it. Set how long to continue sharing a file after the NSA finishes the download.
Edit IP Filter
Apply
Reset
Cancel
Select Upload/Download Ratio to keep sharing a file until the NSA has uploaded a specific percent compared to the download.
Select Seeding Time to keep sharing a file for a specific number of minutes after the download finishes.
Continuing to share a file helps other BitTorrent users finish downloading it. Sharing out at least as much as you download helps keep you in good standing in the BitTorrent community.
Enter -1 to share a file indefinitely. Leave both check boxes blank to have the NSA stop sharing the file as soon as the download finishes.
If you select both options, the NSA keeps sharing a file until both conditions exceed the values you configure. For example, you entered
150% in the Upload/Download Ratio field and 120 minutes in the
Seeding Time field. The NSA keeps sharing a file until it has shared
1.5 times the size of the file and has passed 120 minutes.
Click this to enable or disable IP filtering for BitTorrent downloads.
Refer to
Section 9.6.4 on page 216 for information about the fields in
this screen.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
9.6.4 Edit IP Filter
Use this screen to enable or disable IP filtering for BitTorrent downloads. IP filtering blocks IP addresses known to share fake files. You can either get an IP filter table from a website or use your own table.
216
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Click Edit IP Filter in the Applications > Download Service > Preferences >
BitTorrent screen.
Figure 103 Applications > Download Service > Preferences > BitTorrent > Edit IP
Filter
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 40 Applications > Download Service > Preferences > BitTorrent > Edit IP Filter
LABEL
Enable IP Filter
Update IP
Filter Table File from the
Internet Every
Week
Upload IP
Filter Table
DESCRIPTION
Click this to enable or disable IP filtering for BitTorrent downloads.
Select this option and enter a URL to use an online IP filter table. You can find an online IP filter table in websites such as http:// www.bluetack.co.uk/config/level1.gz.
When you change the URL of the online IP filter table, the NSA also performs an update after you click Apply.
Select this option to upload your own IP filter table. Use the Browse button to locate the file and click Upload to save it on the NSA.
Download Current
IP Filter Table
Apply
Cancel
The NSA supports .txt, .dat, .gz, .tgz, and .tar.gz file extensions. The
NSA saves the IP filter table as /admin/download/ipfilter.dat.
Click this to save a copy of the IP filter table on your computer.
Click Apply to update the IP filter table from the specified URL.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
217
Chapter 9 Applications
9.6.5 Displaying the Task Information
Select an item on the list and click Task Info. Use this screen to check detailed information about the task.
Figure 104 Applications > Download Service > Task Info
218
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 41 Applications > Download Service > Task Info
LABEL
Status
DESCRIPTION
This is the current status of the task.
Name
Size
Uploaded/
Downloaded Ratio
Complete(%)
Seeds
This is the name of the task.
This is the size of the file to be downloaded.
This is the ratio of total uploaded data to downloaded data.
This field displays how much has been downloaded to the NSA.
This is the number of computers that are sharing the complete file that you are downloading.
Peers
Download Speed This field displays how fast the NSA downloads the file.
Upload Speed This field displays how fast the NSA uploads the file.
Health
This is the number of other computers that are also downloading (and sharing) the file you are downloading.
This field displays how many full copies of the file are available for this task. The NSA can download a file with a higher health value more efficiently. If the health value is less than 1 (0.65 for example), there is no full copy of the file, and the NSA may not be able to complete downloading the file.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 41 Applications > Download Service > Task Info
LABEL
Time Left
Priority
DESCRIPTION
This is the time remaining to complete the task.
Use this field to set the priority for downloading the task.
Comment
Start Time
Completed on
Info-Hash
Tracker
Close
Select Auto to have the NSA automatically determine the task’s priority.
Select High to have the NSA download this file before the other files.
Enter a description for this task. Click Apply to save the description.
This field displays when the NSA started to download files.
This field displays when the file was successfully downloaded to the
NSA.
This information is used to verify the torrent file.
This field displays the tracker that NSA is currently connected to. A tracker is a server used for finding peers sharing the file.
Click this to close the screen.
9.7 The Web Publishing Screen
Use this screen to turn web publishing on or off and select shares to publish. Click
Applications > Web Publishing to open the following screen.
Figure 105 Applications > Web Publishing
NSA210 User’s Guide
219
Chapter 9 Applications
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 42 Applications > Web Publishing
LABEL
Web Publishing
DESCRIPTION
Disable / Enable
Web Publishing
Support HTTPS
Port Number
Turn on web publishing to let people access files in the published shares using a web browser, without having to log into the Home screens.
Select this to allow users to use web browser security for connections to the web-published shares. In order to use secured connections users must use “https://” in the NSA’s web address and install the
NSA’s public key certificate.
Specify a port number for accessing the published share websites hosted on the NSA. If you enter a number other than 80, make sure you include it when telling others how to access the web-published share. For example, say you specified port 8080, the NSA’s IP address is 192.168.1.23, and the name of the web-published share is
FamilyPhotos. You would have to enter “http://192.168.1.23:8080/
MyWeb/FamilyPhotos/” in your browser’s address bar to access the share’s web page.
Unpublished
Shares
Publish Selected
Share(s)
This list box displays the shares that the NSA does not publish for web browser access.
Select shares in the Unpublished Shares box and click this to let people access files in the published shares using a web browser, without logging into the Home screens. Use the [SHIFT] key to select a range of entries. Hold down the [CTRL] key to select multiple individual entries.
Published Shares This list box displays the shares people can access using a web browser, without logging into the Home screens.
Unpublish
Selected Share(s)
Select shares in the Published Shares box and click this to not let people access using a web browser without logging into the Home screens. Use the [SHIFT] key to select a range of entries. Hold down the [CTRL] key to select multiple individual entries.
Apply
Reset
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
Note: If you installed php-MySQL-phpMyAdmin through the Package Management screen (
) and enable it, you can use PHP and MySQL
in your published web page.
220
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
9.8 The Broadcatching Screen
This screen displays the NSA’s subscribed channels and the associated contents.
• The NSA saves a channel’s downloaded items in a folder named after the channel.
• The NSA creates the channel folders in the same destination as the download
service. See Section 9.6.2 on page 212 to change the destination for saving
downloads.
• The NSA’s media server feature makes it easy for users on your network to play the broadcatching files you download. See
for more on the media server.
• If you add a channel that contains a torrent file, the NSA downloads the torrent file (.torrent) and transfers it to Download Service (
and start the BitTorrent download task accordingly.
Click Applications > Broadcatching to open the following screen.
Figure 106 Applications > Broadcatching
NSA210 User’s Guide
221
Chapter 9 Applications
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 43 Applications > Broadcatching
LABEL
Add Channel
DESCRIPTION
When you find a channel to subscribe to, copy the URL of the channel’s feed and click this button. A screen opens for you to subscribe to the feed. When you are done, the feed’s channel and contents display in the Applications > Broadcatching screen.
Delete Channel Select a channel and click Delete Channel to remove the channel from the NSA. Any of the channel’s items that you have already downloaded stay in the channel’s folder (in the admin share’s
download folder).
Refresh Channel Select a channel and click Refresh Channel to check for new files.
Edit Channel Select a channel and click Edit Channel to open a screen where you can set the channel’s download and delete policies.
Channel Name This identifies the channel. A channel displays in red if there was an error the last time the NSA attempted to connect to it. When this happens, you can select the channel and click Refresh Channel to have the NSA reattempt to connect to it. Select a channel to see its available files. A “...” indicates an abbreviated name. Hold your cursor over the name to display the full name.
Item Name
The table lists channels and their files. Click a column’s heading to sort the entries by that criteria.
These are the downloadable files. The following icons show the file’s status in the NSA.
Completed: The NSA has downloaded the whole file. Double-click the item to go to the Download Service screen where you can see the file’s name and location.
Seeding: The NSA downloaded the complete file and NSA is sharing it with other BitTorrent users. Double-click the item to go to the
Download Service screen.
Downloading: The NSA is downloading the file. Double-click the item to go to the Download Service screen.
Queued: The file is waiting in line for the NSA to download it. Doubleclick the item to go to the Download Service screen.
Pause: The download has been manually stopped. Double-click the item to go to the Download Service screen.
Missing File: The NSA could not find the file.
Error: The NSA automatically retries unsuccessful download attempts. The status displays as error when the re-attempts are also unsuccessful and the NSA stops trying to download the file. To try the download again, use the Add button to create a new task.
Note: A ... indicates an abbreviated file name. Hold your cursor over the name to display the full name.
222
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 43 Applications > Broadcatching
LABEL
Published
Date
Description
Actions
DESCRIPTION
This is when the file was made available for download.
This is the publishers introduction for the file.
Start Downloading: Click this to add the file to the NSA’s download queue or check the file’s status in the NSA’s download service.
Click the Delete icon to remove the file from the channel’s list.
9.8.1 Adding a Broadcatching Channel
At the time of writing, the NSA supports RSS 2.0 feeds. Websites with a feed usually display a feed icon (shown next). Copy and paste the feed’s URL into the
Applications > Broadcatching > Add Channel screen and you can download new files as they are added.
Figure 107 Feed Icon
A channel uses a feed to deliver its contents (items). Subscribe the NSA to a feed to be able to download the contents.
NSA210 User’s Guide
223
Chapter 9 Applications
Click Applications > Broadcatching > Add Channel to open the following screen. Use the Add Channel screen to subscribe the NSA to a channel’s feed so you can view the channel. You also select policies for downloading and deleting
the channel’s items. Section 4.10 on page 119
provides a tutorial on adding a broadcatching channel.
Figure 108 Applications > Broadcatching > Add Channel
224
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 44 Applications > Broadcatching > Add Channel
LABEL
Subscribe to
Channel Feed
DESCRIPTION
Paste (or type) the URL of the feed for the channel to which you want to subscribe into this field. This is read-only in the Preferences screen.
Note: Make sure the link goes to the actual RSS feed instead of to another list of links or information about the channel.
One way to test this is by clicking the link. Clicking an actual RSS feed link opens a screen of XML code (in browsers without an RSS feed aggregator) or a window where you can add the RSS feed (in browsers with an RSS feed aggregator).
Download Policy Set which of the channel’s items the NSA downloads.
Download All Items: Download every file in the feed.
Download Only New Items: Download new files from today on.
Manually Choose Items for Download: Only download individual files you select later in the Broadcatching screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 44 Applications > Broadcatching > Add Channel
LABEL
Delete Policy
DESCRIPTION
Set how the NSA handles deleting the items downloaded from the channel.
Location of
Downloaded Files
Manual: Only delete individual files you select later in the
Broadcatching screen.
Keep last N of items: Select this to set the NSA to only keep a number of the channel’s most recent files. When this number has been reached, if the NSA downloads another file from the channel, it deletes the oldest file from the NSA.
This shows where the NSA stores new downloads (Put incomplete
downloads in) and where the NSA moves completed downloads
(Move completed downloads to).
The Share column shows the name of the share where the file is downloaded.
The Path column points to the location in the share where the NSA will save the downloaded files.
• BitTorrent jobs are stored in /*/incoming (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• HTTP/FTP jobs are stored in /* (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• All jobs triggered by RSS channels create the subfolder in /* using the channel name where it store all files downloaded from that channel (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
NSA210 User’s Guide
225
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 44 Applications > Broadcatching > Add Channel
LABEL
Edit
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open the following screen where you can set the default folder location where you “Put incomplete downloads in” and
“Move complete downloads to”:.
• Share - Select the share from the list.
• Path - Type the folder location in the share directly or click
Browse to open the following screen and navigate to the file’s location.
Apply
Cancel
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
to create
• Type - This identifies the item as a file or folder.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
226
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
9.8.2 Editing a Broadcatching Channel
Click Applications > Broadcatching, then select a channel and click Edit
Channel to open a similar Edit screen. Use the Edit Channel screen to change the download or delete policies.
Figure 109 Applications > Broadcatching > Edit Channel
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 45 Applications > Broadcatching > Edit Channel
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Channel Name This is the name of the feed for the channel to which you want to subscribe into this field. This is read-only.
URL This is the address of the channel.
Download Policy Set which of the channel’s items the NSA downloads.
Delete Policy
Download All Items: Download every file in the feed.
Download Only New Items: Download new files from today on.
Manually Choose Items for Download: Only download individual files you select later in the Broadcatching screen.
Set how the NSA handles deleting the items downloaded from the channel.
Manual: Only delete individual files you select later in the
Broadcatching screen.
Keep last N of items: Select this to set the NSA to only keep a number of the channel’s most recent files. When this number has been reached, if the NSA downloads another file from the channel, it deletes the oldest file from the NSA.
NSA210 User’s Guide
227
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 45 Applications > Broadcatching > Edit Channel
LABEL
Location of
Downloaded Files
DESCRIPTION
This shows where the NSA stores new downloads (Put incomplete
downloads in) and where the NSA moves completed downloads
(Move completed downloads to).
Edit
The Share column shows the name of the share where the file is downloaded.
The Path column points to the location in the share where the NSA will save the downloaded files.
• BitTorrent jobs are stored in /*/incoming (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• HTTP/FTP jobs are stored in /* (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• All jobs triggered by RSS channels create the subfolder in /* using the channel name where it store all files downloaded from that channel (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
Click this to open the following screen where you can set the default folder location where you “Put incomplete downloads in” and
“Move complete downloads to”:.
228
• Share - Select the share from the list.
• Path - Type the folder location in the share directly or click
Browse to open the following screen and navigate to the file’s location.
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
to create
• Type - This identifies the item as a file or folder.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 45 Applications > Broadcatching > Edit Channel
LABEL
Apply
Cancel
DESCRIPTION
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
9.9 The Print Server Screen
Use the Print Server screen to view and manage the NSA’s list of printers and print jobs.
Click Applications > Print Server to open the following screen.
Figure 110 Applications > Print Server
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 46 Applications > Print Server
LABEL
Refresh
Status
Name
Actions
DESCRIPTION
Click this to update the list of printers and print jobs.
The table lists printers and their queued print jobs. Click a column’s heading to sort the entries by that criteria.
This fields shows whether the printer is connected and turned on (on-
line) or not (off-line).
This identifies the printer. Each printer connected to the NSA must use a unique name.
Rename: Click this to change the name the NSA uses for the printer.
Cancel Job: Click this to remove all print jobs from the NSA queue for a particular printer. However, since the NSA sends print jobs to the printer as soon as it can, this button may only have an effect if there are very large or many print jobs in the queue. To stop a print job that has already started, you may have to turn off the printer.
Delete: Click this to remove a printer from the NSA’s printer list. To add the printer back into the list, disconnect the printer from the
NSA’s USB port and reconnect it. If that does not work, disconnect the USB port and turn off the printer’s power. Then reconnect the printer and turn it back on.
NSA210 User’s Guide
229
Chapter 9 Applications
9.9.1 Print Server Rename
Click Applications > Print Server and a printer’s Rename icon to open the following screen. Use this screen to change the name the NSA uses for the printer.
Figure 111 Applications > Print Server > Rename
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 47 Applications > Print Server > Rename
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Name
Apply
Cancel
Type a new name to identify the printer. The name must be unique from all the other names of printers connected to the NSA.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
230
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
9.10 The Copy/Sync Button Screen
The Copy/Sync button on the front panel allows you to copy or synchronize files between a connected USB device and the NSA.
Click Applications > Copy/Sync Button to open the following screen.
Figure 112 Applications > Copy/Sync Button
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 48 Applications > Copy/Sync Button
LABEL
Copy Settings
DESCRIPTION
NSA Copy Target Select the NSA share to use with the copy function.
USB Volume If your USB device has multiple partitions, select which partition to use with the copy function.
Copy Direction Select USB -> NSA to copy files from your USB device to the NSA.
Create a New
Folder for Copied
Files
Backup Files to be
Replaced
Select NSA -> USB to copy files from the NSA to your USB device.
Select this option to place the copied files in a new folder.
The name of the folder created for the copied files consists of the date and time of the copy in year_month_day_hour_minute_second format.
This option is only available if you do not select Create a New
Folder for Copied Files. Select this option to save the files that will be replaced by the source files.
NSA210 User’s Guide
231
Chapter 9 Applications
Table 48 Applications > Copy/Sync Button
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Backup Target Select a share in which to save the backup files.
Note: The NSA will not create a new folder to store the backup files. It is recommended to create a specific share (such as
“backup”) for backup purposes.
Sync Settings
NSA Sync Target
USB Volume
Sync Direction
Select the NSA share to use with the synchronization function.
If your USB device has multiple partitions, select which partition to use with the synchronization function.
Select USB -> NSA to synchronize files from your USB device to the
NSA.
Select NSA -> USB to synchronize files from the NSA to your USB device.
Backup Files to be
Replaced or
Removed
Select NSA <-> USB to synchronize files in both directions simultaneously.
Select this option to save the files that will be replaced by the source files.
Backup Target Select a share in which to save the backup files.
Apply
Reset
Note: The NSA will not create a new folder to store the backup files. It is recommended to create a specific share (such as
“backup”) for backup purposes.
Click this to save your changes.
The configuration file is saved on the USB device.
Click this to restore your previously saved settings.
9.11 Technical Reference
This section provides technical background information on the topics discussed in this chapter.
9.11.1 Sharing Media Files on Your Network
The media server feature lets anyone on your network play video, music, and photos from the NSA (without having to copy them to another computer). The
NSA can function as a DLNA-compliant media server and/or an iTunes server. The
NSA streams files to DLNA-compliant media clients or computers using iTunes. The
Digital Living Network Alliance (DLNA) is a group of personal computer and
232
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications electronics companies that works to make products compatible in a home network.
• Publish shares to let others play the contained media files.
• The media server is a convenient way to share files you download using the broadcatching service (see
).
• Hardware-based media clients like the DMA-2500 can also play the files. See
Section 19.4 on page 416 for the supported multimedia file formats.
Note: Anyone on your network can play the media files in the published shares. No user name and password or other form of security is used. The media server is enabled by default with the video, photo, and music shares published.
Songs from the iTunes Store
After using iTunes on your computer to download songs from Apple’s iTunes Store, you can copy them to the NSA. Many of these songs have DRM (Digital Rights
Management). At the time of writing, you can use your Apple account ID and password to authorize up to a total of five computers to play the files. To authorize a computer, open iTunes and click Store > Authorize Computer.
A link for the NSA in iTunes under SHARED. Click it to display the NSA’s published media files as shown next.
Figure 113 NSA link in iTunes
NSA210 User’s Guide
233
Chapter 9 Applications
9.11.2 Download Service
The NSA’s download service downloads files from the Internet directly to the NSA.
You do not have to download to your computer and then copy to the NSA. This can free up your computer’s system resources. The download service also handles your broadcatching downloads. See
for information on broadcatching.
The NSA can download using these protocols.
• HTTP: The standard protocol for web pages.
• FTP: A standard Internet file transfer service.
• BitTorrent: A popular distributed peer-to-peer files sharing protocol.
Note: Do not use the NSA for illegal purposes. Illegal downloading or sharing of files can result in severe civil and criminal penalties. You are subject to the restrictions of copyright laws and any other applicable laws and will bear the consequences of any infringements thereof. ZyXEL bears NO responsibility or liability for your use of the download service feature.
Torrent Files
The NSA needs a “.torrent” file for BitTorrent to download a file. The torrent file gives the NSA information about the file to be downloaded (and shared) and the tracker(s) (computers) that coordinates the distribution of the file.
When you add a BitTorrent download task in the NSA’s Web Configurator screens, you can copy and paste the URL of the torrent file. The NSA automatically downloads the torrent file and saves it in a torrent folder within the folder where the NSA stores downloaded files (the admin share’s download folder by default).
If you already have the torrent file saved on your computer, you can just specify its location when adding a download task through the Web Configurator. Another method is to use FTP or a CIFS program (Windows Explorer for example) to copy the torrent file into the torrent folder. The NSA automatically uses the torrent file.
After your BitTorrent download and sharing are finished, you can go to the
incoming folder within the destination share or folder and delete the .torrent file if you need to free up hard disk space.
9.11.3 Link Capture Browser Plugin
The link capture browser plugin is an add-on feature for your web browser. Use the plugin to directly add a file’s URL to the NSA’s download service.
Note: The link capture browser plugin is located in the included CD.
234
NSA210 User’s Guide
The following screen displays how the plugin works.
Figure 114 Link Capture Browser Plugin
Chapter 9 Applications
Instead of copying and pasting a file’s URL to the NSA’s download service, you can right-click on the URL in the web browser and select Send to NSA. The URL is then added to the NSA’s download service list.
See Section 4.9.2 on page 106 and
Section 4.9.3 on page 111 for tutorials about
installing and using the link capture browser plugin.
Note: At the time of writing the plugin supports Internet Explorer 6.0/7.0/8.0 and
Mozilla Firefox 2.0/3.0.
9.11.4 Download Service Notification
Use the download service notification to keep track of downloaded files on the
NSA. You can subscribe to the NSA’s download list on your computer. When the
NSA finishes downloading new files, your RSS reader displays the information and links for the files. You can also download the files from the RSS reader to your computer.
See Section 4.9.5 on page 115 for a tutorial about using the download service
notification.
In the Download Service screen, select Enable Download Notify and click
Apply. An RSS feed icon appears. Click the icon to subscribe to the NSA’s download list.
NSA210 User’s Guide
235
Chapter 9 Applications
Note: The download service notification only keeps track of files downloaded via
BitTorrent.
Figure 115 Download Service Notification
9.11.5 BitTorrent Security
When you download using BitTorrent, you reveal your IP address. This increases the risk of hacking attacks, which can be protected against by a good firewall.
Use a Hardware-based Firewall
Place a hardware-based firewall between your network and the Internet (a software-based firewall on your computer would just protect the computer itself, not the NSA since your computer is not between your NSA and the Internet).
Figure 116 Firewall
236
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
Ideally your firewall should have the following:
• Stateful packet inspection to control access between the Internet and your network and protect your NSA (and computers) from hacking attacks.
• IDP (Intrusion Detection and Prevention) to detect malicious packets within normal network traffic and take immediate action against them.
• Anti-virus to check files you download for computer viruses.
BitTorrent and Your Firewall
The anti-virus feature on a firewall probably cannot check BitTorrent downloads for viruses, so use anti-virus software on your computer to scan the NSA for viruses.
When you download using BitTorrent, many other BitTorrent users are also trying to download the file from you. The firewall slows this down because by default, it only allows traffic from the Internet in response to a request that originated on the
LAN (it lets you get files from the Internet and blocks those on the Internet from getting files from you).
Figure 117 Firewall Blocking Incoming BitTorrent Requests
To speed up BitTorrent file transfers, configure your firewall’s port forwarding to send incoming TCP port 9090 and UDP port 9089 connections to the NSA. You probably need to use your firewall’s HTML (web-based) configuration interface to
NSA210 User’s Guide
237
Chapter 9 Applications set this up (see the firewall’s manual for details). You may also have to configure a corresponding firewall rule.
Figure 118 Firewall Configured to Allow Incoming BitTorrent Requests
9.11.6 Web Publishing Example
This example covers how to configure the Web Publishing screen to let people use a web browser to access a share named FamilyPhotos without logging into the
Home screens and shows how to access the share through the Internet.
238
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
1
Click Applications > Web Publishing and configure the screen as shown
(enable the web publishing and move FamilyPhotos over to Published Shares) and click Apply.
Figure 119 Applications > Web Publishing (Example)
2
Now open your web browser and type in the address of the NSA’s FamilyPhotos web page. In this example, the NSA’s IP address is 192.168.1.33, and the name of the web-published share is FamilyPhotos. So you would enter “http://
192.168.1.33/MyWeb/FamilyPhotos/” in your browser’s address bar. Then press
[ENTER] or click Go. A screen displays listing the share’s files.
Figure 120 Browsing to an NSA Share Example
NSA210 User’s Guide
239
Chapter 9 Applications
• Click a file’s link to open the file.
• Right-click a file’s link and select Save Target As.. (in Internet Explorer) to save a copy of the file.
• Click a label in the heading row to sort the files by that criteria.
• To customize how the page looks and works, create an index.html or index.htm file and store it in the share.
9.11.7 Web Publishing
Web publishing lets you “publish” shares (containing folders and files) on the NSA so people can access the files using a web browser without having to log into the
Home screens. This way you can share files with others without them having to know and enter a user name and password.
For example, if you want to share photos in a FamilyPhotos share, you could “web publish” it and others could use a web browser to access the photos at http://my-
NSA’s-IP-Address/MyWeb/FamilyPhotos.
Note: The NSA does not use any security for the files in the published folders. It is not recommended to publish shares if you do not have the NSA behind a good hardware-based firewall. See
for more on firewalls.
Additionally, you can use HTML editing software (not included) to create an index.html or index.htm file to define and customize how your website works and looks.
Accessing Web-published Shares from the Internet
You need to use a public address to access the NSA’s web-published shares from the Internet. If your NSA uses a private IP address, you may need to use the public IP address of your Internet gateway and configure NAT or port forwarding on your Internet gateway and possibly firewall rules in order to let people access the NSA’s web-published shares from the Internet.
Web Publishing Port Number
If the web-published shares use a port number other than 80 (the normal port for web traffic), users must include it after the NSA’s IP address in order to access the
NSA’s web-published shares. For example, say you specified port 8080, the NSA’s
IP address is 192.168.1.23, and the name of the web-published share is
FamilyPhotos. You would have to enter “http://192.168.1.23:8080/MyWeb/
FamilyPhotos/” in your browser’s address bar to access the share’s web page.
The NSA’s Web Configurator uses port 80. To make the Web Configurator more secure, you can have the web-published shares use another port number. Then you can configure one set of firewall rules and NAT or port forwarding settings on
240
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications your Internet gateway specifically for allowing access to the web-published shares and another separate set of rules for accessing the NSA’s Web Configurator.
9.11.8 Channel Guides for Broadcatching
Here are some popular broadcatching channel guide web sites.
Note: ZyXEL does not endorse these web sites and is not responsible for any of their contents. Use these or any other web sites at your own risk and discretion.
• http://www.zencast.com/
• http://www.miroguide.com/
• http://www.vuze.com/
• http://www.mefeedia.com/
• http://www.vodstock.com/
• http://www.mininova.org
In the following example, the Internet gateway’s firewall is configured to allow anyone to access the NSA’s web-published screens using port 8080. Web configurator access (port 80) however, is only allowed from IP address a.b.c.d.
Figure 121 Web Publishing Port Number Example
NSA210 User’s Guide
241
Chapter 9 Applications
9.11.9 Printer Sharing
The NSA can act as a print server. A print server lets multiple computers share a printer. Connect a printer to the NSA’s USB port to let multiple computers on your network use it. See www.zyxel.com for a list of compatible printers.
Figure 122 Printer Sharing
242
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
9.11.10 Copying Files
You can copy files from a USB device to the NSA or from the NSA to a USB device.
Simply press and release the COPY/SYNC button to start copying files. See
Section 9.10 on page 231 for details about configuring the copy settings.
The following figure illustrates how copying files works when you copy files from a
USB device to the NSA. The same concept applies when you copy files from the
NSA to a USB device.
Figure 123 Copying Files Example
Before Copy
NSA
USB
A
After Copy
B
USB
A
C
NSA
A B A
B
C
Both storage devices contain file A.
• A copy of files A and B from the USB device is transferred to the NSA.
• File A from the USB device replaces file A on the NSA.
NSA210 User’s Guide
243
Chapter 9 Applications
9.11.11 Synchronizing Files
Synchronization makes the contents on the target device identical to the ones on the source device. You can synchronize files from a USB device to the NSA or from the NSA to a USB device. In addition, you may also synchronize files in both directions simultaneously.
Press and hold the COPY/SYNC button until you hear a beep to synchronize files.
See Section 9.10 on page 231 for details about configuring the synchronization
settings.
USB -> NSA or USB <- NSA
When you synchronize files in one direction, contents on the source device replace the files on the target device.
The following figure illustrates how synchronization works when you synchronize files from a USB device to the NSA. The same concept applies when you synchronize files from the NSA to a USB device.
Figure 124 Synchronizing Files Example 1
Before Sync
NSA
USB
A
After Sync
USB
B
A
C
NSA
244
A B
A B
Both storage devices contain A.
• A copy of files A and B from the USB device is transferred to the NSA.
• File A from the USB device replaces file A on the NSA.
• File C on the NSA is deleted.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 9 Applications
USB <-> NSA
When you synchronize files in both directions simultaneously, both storage devices transfer unique files to one another. Files with the same file name are synchronized according to their modification date/time. The difference in modification time between the two files has to be greater than five minutes. More recently modified files overwrite the older ones during synchronization.
The following figure illustrates how synchronization works when you synchronize files in both directions simultaneously.
Figure 125 Synchronizing Files Example 2
Before Sync
NSA
USB
A
(new)
B
C
After Sync
USB
A
B
(new)
D
NSA
A
(new)
B
C
(new)
D
A
(new)
B
(new)
C
D
A on the USB device and B on the NSA are modified more recently.
• File A from the USB device replaces file A on the NSA.
• File B from the NSA replaces file B on the USB device.
• A copy of file C from the USB device is transferred to the NSA.
• A copy of file D from the NSA is transferred to the USB device.
NSA210 User’s Guide
245
Chapter 9 Applications
246
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 0
Package Management
10.1 Overview
Package Management can be used to set up more useful applications in your NSA.
The NSA can download multiple packages/files at once and automatically goes through all the installation steps.
10.2 What You Can Do
• Use the Package Management screen (
download and install applications from the web.
• Use the eMule screens ( Section 10.5 on page 252 ) to configure the server, task
and search settings for the eMule application.
• Use the DyDNS screen (
) to configure the domain name settings of your NSA.
• Use the NFS screen (
Section 10.7 on page 269 ) to configure the Network File
System (NFS) settings of your NSA.
• Use the SMART screens (
Section 10.8 on page 273 ) to view your NSA hard
disk(s) statistics and monitor their performance.
• Use the Protect screens (
Section 10.9 on page 277 ) to configure and schedule
the backup and restore jobs of your NSA.
• Use the Syslog Server screen ( Section 10.12 on page 297
) to configure the
NSA to accept syslog logs from syslog clients.
• Use the TFTP Server screen (
Section 10.13 on page 299 ) to configure the NSA
to accept log files from TFTP clients.
10.3 What You Need to Know
This feature enables you to use the following applications:
• eMule - eMule is an open-source peer-to-peer (P2P) file-sharing application similar to eDonkey, which can be used to download files from the Internet. It uses the Kad protocol.
NSA210 User’s Guide
247
Chapter 10 Package Management
• DyDNS - This gives your NSA a domain name with a dynamic IP address. At the time of writing, this package supports accounts from the following service providers: DynDNS, NoIP, 3322, ZoneEdit, and DHS.
• Gallery - This web-based application allows your NSA to host pictures. You can upload images in your local computer or shares to this application. Use the administrator account of your NSA to log in to the Gallery console. The administrator can then create accounts for other users.
• NFS - NFS (Network File System) is a file-sharing protocol most commonly implemented on Unix-like systems.
• PHP-MySQL-phpMyAdmin - This tool can be used to manage MySQL through the web. Enter 'root' as the username and '1234' as the password to log in. This includes MySQL 5.1.30, PHP 5.2.8 and phpMyAdmin 3.1.1.
• SMART - Use S.M.A.R.T. (Self Monitoring, Analysis, and Reporting Technology) to monitor hard disks. It detects and reports the reliability of hard disks using standard indicators, enabling administrators to anticipate possible disk failures.
• SqueezeCenter - This enables you to manage a Logitech's Squeezebox device connected to the NSA.
• Wordpress - This allows you to create and manage a blog. Use the NSA administrator credentials to log in. The administrator can then create accounts for other users.
• BackupPlanner - Use this to schedule and run backup jobs for files stored in your NSA to an internal drive, external storage device or to another NSA in the network.
• Syslog Server - Use this to configure the NSA to accept syslog logs from syslog clients.
•
TFTP Server - Use this to configure the NSA to accept log files from TFTP clients.
The following applications come with their own Web Configurator and documentation:
• Gallery
• PHP-MySQL-phpMyAdmin
• SqueezeCenter
• WordPress
10.4 Package Management Screen
Use this screen to download and install applications from the web.
248
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Click Applications > Package Management to open the following screen.
Figure 126 Applications > Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 49 Applications > Package Management
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Package Management
Retrieve List
From Internet
Install/Upgrade
Click this to retrieve a list of available packages from the ZyXEL website.
Choose the item(s) on the list and click this to install the selected application(s) on your system or upgrade to the latest version if you have previously installed the application.
Uninstall/Cancel
Installation
Choose the item(s) on the list and click this to uninstall the selected application(s) from your system or cancel their active download(s) or install process/es.
Enable
Disable
Package Info
This is only available if you have previously installed the package.
This option is only for non built-in packages.
Choose the item(s) on the list and click this to enable the application(s) on your system.
This is only available if you have previously installed the package.
This option is only for non built-in packages.
Choose the item(s) on the list and click this to disable the application on your system. You have to enable the application again in order to use it.
This is only available if you have previously installed the package.
Select an item on the list and click this to display information about the package. See
Section 10.4.1 on page 251 for more details.
NSA210 User’s Guide
249
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 49 Applications > Package Management
LABEL
Status
DESCRIPTION
This is the current status of the application. It shows:
• Not Installed - This displays for applications that have not been installed by the NSA.
• Installing (%) - This displays when the application is being installed. It also shows the percent of the package already installed.
• Built-in - This displays for applications installed by the NSA that you can configure in the NSA Web Configurator.
• Enabled - This displays for applications installed and enabled by the NSA that have their own Web Configurators.
• Disabled - This displays for applications installed and disabled by the NSA that have their own Web Configurators.
• Unknown - It is possible to get this status if the web location for the application is unavailable.
Package Name This is the name of the application.
Requires This shows the other packages required in order to run this application.
Version
Description
Management
Page
Note: A package would be disabled/enabled simultaneously if its prerequisite package(s) has been disabled/enabled. For example, when you enable WordPress, this also enables
PHP-MySQL-phpMyAdmin automatically. However when you enable PHP-MySQL-phpMyAdmin, this does not automatically enable WordPress.
This is the version number of the item.
The icon indicates that the application has a newer version available. Move your mouse over this icon to see the latest version number. Choose this item and click Install/Upgrade.
This shows a brief description of the application.
This shows the location of the screens or Web Configurator where you can manage the application (after the package has been installed on the system).
Note: Once you install an application and enable it, additional links show up in the navigation panel. This applies to eMule, DyDNS, NFS, SMART,
BackupPlanner, Syslog Server, and TFTP Server. For Gallery, PHP-MySQL-
phpMyAdmin, SqueezeCenter and WordPress, you can access the applications’ Web Configurators through the Package Management screen.
250
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.4.1 Displaying Package Information
Select an installed package from the list and click Package Info. Use this screen to check detailed information about the application.
Figure 127 Applications > Package Management > Package Info
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 50 Applications > Package Management > Package Info
LABEL
Status
DESCRIPTION
This is the current status of the application. It shows:
Name
Size
Needed Space
Version
Requires
Required By
Management
Page
Source
• Not Installed - This displays for applications that have not been installed by the NSA.
• Installing (%) - This displays when the application is being installed. It also shows the percent of the package already installed.
• Built-in - This displays for applications installed by the NSA that you can configure in the NSA Web Configurator.
• Enabled - This displays for applications installed and enabled by the NSA that have their own Web Configurators.
• Disabled - This displays for applications installed and disabled by the NSA that have their own Web Configurators.
This is the name of the application.
This is the size of the application at initial download.
This is the needed space to complete the installation of the application.
This is the version number of the application.
This shows other package/s required to run this application.
This shows which other packages require this application in order to be usable.
This shows the location of the screens, console or Web Configurator where you can manage the application (after the package has been installed on the system).
This shows the location of the installed files of the application.
NSA210 User’s Guide
251
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 50 Applications > Package Management > Package Info
LABEL
Description
Close
DESCRIPTION
This shows a brief description of the item.
Click this to close the screen.
10.5 eMule Screens
Use these screens to manage the eMule application in your NSA. eMule is a peerto-peer (P2P) file-sharing console that lets you download files from the Internet. It works with eDonkey and Kad networks.
10.5.1 eMule Server Screen
Use this screen to configure the eMule server.
Click Applications > eMule > Server to open the following screen.
Figure 128 Applications > eMule > Server
252
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 51 Applications > eMule > Server
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Server - You can add multiple servers in this screen. However, the NSA can only connect to one eMule server at a time.
Enable eMule
Add Server
Check this and click Apply to enable the eMule application.
Click this to add an eMule server. A server provides a list of available files for download, users sharing them and other information.
Refer to Section 10.5.2 on page 253 for the Add Server screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 51 Applications > eMule > Server
LABEL
My Info
DESCRIPTION
Select a server from the list and click this to view the details and connection status of the server.
Connect
Disconnect
Edit Server
Refer to Section 10.5.4 on page 255 for the My Info screen.
Click this to connect to the selected server or a random server if no server is selected.
Select a server from the list and click this to disconnect from the server.
Select a server from the list and click this to edit the server’s information, including the server name and IP address.
Delete Selected
Server(s)
Refer to Section 10.5.3 on page 254 for the Edit Server screen.
Select the server(s) from the list and click this to delete the server(s) from the list.
The table lists your servers. Click a column’s heading to sort the entries by that criteria.
Status This shows the status of the NSA’s connection to the server:
Connected, Connecting or Not Connected.
IP Address
Port Number
Name
Response
This shows the IP address of the server.
This shows the port number used by the server for file-sharing.
This shows the name of the server.
This shows the length of time (in milliseconds) that the server took to reply to the NSA.
This shows the number of users currently connected to the server.
Number of
Current Users
Max. User
Number
Number of Files
This shows the total number of users that can connect to the server at the same time.
This shows the number of files available for download in the server.
You see a warning screen before you delete a server.
Figure 129 Delete a Server
10.5.2 Add Server
Use this screen to add a server for the eMule application.
NSA210 User’s Guide
253
Chapter 10 Package Management
Click Add in the Applications > eMule > Server screen to add a server.
Figure 130 Applications > eMule > Server: Add
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 52 Applications > eMule > Server: Add
LABEL
Server IP
Server Name
IP Address
Port Number
ED2K Link
DESCRIPTION
Select this if you know the server name, IP address and port number of the eMule server you want to add.
Enter the server name.
Enter the IP address of the server.
Enter the port number used by the server for file-sharing.
Select this and enter the ED2K link for the eMule server you want to add.
Insert server.met from URL
Apply
Cancel
The ED2K link is used within the eMule network and contains information about the server.
Select this and enter the URL from which you want to download the server list that you want the
NSA to use
.
Click this to apply your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
10.5.3 Edit Server
Use this screen to edit a server for the eMule application.
Click Edit in the Applications > eMule > Server screen to edit a server.
Figure 131 Applications > eMule > Server: Edit
254
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 53 Applications > eMule > Server: Edit
LABEL
Server Name
IP Address
Port Number
Apply
Cancel
DESCRIPTION
Enter the server name.
Enter the IP address of the server.
Enter the port number of the server.
Click this to apply your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
10.5.4 My Info
Use this screen to view the server details, including the status, IP address and download/upload speeds.
Click MyInfo in the Applications > eMule > Server screen to view the server details.
Figure 132 Applications > eMule > Server: MyInfo
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 54 Applications > eMule > Server: MyInfo
LABEL
ED2k Status
ED2k ID
ED2k IP
ED2k Port
DESCRIPTION
This shows the status of the NSA’s connection to the server:
Connected, Connecting or Not Connected.
This is the identification given to the NSA by the eMule server. The ID comes in two types:
• High ID - The
NSA
connects to the server directly.
• Low ID - The
NSA
connects to the server from behind a firewall.
This is the IP address of the eMule server to which the
NSA is connected
.
This is the port number of the eMule server to which the
NSA is connected
.
NSA210 User’s Guide
255
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 54 Applications > eMule > Server: MyInfo
LABEL
Kad
DESCRIPTION
This shows the status of the NSA’s connection to the Kad network:
Connected or Not Connected.
Kad is a shortcut for Kademlia network, which does not use servers to store files or user information in order to run a peer-to-peer network.
Instead it employs peers/clients as small “servers” and runs queries through these peers.
Download Speed This shows the current download speed of the eMule client.
Upload Speed This shows the current upload speed of the eMule client.
Client in Queue This shows the number of peers waiting to connect to the NSA to download its file (s).
Sources This shows the total number of peers that can share the required files to the
NSA eMule client
.
Close Click this to exit the screen.
10.5.5 eMule Task Screen
Use this screen to view tasks, including completed, downloading, uploading and shared tasks, that are being handled by the NSA.
Click Applications > eMule > Task screen to view the task details.
Figure 133 Applications > eMule > Task
256
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 55 Applications > eMule > Task
LABEL
Task
Enable eMule
DESCRIPTION
Check this and click Apply to enable the eMule application.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 55 Applications > eMule > Task
LABEL
Add
DESCRIPTION
Click this to add a download task (ED2K link) to the list.
Preferences
Refer to Section 10.5.6 on page 258 for the Add Task screen.
Click this to open a screen where you can set the default location for saving downloaded files. You can also configure your eMule download settings.
Browse
Incomplete
Downloads
Refer to Section 10.5.7 on page 260 for the Preferences screen.
Click this to open a screen where you can see a list of *.part.met files that the NSA is still in the process of downloading.
Refer to Section 10.5.9 on page 264
for the Share Browsing screen.
Clear All
Completed
Refresh
Delete
Pause
Resume
Task Info
Click this to remove all completed downloads from the task list. This only removes the newly completed task(s) in this session
.
Click this to refresh the task screen.
Select an item from the list and click this to delete the task.
Select an item from the list and click this to pause the task.
Select a paused item from the list and click this to resume the task.
Select an item from the list and click this to view the details and status of the task.
The table lists your tasks. Click a column’s heading to sort the entries by that criteria.
Downloading This table shows a list of download tasks that are still in progress.
Newly Completed This table shows a list of tasks that have been completed but have not been cleared from the list.
Uploading
Shared Files
This table shows a list of upload tasks that are still in progress.
This table shows a list of files on the NSA that are available for download by other peers in the network.
Status This shows the current status of the task: Waiting or Downloading.
Name/File Name This shows the name of the file(s) associated to the task.
File Size/Size
Complete (%)
This shows the size of the file(s) associated in the task.
This shows the percentage of the file that has been downloaded by the NSA. It also indicates what percent of the file still needs to be downloaded.
Source This shows the total number of peers that can share the required files to the
NSA eMule client
.
Download Speed This shows the download speed of the NSA for the task.
Time Left This shows how much more time the NSA needs to complete the file’s download.
Priority Use this field to set the priority for the task. Choose from Auto, Low,
Normal or High.
Select Auto to have the NSA automatically determine the task’s priority.
Select High to have the NSA complete this task before the others.
NSA210 User’s Guide
257
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 55 Applications > eMule > Task
LABEL
Transferred
DESCRIPTION
This shows what percent of the file the NSA has uploaded to other peers.
Upload Speed
This column is available in the Uploading tab.
This shows the upload speed of the NSA.
Requests
Accepted
Requests
This column is available in the Uploading tab.
This shows the number of requests for a shared file.
This column is available in the Shared Files tab.
This shows the number of file requests granted by the NSA.
This column is available in the Shared Files tab.
Note: Download tasks initially appear in the Downloading tab of the eMule Task screen. Depending on its status, it can eventually show up in the other tabs
(Newly Completed, Uploading or Shared Files tabs).
You see a warning screen before you delete a task.
Figure 134 Delete a Task
10.5.6 Add Task
Use this to add a download task to the NSA.
258
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Click Add in the Applications > eMule > Task screen to add a task.
Figure 135 Applications > eMule > Task: Add
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 56 Applications > eMule > Task: Add
LABEL
Source
ED2K Link
DESCRIPTION
Paste the ED2K link of the file you want to download into this field.
Location of
Downloaded Files
The ED2K link identifies files in the eMule network. It starts with ed2k:// and may contain the name and size of the file you want to download.
This shows where the NSA stores new downloads (Put incomplete
downloads in) and where the NSA moves completed downloads
(Move completed downloads to).
The Share column shows the name of the share where the file is downloaded.
The Path column points to the location in the share where the NSA will save the downloaded files.
NSA210 User’s Guide
259
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 56 Applications > eMule > Task: Add
LABEL
Edit
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open the following screen where you can set the default folder location where you “Put incomplete downloads in” and
“Move complete downloads to”:.
• Share - Select the destination share from the drop-down list.
• Path - This field displays the share folder’s path. You can use
Browse to find or create a folder on the NSA or type the location of the folder using forward slashes as branch separators.
Apply
Cancel
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
to create
• Type - This identifies the item as a folder or file.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
10.5.7 Preferences
Use this screen to configure your eMule settings, such as port numbers to use, its download/upload rates and the maximum number of peers allowed to connect to the NSA.
260
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Click Applications > eMule > Task > Preferences to open the following screen.
Figure 136 Applications > eMule > Task > Preferences
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 57 Applications > eMule > Task > Preferences
LABEL
Username
Username
Location of
Downloaded Files
DESCRIPTION
Enter your user name that identifies the NSA in the eMule network.
This shows where the NSA stores new downloads (Put incomplete
downloads in) and where the NSA moves completed downloads
(Move completed downloads to).
The Share column shows the name of the share where the file is downloaded.
The Path column points to the location in the share where the NSA will save the downloaded files.
NSA210 User’s Guide
261
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 57 Applications > eMule > Task > Preferences
LABEL
Edit
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open the following screen where you can set the default folder location where you “Put incomplete downloads in” and
“Move complete downloads to”:.
• Share - Select the destination share from the drop-down list.
• Path - This field displays the share folder’s path. You can use
Browse to find or create a folder on the NSA or type the location of the folder using forward slashes as branch separators.
262
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
to create
• Type - This identifies the item as a folder or file.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Max. download rate
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Port Number
UDP Port
TCP Port
Enter the UDP port number you want to use for file transfers.
Enter the TCP port number you want to use for file transfers.
Upload and Download Rate
Enter the maximum download rate for download tasks.
Max. upload rate Enter the maximum upload rate for upload tasks.
Connection
Enter the maximum number of eMule peer-to-peer connections.
Maximum
Number of Active
Connections
IP Filter
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 57 Applications > eMule > Task > Preferences
LABEL
Edit IP Filter
DESCRIPTION
Click this to edit the IP Filter.
Apply
Reset
Cancel
IP filtering prevents your NSA from accessing certain networks and IP addresses that may be hosting malicious programs.
Refer to Section 10.5.8 on page 263 to view and configure the Edit
IP Filter screen.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to clear the fields.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
10.5.8 Edit IP Filter
Use this screen to enable IP filtering which prevents your NSA from accessing certain networks and IP addresses that may be hosting malicious programs.
Figure 137 Applications > eMule > Task > Preferences: Edit IP Filter
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 58 Applications > eMule > Task > Preferences: Edit IP Filter
LABEL
Enable IP Filter
DESCRIPTION
Click this to enable IP filtering. This prevents your NSA from accessing certain networks and IP addresses that may be hosting malicious programs.
Apply
Reset
Select Update IP Filter Table File from the Internet Every Week if you know the web location of the IP filter table you want to use.
Enter the link where your NSA can acquire the list of networks and IP addresses. The NSA checks this link every week and uses the latest
IP filter table available.
Select Upload IP Filter Table if you want to use an IP filter table from your local computer.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
263
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.5.9 Share Browsing
Use this screen to view a list of files that are still being downloaded by the NSA.
The files are located in the eMule\Temp folder in the Admin share by default.
Click Applications > eMule > Task > Browse Incomplete Downloads to open the following screen.
Figure 138 Applications > eMule > Task > Browse Incomplete Downloads
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 59 Sharing > Shares > Share Browser
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Create Folder Type a folder name and click Apply to make a new folder. The name can be 1 to 239 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example)
ASCII characters. The name cannot be the same as another existing
folder in the same path. See Section 3.4.7 on page 67
for more information on folder names.
Upload Click this to add files to the share. Use Browse to locate a file and click
Apply to upload the file. Note that the size of each file should be less than
2 GB.
264
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 59 Sharing > Shares > Share Browser (continued)
LABEL
Rename
DESCRIPTION
Select a folder or file and click this to open a screen. Enter the name you want and click OK to make the changes.
Note: When you change a file name, make sure you keep the file extention.
Delete Select a file/folder from the list and click this to open a warning screen.
Click Yes to delete the file/folder, or click No to close the screen.
Move
Copy
Select a file/folder from the list and click this to relocate the file/folder to another share.
Select a file/folder from the list and click this to make a duplicate of the file/folder to another share.
This is the name of the share and folder path that you are in.
Current location
Type The icon in this column identifies the entry as a folder or a file.
Name
The folder with an arrow pointing up is for the link that takes you to the next higher layer in the share’s folder tree.
This section lists the share’s existing folders or files. Click to the right of the file/folder name to select the file/folder. You can also click the folder’s name to navigate to a sub-folder within the folder.
Size This field displays size of the file.
Modified Date This field displays a file’s latest modification date.
Close Click this to close the screen.
10.5.10 Task Info
Use this screen to view eMule task details, such as status, file name, file size and its download progress.
NSA210 User’s Guide
265
Chapter 10 Package Management
Click Task Info in Applications > eMule > Task screen to open the following.
Figure 139 Applications > eMule > Task: Task Info
266
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 60 Applications > eMule > Task: Task Info
LABEL
Status
Name
DESCRIPTION
This shows the current status of the task - Waiting or
Downloading.
This shows the file name of the file associated with the task. part.met File
Hash
You can change this file name by entering the new name and clicking
Apply.
This shows the temporary file name for an incomplete file.
Files in peer-to-peer networks can be divided into several parts for easier download. Once all the parts have been downloaded, you can run one part and the file automatically rebuilds itself. If the download of the file(s) is not completed, the file parts cannot open on their own.
This shows the hash value of the download file.
ED2K Link
This is a text string that can be interpreted by eMule to check the downloaded file’s integrity.
This shows the ED2K link for this file.
Size
Done Size
Complete (%)
The ED2K link identifies files in the eMule network. It starts with ed2k:// and may contain the name and size of the file you want to download.
This shows the size of the file associated with the task.
This shows the size of the file that has been downloaded so far.
This shows what percent of the file has been downloaded so far.
Source This shows the total number of peers that can share the required files to the
NSA eMule client
.
Download Speed This shows the download speed for the task.
Time Left
Priority
This shows how much time is needed to complete the task.
This shows the priority of this task.
You can set this in
.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 60 Applications > eMule > Task: Task Info
LABEL
Seen Complete
Close
DESCRIPTION
This shows the last time a source with the complete file was online.
Click this to exit the screen.
10.5.11 eMule Search Screen
Use this screen to search for files available in an eMule server using keywords and other parameters, such as file type, file size and extension names.
Click Applications > eMule > Search to open the following screen.
Figure 140 Applications > eMule > Search
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 61 Applications > eMule > Search
LABEL
Search
Enable eMule
Keyword(s)
File Type
Method
Min Size
Max Size
Min Sources
Extension
Search
Clear
DESCRIPTION
Check this and click Apply to enable the eMule application.
Enter words that are related to the file you want to download.
Select the file type that you want to download.
Select the search method you want eMule to employ.
Enter the minimum file size you want included in the search results.
Enter the maximum file size you want included in the search results.
Enter the minimum number of peers sharing the file you want to download.
Enter the file extensions separated by commas of files you want included in the search results.
Click this to have the NSA search the eMule network for files that match the criteria you have set.
Click this to clear the fields.
NSA210 User’s Guide
267
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 61 Applications > eMule > Search
LABEL
Download
DESCRIPTION
Select a file from the results and click this to start downloading the file.
This table shows the results of the search.
File Name This shows the name of the file(s) that match the criteria you have set.
File Size
Source
This shows the size of the file(s) that match the criteria you have set.
This shows how many peers are currently available to share this file so that the NSA can download it.
10.6 DyDNS Screen
Use this to enable and configure DyDNS.
Dynamic DNS allows you to update your current dynamic IP address with a dynamic DNS service so that anyone can contact you (such as through NetMeeting or CUSeeMe). You can also access your FTP server or Web site on your own computer using a domain name (for instance myhost.dhs.org, where myhost is a name of your choice) that will never change instead of using an IP address that changes each time you reconnect. Your friends or relatives will always be able to call you even if they don't know your IP address.
Click Network > DyDNS to open the following screen.
Figure 141 Network > DyDNS
268
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 62 Network > DyDNS
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Gateway Information
Internal Address This shows the IP address assigned to the NSA by the gateway in your local network.
External Address This shows the IP address of the NSA that can be accessed in the
Wide Area Network (WAN). Note that this is not assigned by the
DyDNS server.
Configuration
Enable DyDNS
Select this to use dynamic DNS.
Service Provider
Hostname
Username
Password
Password
(Confirm)
Apply
Reset
You need to have registered a dynamic DNS account with a service provider such as www.dyndns.org. The Dynamic DNS service provider will give you a password or key.
Select your Dynamic DNS service provider.
Enter your host name provided by the Dynamic DNS service.
Enter your user name for your DNS account.
Enter the password assigned to your DNS account.
Confirm the password you entered.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to clear the fields.
10.7 NFS Screen
Use this screen to enable and configure Network File System (NFS) settings on your NSA.
NFS is a client/server distributed file service that provides transparent file sharing for network environments. This allows shared folders in your NSA to be accessible like a local folder in a user’s computer.
NSA210 User’s Guide
269
Chapter 10 Package Management
Click Network > NFS to open the following screen.
Figure 142 Network > NFS
270
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 63 Network > NFS
LABEL
NFS Service
Enable NFS
Server
Disable NFS
Server
DESCRIPTION
Click this to employ NFS in your NSA.
Click this to stop using NFS.
Add NFS Share
This makes all NFS shares unavailable.
Click this to add an NFS share.
NFS Session
Refer to Section 10.7.1 on page 271 for the Add NFS Share screen.
Click this to view active NFS sessions. You can see the list of users who have access to the NFS shares.
Edit NFS Share
Comment
Refer to Section 10.7.2 on page 272 for the NFS Session screen.
Select an NFS share from the list and click this to edit it.
Delete NFS Share
(s)
Refer to Section 10.7.1 on page 271 for the Edit NFS Share screen.
Select an NFS share from the list and click this to delete it.
The table lists your NFS shares. Click a column’s heading to sort the entries by that criteria.
Status
NFS Share Path
Volume Name
DN/IP Filter
This shows whether the share is active or not.
This shows the location of the share in the NSA.
This shows the volume where the NFS share is located.
This shows which domain name(s) or IP address(es) have read/write access to the NFS shares.
Refer to Section 10.7.1 on page 271 for the screen where you can
configure this.
This shows a short description of the share.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
You see a warning screen before you delete a volume.
Figure 143 Delete an NFS Share
10.7.1 Add/Edit NFS Share
Use this screen to add or edit an NFS share.
Note: Some attributes of the NFS share cannot be edited.
Click Add or Edit in the Network > NFS screen to open the following:
Figure 144 Network > NFS: Add/Edit
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 64 Network > NFS: Add/Edit
LABEL
Volume Name
DESCRIPTION
Select the volume where the folder you want to add as an NFS share is located.
NFS Share Name Enter the name you want to give to the NFS share.
Full Path This shows the location of the NFS share in the NSA.
Comment
The NFS server assigns this path to the share folder you input.
Enter a short description for the share.
NSA210 User’s Guide
271
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 64 Network > NFS: Add/Edit
LABEL
DN/IP Filter
DESCRIPTION
Enter the domain name(s) or IP address(es) that can have access to the NFS share.
Enter ‘*’ to make the share available to all users in the network. You can also enter a wildcard, such as ‘*.domain.com’ to indicate that all users within that network have access to the share.
Apply
Cancel
Select the access rights you want to grant to each domain name or IP address you enter and click Add.
• Read Only - Users with this access right can only view and copy files in the NFS share but cannot modify or delete them.
• Read/Write - Users with this access right can view, edit or delete files in the NFS share.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
10.7.2 NFS Session
Use this screen to view a list of active NFS sessions. You can see which users are connected the NFS shares.
Click NFS Session in the Network > NFS screen to open the following.
Figure 145 Network > NFS: NFS Session
272
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 65 Network > NFS: NFS Session
LABEL
Type
NFS Share Path
Username
Connected At
IP Address
OK
DESCRIPTION
This shows if the NFS share is active or not.
This shows the location of the share in the NSA.
This shows the username of the active user connected to the NFS share.
This displays the date and time the user last connected to the NSA in year, month, day, hour, minute, second format.
This shows the IP address of the user accessing the NFS share.
Click this to close the window.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.8 SMART Screen
Use this screen to view indicators of your NSA’s hard disk(s) health.
Self Monitoring, Analysis, and Reporting Technology (S.M.A.R.T) detects and reports the reliability of hard disks using standard indicators (called “attributes”), to help you anticipate possible disk failures.
Note: The fields included the screens may vary depending on the hard disk that you use.
Click Storage > S.M.A.R.T to open the following screen.
Figure 146 Storage > S.M.A.R.T
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 66 Storage > S.M.A.R.T
LABEL DESCRIPTION
S.M.A.R.T. Information
Brief Summary Select a hard disk volume from the list and click this to display information about the volume, such as the hard disk vendor, specific model, hard disk capacity and so on.
Full Summary
See Section 10.8.1 on page 274 to view the Brief Summary screen.
Select a volume and click this to display more detailed information about the volume.
See Section 10.8.1 on page 274 to view the Full Summary screen.
The table lists your hard disks. Click a column’s heading to sort the entries by that criteria.
Status
Name
Temperature
This shows the name assigned to the hard disk.
This shows the temperature of the hard disk in degrees celsius.
NSA210 User’s Guide
273
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 66 Storage > S.M.A.R.T
LABEL
Performance
DESCRIPTION
This shows your hard disk’s performance. Refer to Section 10.8.2 on page 275
for more information on how S.M.A.R.T determines your hard disk’s condition. This displays:
Type
Volume Name
Model Name
Capacity
• Good - This shows when you compare each Value with the
Threshold Value and all the Value is greater than the
Threshold Value.
• Bad - This shows when you compare each Value with the
Threshold Value and at least one Value is less than or equal to the Threshold Value.
This shows volume type or file system that the hard disk is using, such as JBOD, PC Compatible Volume and RAID or FAT32,
FAT16 and NTFS.
See Section 7.5.2 on page 180 for descriptions of the volume types.
This shows the name of the hard disk volume.
This shows the factory model of the hard disk.
This shows the total hard disk space of the hard disk volume.
10.8.1 SMART Brief Summary
Use this screen to display information about the volume, such as the hard disk vendor, specific model, hard disk capacity and so on.
Click Brief Summary in the Storage > S.M.A.R.T screen to display the following.
Figure 147 Storage > S.M.A.R.T: Brief Summary
274
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 67 Storage > S.M.A.R.T: Brief Summary
LABEL
Brief Summary
Temperature
DESCRIPTION
This shows the current temperature of the hard disk in degrees celsius.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 67 Storage > S.M.A.R.T: Brief Summary
LABEL
Health
Performance
DESCRIPTION
This describes the overall health of the volume based on S.M.A.R.T diagnostics.
This shows your hard disk’s performance. Refer to Section 10.8.2 on page 275
for more information on how S.M.A.R.T determines your hard disk’s condition. This displays:
• Good - This shows when you compare each Value with the
Threshold Value and all the Value is greater than the
Threshold Value.
• Bad - This shows when you compare each Value with the
Threshold Value and at least one Value is less than or equal to the Threshold Value.
Detailed Information
Model Family This shows the vendor and product family of the hard disk.
Device Model
Serial Number
Firmware Version This shows the firmware version installed in the hard disk.
User Capacity This shows the total hard disk space of the hard disk volume.
ATA Version
This shows the factory model of the hard disk.
This shows the serial number of the hard disk.
ATA Standard
This shows the ATA version of the hard disk, which refers to an industry standard category for storage devices and connectors used.
This field displays the Advanced Technology Attachment standard the hard drive supports.
Local Time
SMART support
SMART support
OK
This field displays the local time that the hard drive is using.
This field displays whether or not the hard drive is SMART-capable.
This field displays whether or not the hard drive has SMART monitoring turned on.
Click this to close the window.
10.8.2 SMART Full Summary
Use this screen to display more details information about the volume.
Click Full Summary in the Storage > S.M.A.R.T screen to display the following.
Figure 148 Storage > S.M.A.R.T: Full Summary
NSA210 User’s Guide
275
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 68 Storage > S.M.A.R.T: Full Summary
LABEL
ID
DESCRIPTION
This is the identification number used to tag a hard disk attribute.
Attribute Name
Flag
Value
Worst
Threshold
Type
Updated
This is standard across all S.M.A.R.T-enabled storage devices.
However it depends on the storage vendor which attributes it will allow S.M.A.R.T to diagnose.
This refers to an attribute of the hard disk that S.M.A.R.T can assess.
Attributes describe the hard disk’s physical state, performance, wearand-tear, and so on.
This shows a code that S.M.A.R.T uses to determine the current state of the hard disk.
This is a value that corresponds to the Raw Value. Compare this with the Threshold Value.
S.M.A.R.T compresses the raw value(s) into a digit from 1 to 253, where 1 indicates the worst scenario while 253 indicates the best scenario.
The values 100 or 200 usually represent the mean or normal value.
This is the lowest value attained by the hard disk since S.M.A.R.T started its assessment of the hard disk.
This is the attribute’s threshold value. If the attribute’s current normalized value is less than or equal to the threshold, the attribute has failed. An attribute value close to or below the threshold indicates the hard drive is no longer reliable.
This shows S.M.A.R.T’s assessment of the hard disk.
Old_age indicates end-of-product life from old-age (normal wearing out) if the attribute value is less than or equal to the threshold.
Pre-fail indicate imminent hard drive failure if the attribute value is less than or equal to the threshold.
Note that just because an attribute is of the Pre-fail type does not mean your hard drive is ready to fail. It only means this if the current normalized value of the attribute is less than or equal to the threshold.
This indicates when the hard drive updates the value for this attribute.
• Always means the hard drive updates this attribute during normal operation and during offline activities.
• Offline means the hard drive only updates this attribute when no one is accessing the hard drive.
276
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 68 Storage > S.M.A.R.T: Full Summary
LABEL
When Failed
DESCRIPTION
This column indicates when (if ever) the attribute failed. An attribute has failed if the normalized value is less than or equal to the threshold.
Raw Value
OK
• -: This displays if the attribute is not failing now and has never failed in the past.
• FAILING_NOW: This displays if the attribute’s current normalized value is less than or equal to the threshold.
• In_the_past: This displays if the attribute’s current normalized value is greater than the threshold but the worst recorded value is less than or equal to the threshold.
This is the attribute’s unprocessed raw data. These values show exact amounts of time or numbers of attempts or errors. The meaning to the raw values is specific to the hard drive manufacturer. Table 42 on page 156 has some information about whether a higher or lower individual raw S.M.A.R.T. attribute value is better.
Click this to close this window.
10.9 Protect Screens
The Protect screens include:
• Backup screens - These include steps to create and customize backup jobs.
• Restore screens - These include steps to restore previous backups made with the NSA.
10.10 Backup Screens
Use this screen to create and customize scheduled backup jobs for your files.
You can have several backup jobs for specific folders and time periods.
NSA210 User’s Guide
277
Chapter 10 Package Management
Click Protect > Backup to open the following screen.
Figure 149 Protect > Backup
278
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 69 Protect > Backup
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Backup
Add Job
Edit Job
Click this to create and customize a backup job.
Select a backup job in the list and click this to make some changes to it.
Select a backup job in the list and click this to delete it.
Delete Selected
Job(s)
Execute Job Now Select a backup job in the list and click this to run the backup job immediately.
Restore Archive Select a backup job in the list and click this to restore the file(s) included in that backup job to the NSA.
Abort Job
Status
This applies to Archive backups only. Refer to
to see the screens.
Select a backup job in the list and click this to stop the process if the backup job is currently active.
This shows the current state of the backup job.
Job Name
Job Description
Backup Info
Scheduler Info
• Waiting means the backup job is not active but is scheduled to run at some time.
• Running indicates that the NSA is currently doing the backup job.
When the backup job is running, you can also see a progress bar.
This identifies the backup job.
This is a short description of the backup job.
This lists down the backup job details: type, source and target. Refer
to Section 10.10.1 on page 279 and
This shows the backup schedule, including the frequency, the time it was last run in (and whether or not it succeeded), and when it is scheduled to run again. The times use yyyy-mm-dd hh:mm:ss format.
Refer to Section 10.10.4 on page 285
.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.10.1 Backup: Step 1
Use this screen to specify the job information and back up type.
Click Add Job in the Protect > Backup screen to open the following:
Figure 150 Protect > Backup: Step 1
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 70 Protect > Backup: Step 1
LABEL
Job Information
Job Name
Job Description
DESCRIPTION
Enter a name to identify the backup job.
Enter a short description (up to 100 keyboard characters) for the backup job.
NSA210 User’s Guide
279
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 70 Protect > Backup: Step 1
LABEL
Backup Type
DESCRIPTION
Choose the backup type that you want the NSA to implement for the backup job.
Archive - This is a backup of the source folder in an archive format.
Once you backup your files in the target folder, you cannot access the files individually unless you have the extracting tool used by the NSA.
If there are existing files in the target folder prior to the NSA’s backup job, the files remain undisturbed. You can also choose between the following types of archive:
• Full - The NSA does a fresh backup each time. This provides the most protection but also requires the most storage space.
• Incremental - The NSA backs up new or modified files from the source folder since the last backup. The first backup is a full backup. You can also do a full backup after several incremental backups. Enter how many incremental backups the NSA runs before it performs a full backup of the source folder. You must keep the latest full backup to be able to restore the files later.
Synchronization - This does a backup of individual files. If you use this type, you cannot use the Restore feature of the NSA. You can also choose between the following types of synchronization:
Next
• Mirror - The NSA deletes all data in the target folder before running the backup. It makes the target folder identical to the source folder.
• Publish- The NSA does a backup of individual files to the target folder without overwriting existing files in that folder. It makes a copy of the source files.
Click this to go to the next step.
280
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.10.2 Backup: Step 2
Use this screen to specify where the files you want to backup are located and set where you want the backup to be stored.
Figure 151 Protect > Backup: Step 2
NSA210 User’s Guide
281
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 71 Protect > Backup: Step 2
LABEL
Backup Source
DESCRIPTION
Select an (internal) volume and the folders and files to back up using this tree interface.
Click to browse through folders, sub-folders and files.
Click to close a folder in the tree. This is useful if there are many folders or files that you wish to hide from view.
Click to select a folder or file to back up. This also selects all subfolders and files.
Click to deselect the folder or file. This also deselects all subfolders and files.
and appear when there are too many folders/files to display. Click the arrows to scroll up or down through the folders/ files.
for a folder means all sub-folders and files and new folders/files added later will be backed up.
for a file means the file will be backed up.
(a grayed out check box) for a folder means that only some subfolders and files under the folder will be backed up. Newly added folders/files will NOT be backed up.
means the file structure is still loading. Please wait for the folders/ files to display.
Note: If you select to back up an entire folder and then deselect a sub-folder or file within that folder, the main folder icon will turn and any new sub-folders and files added to this main folder after the initial backup configuration will
NOT be backed up.
A list of your select folders and files displays below the selection fields.
This shows the path of the backup source folder you selected.
Selected Source
Folders
Backup Target Select the target folder where you want to place your backup.
282
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 71 Protect > Backup: Step 2
LABEL
Remote
DESCRIPTION
Select this to back up to another device.
Local
External
Previous
Next
For Archives:
The remote device can be another NSA in the network. Fill in the following fields in order to be able to access it.
• Remote NSA Address
• Username
• Password
• Share Name
Click Test Connection to see if your NSA can communicate with the remote device.
For Synchronization:
The remote device must be another NSA compatible with the NSA’s synchronization feature. Fill in the following fields in order to be able to access it.
• Remote NSA Address
• Username (always “admin”)
• Remote Admin’s Password
Click Show target content to connect to the remote NSA so you can select the target share for the backup.
Select this if you want to place your backup in another volume in the
NSA. Select the folder where you want to place the backup.
Select this if you have a USB hard disk connected to the NSA that you want to use for your backup. Select the folder where you want to place the backup.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to go to the next screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
283
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.10.3 Backup: Step 3
Use this screen to specify compression, encryption and purge policies for the backup job. This step is only available if you are doing an archive backup or a synchronization backup to a remote target.
Figure 152 Protect > Backup: Step 3
284
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 72 Protect > Backup: Step 3
LABEL
Compression
DESCRIPTION
Select Yes if you want NSA to compress the files for your backup.
Otherwise, choose No.
Encryption
In an Archive backup, compression is a method of packing computing files in a way that saves hard disk space.
For a Synchronization backup (to a remote target), the source data will be compressed before the transmission to reduce the transmission time. It is used in slow networks only.
Select Yes if you want NSA to encrypt the files for your backup.
Otherwise, choose No.
In an Archive backup, this means using a password to secure files.
Bandwidth
For a Synchronization backup (to a remote target), this means securing the file transfer session. However the final file stored on the remote NSA is unencrypted. This takes a long time. Make sure you really need this feature before enabling it.
Restrict the bandwidth of synchronization backups to help stop them from using all of your network connection’s available bandwidth. This is more important when backing up to a remote NSA or computer through the Internet.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 72 Protect > Backup: Step 3
LABEL
Purge Policy
DESCRIPTION
The NSA maintains the files that have been included in your backups.
However to save hard disk space, you can choose to delete files that have been included in previous backups.
Previous
Next
• Select Keep All Old Backup files to store all files that have been included in previous backups.
• If you want to store a certain number of backup files, select Keep
Only the last n backup files (1-30). Enter a value (n) from 1 to
30 to specify how many backups the NSA stores. All backup files older than the last one are deleted. You will not be able to recover files that existed (only) in those previous backups. Select this if backup space is limited and recovery of old files is not important.
• If you want to store all backups for a certain time period, select
Keep Backups for n day(s)(1-3650). Enter a value (n) from 1 to 3650 to specify how many days the NSA stores all backup files.
After this day has expired, all backup files will be deleted.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to go to the next screen.
10.10.4 Backup: Step 4
Click this to specify the schedule for the backup job. The backup job automatically runs according to the schedule that you set in this screen.
Figure 153 Protect > Backup: Step 4
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 73 Protect > Backup: Step 4
LABEL
Scheduler
Backup
Frequency
DESCRIPTION
Select from Hourly, Daily, Weekly and Monthly backup intervals.
The screen changes depending on the item you select.
NSA210 User’s Guide
285
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 73 Protect > Backup: Step 4
LABEL
Every how many hours?
DESCRIPTION
This is only available if you selected Hourly as your backup frequency.
On which minute of the hour?
Start Time
(hh:mm)
Select every how many hours the NSA performs the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Hourly as your backup frequency.
Select the minute (from 0 to 59) in an hour when the NSA performs the backup job.
This is available if you selected Daily, Weekly or Monthly as your backup frequency.
Every how many days?
Every how many weeks?
Step 1: Please select the month(s) of a year
Step 2: Please select the day of the month
Previous
Done
Select the time in hour:minute format when you want the NSA to perform the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Daily as your backup frequency.
Enter the interval between days when the NSA performs the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Weekly as your backup frequency.
Enter the interval between weeks when NSA performs the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Monthly as your backup frequency.
Select the month(s) when you want the NSA to perform the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Monthly as your backup frequency.
Select the day in a month when you want the NSA to perform the backup job.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to close the screen.
10.10.5 Edit Job Screen
Use this screen to edit an existing backup job. Some attributes of the backup job cannot be changed, such as the name, backup type, source folder and so on.
286
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.10.6 Edit Job: Step 1
Click Protect > Backup. Select a backup job from the list and click Edit Job to open the following.
Figure 154 Protect > Backup > Edit: Step 1
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 74 Protect > Backup > Edit: Step 1
LABEL
Job Settings
Job Name
Job Description
Backup Type
Source folder(s)/ file(s)
Backup Target
Target Path
DESCRIPTION
This field is read-only and shows the name of the backup job.
Enter a short description for the backup job.
This field is read-only and shows the backup type.
This is read-only and shows the path of the source folder for backup.
This field is read-only and shows on which volume (whether internal or external) the backup files are stored. If the target location is a remote NSA, this shows the remote IP address.
This field is read-only and shows the target folder for the backup files.
NSA210 User’s Guide
287
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 74 Protect > Backup > Edit: Step 1
LABEL
Compression
DESCRIPTION
This field is read-only and shows whether the backup employs compression.
Encryption
Bandwidth
Purge Policy
Next
Compression reduces the size of the file that you want to back up.
Backup is then faster, but restoring may be slower, so if backup space is not a concern and recovery speed is, then turn off compression.
This field is read-only and shows whether the backup employs encryption.
You can have the NSA use a password to encrypt the backup files.
For backups to a remote NSA, you can restrict the bandwidth to help prevent the backups from using all of your network connection’s available bandwidth. This is more important when backing up to a remote NSA or computer through the Internet.
The NSA maintains the files that have been included in your backups.
However to save hard disk space, you can choose to delete files that have been included in previous backups.
• Select Keep All Old Backup files to store all files that have been included in previous backups.
• If you want to store a certain number of backup files, select Keep
Only the last n backup files (1-30). Enter a value (n) from 1 to
30 to specify how many backups the NSA stores. All backup files older than the last one are deleted. You will not be able to recover files that existed (only) in those previous backups. Select this if backup space is limited and recovery of old files is not important.
• If you want to store all backups for a certain time period, select
Keep Backups for n day(s)(1-3650). Enter a value (n) from 1 to 3650 to specify how many days the NSA stores all backup files.
After this day has expired, all backup files will be deleted.
Click this to go to the next screen.
10.10.7 Edit Job: Step 2
Use this screen to edit the schedule for the backup job.
Figure 155 Protect > Backup > Edit: Step 2
288
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 75 Protect > Backup > Edit: Step 2
LABEL
Scheduler Settings
Backup
Frequency
Every how many hours?
DESCRIPTION
Edit this by selecting from Hourly, Daily, Weekly and Monthly backup intervals. The screen changes depending on the item you select.
This is only available if you selected Hourly as your backup frequency.
On which minute of the hour?
Start Time
(hh:mm)
Select every how many hours the NSA performs the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Hourly as your backup frequency.
Select the minute (from 0 to 59) in an hour when the NSA performs the backup job.
This is available if you selected Daily, Weekly or Monthly as your backup frequency.
Every how many days?
Every how many weeks?
Step 1: Please select the month(s) of a year
Step 2: Please select the day of the month
Previous
Done
Select the time in hour:minute format when you want the NSA to perform the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Daily as your backup frequency.
Enter the interval between days when the NSA performs the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Weekly as your backup frequency.
Enter the interval between weeks when NSA performs the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Monthly as your backup frequency.
Select the month(s) when you want the NSA to perform the backup job.
This is only available if you selected Monthly as your backup frequency.
Select the day in a month when you want the NSA to perform the backup job.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to close the screen.
10.10.8 Restore Archive Screen
Use this screen to restore previous backups made with the NSA.
NSA210 User’s Guide
289
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.10.9 Restore Archive: Step 1
Click Protect > Backup screen (
Section 10.10 on page 277 ). You can restore a
previous backup job by selecting a backup job from the list and clicking Restore
Archive.
Figure 156 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 1
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 76 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 1
LABEL
Step 1. Select
Restore Source
Job Information
Job Name
Job Description
Backup Type
Scheduler
Information
Restored Time
DESCRIPTION
Select a previous archive backup that you want to restore to the NSA.
This is the name to identify the backup job.
This is a short description (up to 100 keyboard characters) for the backup job.
This is the type of backup implemented for the backup job.
This field displays the backup’s frequency.
Next
Select a previous backup in the list that you want to restore to your
NSA.
Click this to go to the next screen.
290
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.10.10 Restore Archive: Step 2
Use this screen to select the folder where the archive you want to restore is located.
Figure 157 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 2
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 77 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 2
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Step 2. Please select which file(s)/folder(s) to restore.
Folder Chooser Select the folder where the backup you want to restore is located.
Selected Folder
Previous
Next
This shows the path of the folder you selected.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to go to the next screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
291
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.10.11 Restore Archive: Step 3
Use this screen to select the location in the NSA where you want to restore your backup.
Figure 158 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 3
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 78 Protect > Backup > Restore Archive: Step 3
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Step 3. Set a restore target and start restoring
Original Location Select this to restore the files to their original location in the NSA.
Other Location Click this to select a folder where you want to place the restored files.
Click Browse to open the following screen.
292
Previous
Done
• Volume - Select a volume from the list.
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Type - This identifies the item as a file or folder.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to run the restore process and go back to the Backup screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
10.11 Restore Screen
Use this screen to restore previous backups made with the NSA, including archives and folders from internal, external or remote NSAs to the NSA.
10.11.1 Restore: Step 1
You can access this screen by clicking Protect > Restore.
Figure 159 Protect > Restore: Step 1
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 79 Protect > Restore: Step 1
LABEL
Step 1. Select
Restore Source
DESCRIPTION
Select a previous archive backup that you want to restore to the NSA.
Select Remote NSA if the file is in another NSA in the network that you used for your backup. Fill in the fields below when you choose this option.
IP Address
User
Password
Share Name
Test Connection
Select Internal or External Volume if you want to use another volume in the NSA or an attached USB hard disk for your backup.
Click Browse to select the backup file.
Enter the address of the NSA you want to use.
Enter the username you use to access the NSA.
Enter the password of your NSA account.
Enter the name of the share you want to use.
Click this to test your connection to the remote NSA that you have specified in the fields above.
NSA210 User’s Guide
293
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 79 Protect > Restore: Step 1
LABEL
Browse
DESCRIPTION
Click this to select where the previous backup that you want to restore is located.
Next
• Volume - Select a volume from the list.
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Type - This identifies the item as a file or folder.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Click this to go to the next screen.
10.11.2 Restore: Step 2
Select a previous archive backup that you want to restore to the NSA.
Figure 160 Protect > Restore: Step 2
294
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 80 Protect > Restore: Step 2
LABEL
Step 2. Select
Restore Point
DESCRIPTION
If you selected Remote NSA for the backup you want to restore, you can see a list of all the backups you performed in the Job Name table.
Job Name
Restored Time
Previous
Next
If you selected Internal or External Volume for the backup you want to restore, you can see a list of restore times for the backups you performed in the Restored Time table.
Select a previous backup job in the list that you want to restore to your NSA. Once you choose a job name, all available restore times for that backup job shows in the Restored Time table.
Select a previous backup job in the list that you want to restore to your NSA.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to go to the next screen.
10.11.3 Restore: Step 3
Use this screen to select the folder where the archive you want to restore is located.
Figure 161 Protect > Restore: Step 3
NSA210 User’s Guide
295
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 81 Protect > Restore: Step 3
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Step 3. Please select which file(s)/folder(s) to restore.
Folder Chooser
Selected Folder
Previous
Next
Select the folder where the backup you want to restore is located.
This shows the path of the folder you selected.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to go to the next screen.
10.11.4 Restore: Step 4
Use this screen to select the location in the NSA where you want to restore your backup.
Figure 162 Protect > Restore: Step 4
296
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 82 Protect > Restore: Step 4
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Step 3. Set a restore target and start restoring
Browse Click this to select a folder where you want to place the restored files.
Previous
Done
• Volume - Select a volume from the list.
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Type - This identifies the item as a file or folder.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Click this to go back to the previous screen.
Click this to run the restore process and go back to the Backup screen.
10.12 Syslog Server Screen
Use this screen to configure the NSA to accept syslog logs from syslog clients such as ZyXEL’s G-4100 v2.
Note: You may need to configure any firewalls between the NSA and the syslog clients in order to let the syslog traffic go to the NSA.
NSA210 User’s Guide
297
Chapter 10 Package Management
Click Applications > Syslog Server to open the following screen.
Figure 163 Applications > Syslog Server
298
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 83 Applications > Syslog Server
LABEL
Enable Syslog
Server
Log Location
Shares
Path
DESCRIPTION
Select this to have the NSA accept syslog logs from syslog clients.
Clear it to stop the NSA from accepting syslog logs from syslog clients.
Click View Files to browse to where you want to store the syslog logs on the NSA.
Select the share in which to store the syslog logs.
Use this if you want to further specify a folder within the share. This field displays the share folder’s path. Type the location of the folder using forward slashes as branch separators or use Browse to find or create a folder on the NSA.
After you click Apply in the Syslog Server screen the NSA creates a folder for the current month’s logs. The folder’s name uses the year and month in YYYYMM format.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 83 Applications > Syslog Server
LABEL
Purge Policy
DESCRIPTION
Select Enable Purge Policy and set a number of months in the Log
Deletion Interval field that displays to have the NSA delete the syslog messages after keeping them for the specified period of time.
Log Format
Apply
Reset
Regardless of how you set the purge policy, to save hard disk space the NSA archives the syslog logs in a .tgz file on the second day of each month and deletes the original folder and syslog files. The NSA creates a new folder for the syslog logs it receives after that. You can use a zip program such as 7-zip to open the archives.
Select the format you want to use for recording the received logs.
The Example item below the drop-down list boxes displays how the selected custom format looks. For example, if you select Full Date, the individual log entries would display with something like 2009 May
13 17:15:51 in front of them.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore the screen’s last-saved settings.
10.13 TFTP Server Screen
Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) is an Internet file transfer protocol similar to
FTP and often used for transmitting large numbers of small files. Use this screen to configure the NSA to accept log files from TFTP clients such as ZyXEL’s G-4100 v2.
Note: You may need to configure any firewalls between the NSA and the TFTP clients in order to let the log files go to the NSA.
Click Applications > TFTP Server to open the following screen.
Figure 164 Applications > TFTP Server
NSA210 User’s Guide
299
Chapter 10 Package Management
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 84 Applications > TFTP Server
LABEL
Enable TFTP
Server
Upload /
Download
Directory Setting
Shares
Path
DESCRIPTION
Select this to have the NSA accept log files from TFTP clients. Clear it to stop the NSA from accepting log files from TFTP clients.
Click View Files to browse to where you want to store the log files on the NSA.
Select the share in which to store the log files.
Use this if you want to further specify a folder within the share This field displays the share folder’s path. Type the location of the folder using forward slashes as branch separators or use Browse to find or create a folder on the NSA.
Apply
Reset
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore the screen’s last-saved settings.
10.14 Technical Reference
This section provides technical background information on the topics discussed in this chapter.
10.14.1 S.M.A.R.T Attributes
The following table describes some common S.M.A.R.T. attributes. If a higher or lower raw attribute value is better, it is indicated in the BETTER column. Since
S.M.A.R.T. attributes and their definitions vary by manufacturer, refer to the hard drive manufacturer for details about the attributes your hard drive supports.
Table 85 S.M.A.R.T. Attributes
ID
ATTRIBUTE
NAME
01 Read Error
Rate
02 Throughput
Performance
BETTE
R
Low
High
DESCRIPTION
Shows the rate of hardware read errors. If this is not zero, there is a problem with the disk surface or the read/write heads.
This is the hard drive’s general (overall) throughput performance. A decreasing value indicates a problem.
300
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
Table 85 S.M.A.R.T. Attributes (continued)
ID
ATTRIBUTE
NAME
BETTE
R
03 Spin-Up Time Low
DESCRIPTION
This is the average number of milliseconds the hard drive took for spindle spin up (from zero RPM to fully operational).
The total number of spindle start and stop cycles.
04 Start/Stop
Count
05 Reallocated
Sectors Count
Low Total number of reallocated sectors on the hard drive.
When the hard drive detects a read/write/verification error, it marks the sector as “reallocated” and transfers the data to a specially reserved (spare) area. The process is also known as remapping with “reallocated” sectors known as remaps. The more sectors the hard drive has to reallocate, the slower read and write speeds become.
This is the margin of a channel when it reads data.
06 Read Channel
Margin
07 Seek Error
Rate
Low
08 Seek Time
Performance
09 Power-On
Hours (POH)
10 Spin Retry
Count
11 Recalibration
Retries
12 Device Power
Cycle Count
13 Soft Read Error
Rate
19
0
Airflow
Temperature
19
0
19
1
Temperature
Difference from 100
G-sense error rate
High
Low
Low
High
Low
Low
High
Low
This is the rate of the magnetic heads’ seek errors. A failure in the mechanical positioning system, such as servo damage or a thermal widening of the disk, results in seek errors. An increasing number of seek errors indicate the condition of the disk surface and the mechanical subsystem are worsening.
This is an average performance indicator for the seek operations of the magnetic heads. Mechanical subsystem problems cause this value to decrease.
This is how many hours the hard drive has been in a power-on state. The raw value lists the total number of hours (or minutes, or seconds depending on the manufacturer).
This is the total number of spin start retry attempts. This is the number of attempts to spin up to fully operational speed the hard drive has made when the first attempt did not succeed. An increase in this value is an indicator of hard disk mechanical subsystem problems.
This is the number of times recalibration was requested when the first attempt did not succeed. A decrease in this value is an indicator of hard disk mechanical subsystem problems.
This is the number of times the hard drive has gone through a full power on and power off.
This is the number of uncorrected read errors the hard drive has reported. If this is not zero, back up your data.
This indicates the temperature of the airflow measured by a Western Digital hard drive.
This indicates the value of 100 - the temperature in degrees Celsius. Manufacturers can set a minimum threshold that corresponds to a maximum temperature.
This is the number of mistakes caused by impact loads.
NSA210 User’s Guide
301
Chapter 10 Package Management
20
6
20
7
20
4
20
5
20
1
20
2
20
3
19
4
19
5
19
2
19
3
19
6
Table 85 S.M.A.R.T. Attributes (continued)
ID
ATTRIBUTE
NAME
Power-off
Retract Count
BETTE
R
Low
Load/Unload
Cycle
Low
Temperature Low
DESCRIPTION
This is how many times the heads are loaded off the media.
This is the number of load and unload cycles into head landing zone position.
This is the hard drive’s internal temperature.
Hardware ECC
Recovered
Reallocation
Event Count
High
Low
19
7
19
8
19
9
20
0
Current
Pending Sector
Count
Low
Uncorrectable
Sector Count
UltraDMA CRC
Error Count
Low
Low
Write Error
Rate / Multi-
Zone Error
Rate
Low
Soft Read Error
Rate
Data Address
Mark Errors
Low
Low
Run Out Cancel Low
This is the time between ECC (Error Correction Code)corrected errors.
This is the total number of reallocation (remap) operations. The raw value is the total attempts to move data from reallocated sectors to a spare area. Successful and unsuccessful attempts are both included.
This is the number of unstable sectors awaiting reallocation. If the sector is later successfully written or read, this value decreases and reallocation is not performed. Only failed write attempts cause a reallocation, not read errors. This can be difficult to test since only direct I/O writes to the disk cause reallocations, not cached writes.
This is the number of errors reading or writing a sector that were not correctable. An increase in this value is an indicator of disk surface defects or mechanical subsystem problems.
This is the number of data transfer errors through the interface cable according to the ICRC (Interface Cyclic
Redundancy Check).
This is the total number of errors in writing sectors.
This is the number of read/write head off-track errors. If the value is not zero, make a backup.
This is the number of data address mark errors. This could also be a different, manufacturer-specific attribute.
This is the number of ECC (Error Correction Code) errors.
Soft ECC
Correction
Thermal
Asperity Rate
(TAR)
Flying Height
Spin High
Current
Low
Low
This is the number of errors corrected by software ECC
(Error Correction Code).
This is the number of thermal asperity errors. Thermal asperity is a read signal spike caused by sensor temperature rise due to touching the disk surface or contaminant particles.
This is the height of the hard drive’s read/write heads above the disk surface.
This is the quantity of high current used to spin up the drive.
302
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 10 Package Management
24
0
25
0
22
8
23
0
23
1
22
6
22
7
22
3
22
4
22
5
Table 85 S.M.A.R.T. Attributes (continued)
ID
20
8
20
9
22
0
22
1
22
2
ATTRIBUTE
NAME
Spin Buzz
Offline Seek
Performance
Disk Shift
G-Sense Error
Rate
Loaded Hours
Load/Unload
Retry Count
Load Friction
Load/Unload
Cycle Count
Load 'In'-time
BETTE
R
Low
Low
Low
Low
DESCRIPTION
This is the number of buzz routines to spin up the drive.
When the arm holding the read/write heads is stuck, the motor driving it tries to oscillate the arm to free it. This causes an audible vibration.
This is the hard drive’s seek performance during offline operations. Offline operations are tests the drive does itself as opposed to those that an external diagnostic tool has it do. Seek performance is how quickly the drive moves from track to track.
This is how far the disk has moved relative to the spindle
(this kind of shift is usually due to shock).
This is the number of errors that have resulted from external vibration and shock.
This is how long the hard drive has operated under data load (this requires movement of the magnetic head armature).
This is how many time the magnetic head has changed position.
This is resistance caused by friction in mechanical parts during operation.
This is the total number of load cycles.
Low
This is the total time that the magnetic heads actuator has had a load (not been in the parking area).
This is the number of attempts to compensate for variations in platter speed.
Torque
Amplification
Count
Power-Off
Retract Cycle
GMR Head
Amplitude
Temperature
Low
Low
This is how many times the magnetic armature was automatically retracted because the power was cut.
This is the amplitude of thrashing (or the distance of repetitive forward and reverse head motion).
This is the hard drive’s temperature.
Head Flying
Hours
Read Error
Retry Rate
Low
This is the total time that the head has been positioning.
This is the number of errors in reading from the disk.
NSA210 User’s Guide
303
Chapter 10 Package Management
304
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
11
Auto Upload
11.1 Overview
This chapter discusses the features in the Auto Upload screens.
The auto upload feature uploads media files stored in the NSA to the Flickr and/or
YouTube sharing websites. Besides web publishing and media server, auto upload is another convenient way to share media files with your friends and family. You can link the NSA to your Flickr and/or YouTube account and select shares for the
NSA to upload. The NSA uploads the media files stored in the specified shares to your Flickr and/or YouTube account. When you add new files to the specified shares, the NSA also automatically uploads the new files to your Flickr and/or
YouTube account.
11.2 What You Can Do
• Use the Flickr/YouTube screen (
) to upload photos and videos to your Flickr and YouTube accounts.
• Use the FTP Uploadr screen (
Section 11.5 on page 316 ) to upload files to FTP
servers.
11.3 What You Need to Know
FTP
File Transfer Protocol (FTP) is a file transfer service that operates on the Internet.
A system running the FTP server accepts commands from a system running an
FTP client. FTP is not a secure protocol. Your file transfers could be subject to snooping.
305
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
FTPES (File Transfer Protocol over Explicit TLS/SSL)
File Transfer Protocol over Explicit TLS/SSL (FTPES) is a file transfer service that uses TLS (Transport Layer Security) or Secure Socket Layer (SSL) for secure transfers across the Internet.
11.4 The Flickr/YouTube Screen
Use this screen to upload photos and videos to your Flickr and YouTube accounts.
Click Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube to open the following screen.
Figure 165 Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube
306
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 86 Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube
LABEL
Flickr/YouTube
Disable/Enable
DESCRIPTION
Select a service from the list and click this to turn the service on or off.
Pause/Resume
Config
Status
Service Name
Account
Information
If you disable the service and add more files to the watch folder(s), the NSA will not auto upload these files. However, the NSA still uploads any files added before you turned off the service.
Select a service from the list and click this to pause or resume the auto upload feature.
Select a service from the list and click this to manage the service’s settings.
This field displays the service’s status.
The service may be Enabled, Disabled, Uploading or Paused.
This field displays the name of a sharing website to which the NSA can automatically upload files.
This field displays the username and related information of the account to use with the auto upload feature.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
11.4.1 Configuring the Flickr Settings
In the Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube screen, select Flickr from the list and then click the Config button.
The following screen displays if you have not authorized the NSA to use a Flickr account. Click OK to continue the authorization process.
Figure 166 Linking NSA to Flickr
The web browser opens the Yahoo! Flickr login page. Enter your Yahoo account’s information and click Sign In.
Figure 167 Yahoo! Flickr Login Page
NSA210 User’s Guide
307
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
The following page displays asking for your authorization. Click OK, I’LL ALLOW
IT to establish a link between the NSA and your Flickr account.
Figure 168 Flickr Authorization
A confirmation page displays indicating successful authorization. Return to the
NSA Web Configurator. Click Get Ready in the following screen to complete the authorization process.
Figure 169 Confirming Flickr Authorization
308
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
Once the NSA is associated with your Flickr account, you can configure auto upload settings in the following screen.
Figure 170 Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube > Config (Flickr)
NSA210 User’s Guide
309
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 87 Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube > Config (Flickr)
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Flickr Account Configuration
Username
Photo Space
Usage
This field displays the Flickr account authorized for the auto upload feature.
This shows how much storage space for photos (in size and percentage) you have used and how much space is still available on your Flickr account.
Video Files Usage This shows how many videos you have uploaded and how many videos you can still upload to your Flickr account.
Switch User
Folder Selection
Click this to use a different Flickr account for the auto upload feature.
Folder Watch List This table displays a list of shares and folders selected for auto upload. Files stored in these locations are uploaded to your Flickr account.
Status This indicates whether the folder or share is available.
Share Name
Path
Action represents a valid folder. The folder is available for auto upload.
represents a missing folder. The share may be deleted from the
NSA, or the hard disk was removed from the NSA.
This is the share selected for auto upload.
This is the path of a folder selected for auto upload. The NSA only uploads files stored in the specified share or folder to your Flickr account.
Use the Remove icon to remove a folder from the Folder Watch
List.
310
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
Table 87 Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube > Config (Flickr) (continued)
LABEL
Add
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open the following screen where you can set a folder that contains files you want the NSA to automatically upload.
• Share - Select the share from the list.
• Path - Type the folder location in the share directly or click
Browse to open the following screen and navigate to the folder’s location.
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
• Type - This is the type of the folder/file.
to create
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Grace Period
Grace Period N minutes
Specify how long the NSA should wait when you add a new file for auto upload. For example, if you set the grace period to 5 minutes, the NSA uploads a new file after it has been in a watched folder for 5 minutes. You can choose from a range of 1 to 10080 minutes (up to one week).
Default Privacy
Who can see your media files on
Flickr?
Determine who has the right to see files uploaded to your Flickr account.
Select Only You if you do not want anyone else to see your files. You may also restrict the access to Your friends and/or Your family.
You can set up a friend/family list in your Flickr account.
Hide from public site area
Select Anyone to allow everyone to see your files.
Check this option to prevent others from finding your files when they perform a search in the Flickr website.
NSA210 User’s Guide
311
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
Table 87 Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube > Config (Flickr) (continued)
LABEL
Default Safety
Level
DESCRIPTION
Assign a safety level to your files.
Select Safe if the contents of your files are suitable for the general public.
Default Content
Type
Apply
Reset
Select Moderate if the contents of your files may be offensive to some people.
Select Restricted if the contents of your files are not suitable for certain people, such as children or your colleagues.
Select a content type for your files. You can choose Photo/Video,
Screenshots/Screencasts, or Illustration/Art/Animation/CGI.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore previously saved settings.
11.4.2 Configuring the YouTube Settings
In the Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube screen, select YouTube from the list and then click the Config button.
Note: Your YouTube account must be associated with a Google account.
Get a Google account and use it to log into YouTube. You can then merge the existing YouTube account to your Google account.
If you have not authorized a YouTube account on the NSA, the following screen displays. Enter your Google account’s e-mail address and password in the fields and click OK to authorize the service.
Figure 171 YouTube Account Settings
312
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
Once the NSA is associated with your YouTube account, you can configure auto upload settings in the following screen.
Figure 172 Applications > Auto Upload > Flickr/YouTube > Config (YouTube)
NSA210 User’s Guide
313
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 88 Applications > Auto Upload > Config (YouTube)
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Youtube Account Configuration
Username
Switch User
This field displays the Youtube account authorized for the auto upload feature.
Click this to use a different YouTube account for the auto upload feature.
Folder Selection
Folder Watch List This table displays a list of shares and folders selected for auto upload. Files stored in these locations are uploaded to your YouTube account.
Status This field indicates whether the share or folder is available.
Share Name
Path
Action represents a valid folder. The folder is available for auto upload.
represents a missing folder. The share may be deleted from the
NSA, or the hard disk was removed from the NSA.
This field displays the share selected for auto upload.
This field displays the path of a folder selected for auto upload. The
NSA only uploads the files stored in the specified share or folder to your YouTube account.
Use the Remove icon to delete a folder from the Folder Watch List.
314
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
Table 88 Applications > Auto Upload > Config (YouTube) (continued)
LABEL
Add
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open the following screen where you can set a folder that contains files you want the NSA to automatically upload.
• Share - Select the share from the list.
• Path - Type the folder location in the share directly or click
Browse to open the following screen and navigate to the folder’s location.
Apply
Reset
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
to create
• Type - This is the type of the folder/file.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Grace Period
Grace Period N minutes
Video Category
Specify how long the NSA should wait when you add a new file for auto upload. For example, if you set the grace period to 5 minutes, the NSA uploads a new file after it has been in a watched folder for 5 minutes. You can choose from a range of 1 to 10080 minutes (up to one week).
Select the category that best describes the media files you want to upload.
Default Privacy
Who can see your media files on
YouTube?
Determine who has the right to see files uploaded to your YouTube account.
Select Only You if you do not want anyone else to see your files.
Select Anyone to allow everyone to see your files.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore your previously stored settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
315
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
11.5 The FTP Uploadr Screen
The FTP Uploadr feature uploads files stored in the NSA to FTP servers. Besides web publishing and media server, auto upload is another convenient way to share media files with your friends and family. You can link the NSA to the FTP server or the FTP server on another NSA and select shares or folders for the NSA to upload.
The NSA uploads the files stored in the specified shares to the FTP server. When you add new files to the specified shares, the NSA also automatically uploads the new files to the FTP server.
Use this screen to configure the FTP Uploadr.
Click Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr to open the screen shown next.
Figure 173 Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr
316
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 89 Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr
LABEL
Enable FTP
Uploadr
DESCRIPTION
Use the check box to enable or disable the FTP Uploadr. Click Apply to save your changes.
When you disable the FTP Uploadr, a screen opens requesting confirmation. Select the check box to stop any current or queued uploads. If you do not select the check box, the FTP Uploadr will finish uploading the files that are already in the queue list. Clicking
Yes will disable the FTP Uploadr.
Add Server
Preferences
Edit Server
Delete Selected
Server(s)
Click this to add a target FTP server entry. See
Section 11.5.1 on page 318 for more details.
Click this to manage the settings of the FTP Uploadr.
Select a server from the list and click this to edit the FTP server entry.
Select a server from the list and click this to remove the FTP server entry.
Server
Information
Domain Name/IP
Address
Port Number
Remote Path
Account Name
Description
Select a server from the list and click this to display the status and settings about the FTP server.
This is the domain name or IP address of the FTP server.
This is the port number used by the FTP server.
The NSA automatically uploads files to this location of the FTP server.
This is the login account for the FTP server.
This is the information related to the FTP server.
NSA210 User’s Guide
317
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
11.5.1 Adding or Editing an FTP Server Entry
Use this screen to add or edit an FTP server entry for auto upload.
In the FTP Uploadr screen, click the Add Server or Edit Server button to open the following screen.
Figure 174 Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr > Add or Edit a Server
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 90 Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr > Add or Edit a Server
LABEL
Domain Name/IP
Address
Account Name
Password
Port Number
Remote Path
Description
Test Connection
Apply
Cancel
DESCRIPTION
Enter the domain name or IP address of the FTP server.
Enter the account name used to access the FTP server.
Enter the password associated with the account name.
Enter the port number for the FTP server.
Enter the path of the FTP server where the NSA automatically uploads files.
Enter additional information about this FTP server.
Click this to test your settings and check whether you can use the settings to connect to the FTP server.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
318
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
11.5.2 The FTP Uploadr Preferences Screen
Use this screen to configure the general settings for the FTP Uploadr.
In the FTP Uploadr screen, click the Preferences icon to open the following screen.
Figure 175 Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr > Preferences
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 91 Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr > Preferences
LABEL
Folder Watch List
Status
DESCRIPTION
This field indicates whether the share or folder is available.
Share Name
Path
Action represents a valid folder. The folder is available for auto upload.
represents a missing folder. The share may be deleted from the
NSA, or the hard disk was removed from the NSA.
This is the share selected for auto upload.
This is the path of a folder selected for auto upload. The NSA only uploads files stored in the specified share or folder to your FTP server.
Use the Remove icon to delete a folder from the Folder Watch List.
NSA210 User’s Guide
319
Chapter 11 Auto Upload
Table 91 Applications > Auto Upload > FTP Uploadr > Preferences (continued)
LABEL
Add
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open the following screen where you can set a folder that contains files you want the NSA to automatically upload.
• Share - Select the share from the list.
• Path - Type the folder location in the share directly or click
Browse to open the following screen and navigate to the folder’s location.
320
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click it.
to create
• Type - This is the type of the folder/file.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Settings
Grace Period
Bandwidth Limit
Apply
Reset
Close
Specify how long the NSA should wait when you add a new file for auto upload. For example, if you set the grace period to 5 minutes, the NSA uploads a new file after it has been in a watched folder for 5 minutes. You can choose from a range of 1 to 10080 minutes (up to one week).
Enter the maximum upload rate for auto upload. You can choose from a range of 0 to 100,000 KB/s. Enter 0 if you do not want to set any limit.
Use this to leave bandwidth on your network connection for other traffic, especially if your Internet connection has restricted upload speed.
Click this to save your changes in this section.
Click this to restore previously saved settings.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 2
Users
12.1 Overview
This chapter introduces the Users screens of the NSA. Use the Users screens to create and manage administrator and user accounts.
Administrators can:
• Configure and manage the NSA.
• Create volumes, shares, and user accounts.
• Assign individual users specific access rights for specific shares.
Users are people who have access rights to the NSA and can store files there for later retrieval. A user can:
• Manage shares that he owns.
• Change his own password.
• Access the contents of other shares to which he is given access rights.
12.2 What You Can Do
• Use the main Users screen (
Section 12.3 on page 322 ) to display a list of user
accounts created on the NSA.
• Use the Add User screen (
Section 12.3.2 on page 324 ) to create new user
accounts.
• Use the Edit User screen ( Section 12.3.2 on page 324 ) to edit the properties of
an existing account.
• Use the User Info screen (
Section 12.4 on page 328 ) to display the amount of
volume space used by a selected account and the account’s membership in any groups.
321
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 12 Users
12.3 The Users Screen
Click Sharing > Users to display the screen shown next.
Use this screen to create and manage accounts for users who can store files on the NSA.
Figure 176 Sharing > Users
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 92 Sharing > Users
LABEL
Add User
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open a screen where you can configure a new user account.
Search
Refer to
to see the screen.
Click this to display a search field. Type in the name of an account and then click Search to look up the account you specified. Click Clear to close the search function.
322
Edit User Select an account and click this to open a screen where you can edit the properties of the account.
Refer to
to see the screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 12 Users
Table 92 Sharing > Users (continued)
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Delete Selected Users Select an account and click this to open a screen where you can delete the user account.
User Info
Display Number
Go to Page
User Type
Username
Select an account and click this to open a screen displaying the amount of storage space used by the account. You can also check the account’s membership in any groups.
Refer to
to see the screen.
Click the drop-down menu to set how many accounts you want to display in one screen.
Click the drop-down menu to display and access more user accounts.
This field displays whether the account is an administrator account or a user account.
This field displays the username of each account.
12.3.1 User Icons
The following table describes the user icons.
Table 93 User Icons
ICON DESCRIPTION
The blue icon is for an administrator account.
The green icon is for a user account.
NSA210 User’s Guide
323
Chapter 12 Users
12.3.2 Adding or Editing General Account Settings
Use this screen to create or edit a NSA user account with NSA access password.
Click the Add User button in the Users screen to open the following screen. Click the Edit User button in the screen shown previously to edit an existing account.
Figure 177 Sharing > Users > Add a User
324
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 94 Users > Add a User
LABEL
Username
New Password
Password (Confirm)
Account Type
DESCRIPTION
Type a name from 1 to 32 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example) ASCII characters. See
Section 12.3.3 on page 325 for more details on usernames.
Create a password associated with this user. You can type from one to 14 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example) ASCII characters.
You must type the exact same password that you just typed in the above field.
Select Administrator to give the account full configuration and management access to the NSA.
Apply
Cancel
Select User to give the account basic access rights to the NSA and allow the user to manage his own shares, change his own password, and access the contents of other shares to which he is given access rights.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 12 Users
12.3.3 Usernames
Enter a username from one to 32 characters. The first character must be alphabetical (case insensitive, [A-Z a-z]); numeric characters are not allowed as the first character.
The username can only contain the following characters:
• Alphanumeric A-z 0-9. Unicode usernames are supported with CIFS logins, but not FTP or Web Configurator logins.
• Spaces
• _ [underscores]
• . [periods]
• - [dashes]
Other limitations on usernames are:
• All leading and trailing spaces are removed automatically.
• Multiple spaces within names are converted to a single space.
• Usernames are case insensitive. The username cannot be the same (no matter the letter case) as an existing user. For example, if a user exists with the name
'BOB', you cannot create a user named 'bob'. If you enter a user 'bob' but use
'BOB' when connecting via CIFS or FTP, it will use the account settings used for
'bob'.
• The username cannot be the same as a system username such as
ANONYMOUS-FTP nor be the same as an existing user. Other reserved usernames that are not allowed are:
• bin
• daemon
• ftp
• anonymous-ftp
• anonymous
• nobody
• root
• pc-guest
• admin
• password
NSA210 User’s Guide
325
Chapter 12 Users
12.3.4 Account Quota Per Volume
Click Sharing > Users > Add User (or Edit User) > Quota (per volume) to open the following screen. Use this screen to set how much storage space the user can use in specific volumes.
Figure 178 Sharing > Users > Add User > Quota (per volume)
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 95 Sharing > Users > Add User > Quota (per volume)
LABEL
Volume Name
Quota (per volume)
Apply
Cancel
DESCRIPTION
This column lists the volumes configured on the NSA.
Enter how much of the volume’s space (in megabytes) to allow for the user to store files.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
326
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 12 Users
12.3.5 Account Group Membership
Click Sharing > Users > Add User (or Edit User) > Group Membership to open the following screen. Use this screen to set which groups the user accounts belongs.
Figure 179 Sharing > Users > Add User > Group Membership
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 96 Sharing > Users > Add User > Group Membership
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Available Group(s) This field lists the groups created on the NSA to which the selected account does not belong.
This field lists the groups that the selected account belongs to.
Group Membership
Add Selected Group(s) Select a group from the Available Groups list and click this to add the account to that group.
Remove Selected
Group(s)
Select a group from the Group Membership list and click this to remove the account from that group.
Apply
Cancel
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
327
Chapter 12 Users
12.4 Displaying User Info
Use this screen to display a user’s information.
In the Users screen, select an account and click User Info to open the following screen.
Figure 180 Sharing > Users > User Info
328
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 97 Sharing > Users > User Info
LABEL
Username
Space Usage
Group List
Volume Name
Used Space
Group Name
DESCRIPTION
This field displays the selected username.
Click this to display the amount of volume space used by the selected account.
Click this to display the selected user’s group membership.
This field displays the volume(s) created on the NSA.
This field displays how much storage space the selected account is currently using. This only applies for files that the user saved onto the
NSA while logged in with that username.
This shows when you click the Group List tab.
OK
This displays the list of groups to which the selected user belongs.
Click this to close the current screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 3
Groups
13.1 Overview
This chapter introduces the Groups screens. Use the Groups screens to create and manage groups. You can assign users to groups and grant individual groups access rights to specific shares.
13.2 What You Can Do
• Use the main Groups screen (
Section 13.3 on page 329 ) to display and manage
a list of groups created on the NSA.
• Use the Add Group screen ( Section 13.3.1 on page 331 ) to create new groups.
• Use the Edit Group screen ( Section 13.3.1 on page 331 ) to edit the properties
of an existing group.
13.3 The Groups Screen
Use this screen to create and manage groups.
329
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 13 Groups
Click Sharing > Groups to display the screen shown next.
Figure 181 Sharing > Groups
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 98 Sharing > Groups
LABEL
Add Group
Search
DESCRIPTION
Click this to open a screen where you can configure a new group.
Click this to display a search field. Type the name of a group and then click Search to look up the group you specified. Click Clear to close the search function.
Edit Group
Delete Selected
Group(s)
Select a group and click this to open a screen where you can edit the properties of the selected group.
Select a group and click this to open a screen where you can delete the group.
330
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 13 Groups
Table 98 Sharing > Groups (continued)
LABEL
Display Number
Go to Page
Status
Group Name
DESCRIPTION
Click the drop-down menu to set how many groups you want to display in one screen.
Click the drop-down menu to select a page number. Jump to a different page to display and access more groups.
This field displays the group icon.
This field displays the group names created on the NSA.
13.3.1 Adding or Editing a Group
Use this screen to create or edit a NSA group.
Click the Add Group button in the Groups screen to open the following screen.
Click the Edit Group button in the screen shown previously to edit an existing group.
Figure 182 Sharing > Groups > Add or Edit a Group
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 99 Sharing > Groups > Add or Edit a Group
LABEL
Group Name
DESCRIPTION
Type a name from 1 to 32 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example) ASCII characters. See
Section 13.3.2 on page 332 for more details on group names.
Group Membership
Available User(s)
Use this field to assign group membership to individual users.
This field lists the user accounts created on the NSA that are not members of the current group.
Group Membership This field lists the user accounts added to the group.
Add Selected
User(s)
Select a user account from the Available Users list and click this to add the account to the group.
Remove Selected
User(s)
Apply
Cancel
Select a user account from the Group Membership list and click this to remove the account from the group.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
331
Chapter 13 Groups
13.3.2 Group Names
Enter a group name from 1 to 32 characters. The first character must be alphabetical (case insensitive, [A-Z a-z]); numeric characters are not allowed as the first character.
The group name can only contain the following characters:
• Alphanumeric A-z 0-9. Unicode usernames are supported with CIFS logins, but not FTP or Web Configurator logins.
• Spaces
• _ [underscores]
• . [periods]
• - [dashes]
Other limitations on group names are:
• All leading and trailing spaces are removed automatically.
• Multiple spaces within names are converted to a single space.
• Group names are case insensitive. The group name cannot be the same (no matter the letter case) as an existing group. For example, if a group exists with the name 'FAMILY', you cannot create a group named 'family'.
• The group name cannot be the same as a system group name such as
EVERYONE nor be the same as an existing group. Other reserved groups names that are not allowed are:
• nobody
• root
• everyone
332
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 4
Shares
14.1 Overview
A share is a set of access permissions mapped to a specific folder on a volume. It is equivalent to the Windows concept of a shared folder. You can map a share to a network drive for easy and familiar file transfer for Windows users.
14.2 What You Can Do
• Use the Shares screen ( Section 14.3 on page 334 ) to navigate a list of shares
created on the NSA.
• Use the Add Shares screen (
) to create additional shares on the NSA.
• Use the Recycle Bin screen (
Section 14.4 on page 339 ) to configure and clean
up the recycle bins.
• Use the Edit Share screen (
) to edit a share’s properties.
• Use the Share Browser screen (
) to navigate, add and edit the contents in a share.
333
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 14 Shares
14.3 The Shares Screen
Click Sharing > Shares in the navigation panel to open the following screen. This screen lists all shares created on the NSA.
Figure 183 Sharing > Shares
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 100 Sharing > Shares
LABEL
Add Share
Recycle Bin
Edit Share
Delete Share
DESCRIPTION
Click this to create a new share.
Click this to configure recycle bins.
Select a share and click this to edit the share.
Select a share and click this to remove or restrict access to the share.
334
Share Browser Select a share and click this to browse the share’s contents.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 14 Shares
Table 100 Sharing > Shares (continued)
LABEL
Status
DESCRIPTION
This field displays the share icons.
Share Type
Share Name
Share Path
Share Owner
Permission Type represents a Built-in share on a volume on the internal hard drives.
represents a Predefined or User-Created share on a volume on the internal hard drives. represents an Auto or User-Created share on a volume on the external (USB) devices. represents a disabled share that no user can access. represents a missing share. The NSA cannot find the hard disk associated with the share (the disk may be removed from the NSA for example). You may install the disk back to the NSA to recover the share, or you may delete the share from the NSA.
This field displays Built-in for system shares. You cannot delete these shares (these are the public and admin shares).
This field displays Predefined for default shares. You cannot delete these shares (these are the video, music, and photo shares).
This field displays User-created for shares that an administrator has created. You can delete these shares.
This field displays Auto for shares that are automatically created on an external (USB) device when a user plugs in the device.
This field displays the share’s names.
This field displays the share’s file path, for example, volume1/ music.
This is the name of the user account to which this share belongs.
This field displays the access permission of a share.
Everyone on the network can access a Public share.
Only the share owner can access a Private share.
An Advanced share allows you to assign specific access rights
(read-only for example) to individual users/groups.
NSA210 User’s Guide
335
Chapter 14 Shares
14.3.1 Adding or Editing Share
Click Add Share to create a new share. In the Shares screen, select a share and click Edit Share to open the following screen. Use this screen to create or edit a share.
Figure 184 Shares > Add Share (or Edit Share)
336
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 101 Shares > Add Share (or Edit Share)
LABEL
Share Name
Volume
DESCRIPTION
Type a share name from 1 to 239 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example) ASCII characters. The name cannot be the same as another existing share. See
for more information on share names.
You should have already created volumes (a single accessible storage area with a single file system) on the NSA. Select the one that contains the folder that you want to share out.
Make this share owned by
Enable this share
Enable Recycle
Bin
Publish this share to Media
Server
You cannot modify this when editing a share.
Select the administrator or user account that can own (manage) this share. The share owner controls access rights to the share.
Click this to allow access to this share.
Click this to activate the recycle bin. When you delete a file from this share, a recycle folder is created to store the deleted item.
This shows only when you enable the Media Server (
.
Publish this share to Web
Select this option to have the NSA share files in this folder with media clients. The media clients do not have to use a password to play the shares you publish.
This shows only when you enable the Web Publish (
.
Select this option to let people use a web browser to access this share’s files without logging into the Home screens.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 14 Shares
Table 101 Shares > Add Share (or Edit Share) (continued)
LABEL
Share Access
DESCRIPTION
Assign access rights (full, read only or deny) to users or groups. If you publish the share to the media server or the web, all users will have at least read-only access to the share, regardless of what you configure here.
Edit
Apply
Cancel
Keep it private to owner means only the share owner (selected above) can access the share.
Make it Public means every user (including people who do not have accounts on the NSA) can access the share.
Advanced allows you to assign specific access rights (full, read only or deny) to individual users/groups.
This button is available only when you select Advanced share access.
Click this to configure advanced share access rights.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
14.3.2 Configuring Advanced Share Access
In the Sharing > Shares > Add Share or Edit Share screen, select Advanced from the Share Access drop-down list. Click Edit to open the following screen.
Use this screen to configure share access rights for individual users and groups.
Figure 185 Sharing > Shares > Add Share (or Edit Share) > Advanced
NSA210 User’s Guide
337
Chapter 14 Shares
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 102 Sharing > Shares > Add Share (or Edit Share) > Advanced
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Available Users/Groups This field lists the users/groups to which you can assign access rights.
Authority Use this field to assign access rights to users/groups.
Full Control gives users/groups full access (read, write and execute) to all files contained within this share.
Read-Only gives users/groups read-only access (they cannot modify nor execute) to all files contained within this share.
Deny blocks access (users/groups cannot read, modify, nor execute) to all files contained within this share.
Among all access rights, Deny has the highest priority. For example, User A belongs to Group 1. You assign User A full access rights to the Music share but deny access rights to Group
1. Then User A cannot access the Music share.
Apply
Cancel
Note: If you deny access to all users, no-one can use the share, not even the administrator.
Click an arrow button to move users/groups between the left and right fields. Use the arrow buttons to assign access rights to users/groups.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
14.3.3 Public and ANONYMOUS Share Access Rights
If you make a share public, users do not need to log in.
With ANONYMOUS FTP, you must enter either 'anonymous' or 'ftp' as the username. Any other name is considered a username, so must be valid and have a corresponding correct password.
338
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 14 Shares
14.4 The Recycle Bin Configuration Screen
Use this screen to periodically clean up items in all recycle bins.
14.4.1 Recycle Bins
Recycle bins in the NSA help users recover accidentally deleted files or folders in the shares. When you delete an item, a recycle folder is created within the share to hold the deleted item.
Every share can have its own recycle folder. You must enable the recycle-bin function to recycle deleted items. You can configure this setting when you add or edit a share. See
Section 14.3.1 on page 336 for details on activating the recycle
bin in a share.
Later if you want to retrieve a deleted item, you can locate the item in the recycle folder. You may move or copy the deleted item to another share.
14.4.2 Configuring Recycle Bins
In the Sharing > Shares screen, click Recycle Bin to open the following screen.
Figure 186 Sharing > Shares > Recycle Bin
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 103 Sharing > Shares > Recycle Bin
LABEL
Clean Recycle Bin every N days
DESCRIPTION
Specify how often you want to clear the contents in all recycle bins. The specified days correspond to how long a file has been stored in a recycle bin. For example, if you set the interval to be
3 days, recycle bins will clean up items deleted or not accessed for 3 days.
Note: Cleaning up recycle bins permanently removes the files from the NSA.
Click this to immediately remove contents from all recycle bins. Clean all recycle bins now
Apply
Cancel
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
339
Chapter 14 Shares
14.5 The Share Browser Screen
Use this screen to create folders, upload files, and edit files within the share.
Figure 187 Sharing > Shares > Share Browser
340
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 104 Sharing > Shares > Share Browser
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Create Folder Type a folder name and click Apply to make a new folder. The name can be 1 to 239 single-byte (no Chinese characters allowed for example)
ASCII characters. The name cannot be the same as another existing
folder in the same path. See Section 3.4.7 on page 67
for more information on folder names.
Upload Click this to add files to the share. Use Browse to locate a file and click
Apply to upload the file. Note that the size of each file should be less than
2 GB.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 14 Shares
Table 104 Sharing > Shares > Share Browser (continued)
LABEL
Rename
DESCRIPTION
Select a folder or file and click this to open a screen. Enter the name you want and click OK to make the changes.
Note: When you change a file name, make sure you keep the file extention.
Delete Select a file/folder from the list and click this to open a warning screen.
Click Yes to delete the file/folder, or click No to close the screen.
Move
Copy
Select a file/folder from the list and click this to relocate the file/folder to another share.
Select a file/folder from the list and click this to make a duplicate of the file/folder to another share.
This is the name of the share and folder path that you are in.
Current location
Type The icon in this column identifies the entry as a folder or a file. Click a music or video file’s play icon to play the file.
Name
The folder with an arrow pointing up is for the link that takes you to the next higher layer in the share’s folder tree.
This section lists the share’s existing folders or files. Click to the right of the file/folder name to select the file/folder. You can also click the folder’s name to navigate to a sub-folder within the folder.
Size This field displays size of the file.
Modified Date This field displays a file’s latest modification date.
Close Click this to close the screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
341
Chapter 14 Shares
14.5.1 Moving or Copying Files
Use this screen to move or copy files to another share.
In the Share Browser screen, select a file or folder and click Move or Copy to open the following screen.
Figure 188 Sharing > Shares > Share Browser > Move (or Copy)
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 105 Sharing > Shares > Share Browser > Move (or Copy)
LABEL
Shares
Path
Browse
DESCRIPTION
Select the destination share from the drop-down list.
This field displays the share folder’s path. You can use Browse to find or create a folder on the NSA or type the location of the folder using forward slashes as branch separators.
Click this to open the following screen and navigate to the location of the file/folder.
342
Yes
Close
• Current Location - This is the location of the selected folder.
• Folder Name - Enter a new folder name and click to create it.
• Type - This identifies the item as a folder or file.
• Name - This is the name of the folder/file.
Select a folder. If you don’t select a folder, a forward slash (/) displays in the Path field. All contents within the specified share are automatically selected.
Click Apply to save your settings and Cancel to close the screen.
Click this to move or copy the file/folder to the designated share.
Click this to return to the Share Browser screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 5
Maintenance Screens
15.1 Overview
This chapter discusses the Maintenance screens. The Maintenance screens allow you to manage system configurations.
15.2 What You Can Do
• Use the Power screen (
) to configure power settings for the NSA, including power saving, UPS, power on/off after power failure, and a power on/off schedule.
• Use the Log screen (
Section 15.4 on page 348 ) to check the system’s logs.
• Use the Configuration screen (
Section 15.5 on page 352 ) to backup or restore
the NSA configuration file.
• Use the SSL screen (
Section 15.6 on page 353 ) to configure HTTPS and the
NSA’s SSL certificate.
• Use the Firmware Upgrade screen (
Section 15.7 on page 356 ) to upload new
firmware.
• Use the Shutdown screen (
) to restart or shut down your NSA.
343
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
15.3 The Power Screen
Use this screen to manage power settings for the NSA.
Click Maintenance > Power to display the following screen.
Figure 189 Maintenance > Power
344
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 106 Maintenance > Power
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Power Management
Turn off hard disk(s)
Enter the number of minutes the NSA will sit idle before spinning the hard disks down to sleep. The default power-off time is 15 minutes.
Minimum UPS Capacity
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 106 Maintenance > Power (continued)
LABEL
Minimum UPS
Capacity
DESCRIPTION
When you use an APC Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) with a USB connection to the NSA, the NSA shuts itself down if the APC UPS’s battery charge gets down to the percentage you specify in this field. This allows the NSA to shut down properly and avoid data loss caused by a power failure when the UPS stops supplying power.
Power On After
Power Failure
Keep Former
Status
Always Power
On
A setting around 50% is recommended. A setting close to 100% is not recommended since it would cause the NSA to shut down whenever the
UPS is charging. A setting close to 0 is also not recommended since the
UPS would not have enough power to allow the NSA to shutdown properly.
Select an option to set whether or not the NSA restarts when the power is restored after a power failure.
Select this option to have the NSA automatically restart only if it was operating when the power failed. The NSA remains off if it was already off when the power failed.
Select this option to keep the NSA operating as much of the time as possible. The NSA restarts automatically even if it was turned off when the power failed.
Always Power
Off
Select this option to keep the NSA from automatically restarting when the power is restored after a power failure. This is a computer’s
“traditional” behavior. Select this if you have other servers such as a domain controller or DNS server that you want to start or check after a power failure before the NSA turns on.
Power On/Off Schedule
Enable Power
Control
Schedule
Select this option to have the NSA turn itself off and on or reboot according to the schedules you configured.
Click Edit to go to the screen where you can configure the power control schedules.
Apply
Reset
Refer to
for this screen.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to restore previously saved settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
345
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
15.3.1 Editing the Power Control Schedule Screen
Click Maintenance > Power Management > Edit to open this screen. Use this screen to configure power control schedules to have the NSA turn on, turn off, or reboot at specified times.
Figure 190 Maintenance > Power Management > Edit
346
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 107 Maintenance > Power Management > Edit
LABEL
Power Control
Schedule List
DESCRIPTION
This table lists the power on, power off, and reboot schedules. For example, you could have one schedule to turn the NSA on every morning, at 8:00, another schedule to turn it off every evening at 18:00, and a third schedule to have it reboot every Friday at 14:00.
Type
Frequency
Click a column’s heading cell to sort the schedules by that column’s criteria. Click the heading cell again to reverse the sort order.
This field displays whether the power control schedule has the NSA turn on, turn off, or reboot.
This field shows how often (monthly, weekly, or daily) the NSA is to apply this power control schedule.
Execute Time This field shows when the NSA is to use this power control schedule
(when the NSA is to turn on, turn off, or reboot).
Actions
Add Power
Control
Schedule
Click the Delete icon to remove a power control schedule from the list.
Use this part of the screen to configure power on, power off, and reboot times.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 107 Maintenance > Power Management > Edit (continued)
LABEL
Type
Frequency
Execute Time
(hh:mm)
DESCRIPTION
Select whether this power control schedule has the NSA turn on, turn off, or reboot.
Select whether the NSA is to apply this power control schedule entry on a monthly, weekly, or daily basis.
Enter the time, day, and/or day of the month as appropriate for this power control schedule entry. Leave more than 10 minutes between the execution times of the entries.
If the NSA turns off or restarts while a user is transferring files to or from the NSA, the transfer fails. The user will need to restart the transfer.
The NSA skips a scheduled restart or power off if the execution time comes while the NSA is doing any of the following:
• Resynchronizing a RAID
• Upgrading firmware
• Replacing the configuration file
If the NSA is turned off at the time when a restart or power off is scheduled, the NSA does not perform the restart or power off.
If the NSA is turned on at the time when a power on is scheduled, the
NSA does not perform the power on.
Use this part of the screen to configure power on, power off, and reboot times.
Please select the day of the month
This is only available if you set the Frequency to Monthly.
Choose the day of each month for the power control schedule entry.
Every how many weeks?
This is only available if you set the Frequency to Weekly.
Every how many days?
Enter the interval between weeks and choose the day of the week for the power control schedule entry.
This is only available if you set the Frequency to Daily.
Add
Apply
Cancel
Enter the interval between days for the power control schedule entry.
Click this to add the power control schedule to the list.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
347
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
15.4 The Log Screen
Click Maintenance > Log to open the following screen.
Use this screen to display all NSA logs. There are at most 512 entries in the log.
Older logs are removed by the system. You cannot download the log file via FTP or
CIFS.
Figure 191 Maintenance > Log
348
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 108 Maintenance > Log
LABEL
Refresh
DESCRIPTION
Click this to update the log display.
Purge all Logs Click this to erase all logs from the NSA.
Report Config Click this to open a screen where you can configure email alerts for logs.
Display
#
Time
Class
Severity
Message
Refer to
to see the screens for this.
The screen always shows all logs by default. Choose a specific log category to view logs for just that category.
This is the log entry’s number in the list according to the currently selected sort order.
This shows the date and time the log was created. Click the top of the column to sort by oldest or newest.
This displays the log category; see
for details.
This displays how serious the log is rated by the NSA. See
Table 118 on page 358 for more information.
This displays a description of the log. Click the top of the column to sort by alphabetical or reverse alphabetical order.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
15.4.1 Report Config Screen
In the Log screen, click Report Config to do the following:
• Use the Email Setting screen (
) to enable and configure e-mail alerts from the NSA.
• Use the Report Setting screen ( Section 15.4.3 on page 350 ) to select the type
of alerts you want to receive through e-mail and schedule when the NSA e-mails the alerts.
• Use the Syslog Server Setting screen (
) to enable the syslog server and select the categories to include in the log report.
15.4.2 Email Setting
You can enable and configure e-mail alerts from the NSA. In the Report Config screen, click the Email Setting tab to open the following screen.
Figure 192 Maintenance > Log > Report Config: Email Setting
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 109 Maintenance > Log > Report Config: Email Setting
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Enable Log Email Click this to have the NSA e-mail log alerts to your e-mail account.
Email To Enter the e-mail address where you want to receive the log alerts.
Email From Enter the e-mail address the NSA uses in the From field of the e-mail header for its log alerts.
Email Server Enter the e-mail server address the NSA uses to send e-mail alerts,
Email Format Select the e-mail format you want the NSA to use in its e-mail alerts.
Use SMTP
Authentication
User
Click this if the e-mail server you want the NSA to use for its e-mail alerts requires a username and password.
Enter the username for the e-mail server.
NSA210 User’s Guide
349
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 109 Maintenance > Log > Report Config: Email Setting (continued)
LABEL
Password
Password
(Confirm)
After apply settings, send a test email
Apply
Cancel
DESCRIPTION
Enter the password for the e-mail server.
Re-enter the password to confirm it.
Click this to have the NSA send a test e-mail to the settings you have entered.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
15.4.3 Report Setting
You can select the type of alerts you want to receive through e-mail and schedule when the NSA e-mails the alerts. In the Report Config screen, click the Report
Setting tab to open the following screen.
Figure 193 Maintenance > Log > Report Config: Report Setting
350
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 110 Maintenance > Log > Report Config: Report Setting
LABEL
Email Alert
DESCRIPTION
Check the type of log alerts you want to receive in your e-mail.
Email Report
Report Time
Apply
Cancel
Select All Log to include all types of log alerts.
Check the type of log alerts you want to receive in your e-mail.
Select All Log to include all types of log alerts.
Select how often (Weekly, Daily or Hourly), what day in the week
(Monday to Sunday) and which time (hour:minutes) the NSA delivers its e-mail alerts.
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
15.4.4 Syslog Server Setting
You can enable the syslog server and select the categories to include in the log report. In the Report Config screen, click the Syslog Server Setting tab to open the following screen.
Figure 194 Maintenance > Log > Report Config: Syslog Server Setting
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 111 Maintenance > Log > Report Config: Syslog Server Setting
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Enable Syslog
Server
Check this to enable syslog server.
Server Address Enter the syslog server address you want the NSA to use for its log alerts.
In the table below, check the type of log alerts you want to receive in your e-mail. Select
All Log to include all types of log alerts.
Apply
Cancel
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to return to the previous screen without saving.
NSA210 User’s Guide
351
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
15.5 The Configuration Screen
Click Maintenance > Configuration to open the following screen. Use this screen to backup or restore the NSA configuration settings.
Figure 195 Maintenance > Configuration
352
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 112 Maintenance > Configuration
LABEL DESCRIPTION
Backup Current Configuration Settings
Backup Click this to save the current configuration of the NSA to your computer. A pop-up screen appears asking you to confirm. Click
OK to continue or Cancel to quit.
Restore Configuration When you restore a file configuration, the NSA checks the volumes/share paths on the NSA and the configuration file.
Browse
Restore
If the volume exists but the share path is missing in the NSA, the NSA automatically creates this share path.
If the volume does not exist on the NSA, the Status of the share will show “missing share icon” in Shares screen (see
Click this to locate a previously-saved configuration file.
Click this to load the previously-saved configuration file to the
NSA. This replaces your current NSA configuration settings with the settings in the previously-saved configuration file.
Reset MySQL Database
Password
A pop-up screen appears asking you to confirm. Click OK to continue or Cancel to quit.
This displays if you installed php-MySQL-phpMyAdmin
through the Package Management screen ( Section 10.4 on page 248 ).
Click this to reset the password for your MySQL database.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
15.6 SSL Certification
Click Maintenance > SSL to open this screen, where you can turn on HTTPS, create a public key certificate, or upload a public key certificate that was issued by a known certificate authority.
Figure 196 Maintenance > SSL
NSA210 User’s Guide
353
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 113 Maintenance > SSL
LABEL
Force HTTPs
DESCRIPTION
Select the Force HTTPs option to turn on the NSA’s web browser security. Anyone who connects via HTTPS to the NSA must install the public key certificate associated with it.
Note: The NSA will restart the Web Configurator after you click Apply.
The NSA displays a warning screen if applying your change may disconnect some users. Click Apply if you want to continue.
354
Install System Default
CA
Click Download button to save a copy of the NSA’s public key certificate to your local computer. This is useful for installing the certificate without having to connect to the NSA, or for sending by email to other users for them to install prior to logging into the NSA for the first time. After saving the certificate to your computer, double-click it to install it.
Modify the Existing
Certificate
Note: Each web browser handles certificate installation differently. See
for more information.
Select Edit a self-signed CA certificate, then follow the onscreen instructions for creating a public key certificate signed by the NSA as the local certificate authority.
Note: Use certificates created and signed by the NSA if the device is not open to external access.
Select Create a certificate authorized by other CA, then follow the on-screen instructions to install a certificate that has been authorized by a third-party certificate authority.
Note: Use this method if the device is open to external access, such as allowing users to connect through the
Internet using FTP over TLS or HTTPs.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
15.6.1 Modifying or Creating a Certificate
When you select the Edit a self-signed CA certificate option, then click the Edit button, a screen opens to allow you to make adjustments to the NSA’s public key certificate.
The screen is also the same for the Create a certificate authorized by other
CA option
.
Figure 197 Maintenance > SSL > Create or Edit a Certificate
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 114 Maintenance > SSL > Create or Edit a Certificate
LABEL
Common Name
Host IP Address
Host Domain Name
Organizational Unit
(Optional)
Organization
(Optional)
Country (Optional)
Key Type
Key Length
DESCRIPTION
This name describes the certificate’s origin, either in the form of an IP address or a domain name.
Select this option and enter the NSA’s IP address if you want to use this for the common name.
Select this option and enter the NSA’s domain name if you want to use this for the common name
Enter this name of the organizational unit which owns or maintains the NSA. This is an optional field.
Enter this name of the organization or company which owns or maintains the NSA. This is an optional field.
Enter this name of the country in which the NSA is located. This is an optional field.
Select the certificate’s key type, either RSA or DSA. RSA is a public-key encryption and digital signature algorithm, while DSA is only a digital signature algorithm.
Select the encryption key length. The longer the key, the better the encryption security. The only drawback to having a long key is that the file encrypted with it swells in size as well.
NSA210 User’s Guide
355
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 114 Maintenance > SSL > Create or Edit a Certificate
LABEL
Apply
Cancel
DESCRIPTION
Click this to save your changes.
Click this to discard changes and close the window.
15.7 The Firmware Upgrade Screen
Use this screen to upgrade the NSA firmware. You should first have downloaded the latest firmware files from the ZyXEL website.
Do not turn off the NSA while it is upgrading the firmware or you may render it unusable.
Click Maintenance > FW Upgrade to open the following screen.
Figure 198 Maintenance > FW Upgrade
356
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 115 Maintenance > FW Upgrade
LABEL
Firmware File
Browse
Upload
Reset
DESCRIPTION
Type the location of the firmware file you want to upload
Click this to find the file on your computer
Click this to upload the new firmware. The NSA automatically restarts after you upgrade. Wait until the restart completes before accessing the NSA again. If you interrupt the upgrade, then the NSA may become unusable.
Click this to refresh the screen.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 115 Maintenance > FW Upgrade (continued)
LABEL
Periodically Check for
Latest Firmware
Automatically
DESCRIPTION
Select this to have the NSA regularly check ZyXEL’s server for updated firmware. The NSA notifies you at login if a new firmware is available.
Check for Latest
Firmware Now
Click Apply to save this field’s setting.
Click this to check ZyXEL’s server for updated firmware.
15.8 The Shutdown Screen
Use this screen to turn off the NSA or perform a software restart. A software restart is faster than turning the NSA off and then turning it on again. Before shutting down or restarting, check the System Status > Active Sessions screen to make sure that no one is logged into the NSA or transferring files to or from the
NSA.
Click Maintenance > Shutdown to open the following screen.
Figure 199 Maintenance > Shutdown
The following table describes the labels in this screen.
Table 116 Maintenance > Shutdown
LABEL
Restart
Shutdown
DESCRIPTION
Click this to have the device perform a software restart.
Click this to shut down the system and restart it again later.
When you click the Restart button a pop-up screen will appear asking you to confirm. Click OK to continue or Cancel to quit the restart.
Figure 200 Maintenance > Shutdown > Confirm Restart
NSA210 User’s Guide
357
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
When you click the Shutdown button a pop-up screen will appear asking you to confirm. Click OK to continue or Cancel to quit the shutdown.
Figure 201 Maintenance > Shutdown > Confirm Shutdown
15.9 Technical Reference
This section provides technical background information on the topics discussed in this chapter.
15.9.1 Log Classes
The following table shows information on log classes.
Table 117 Log Classes
LOG
CATEGORY
DESCRIPTION
Users
Shares
Services
This log class shows information on user access to the NSA.
This log class shows information on shares being created or deleted.
This log class shows information on the operation of the NSA’s built-in services.
This log class shows all other system related messages.
System
Network
Storage
This log class shows information on network configuration, setting changes and so on.
This log class shows information on the NSA’s internal and external storage activities.
Backup This log class shows information on all backup-related activities.
Auto Upload This log class shows information on automatic uploads done by the NSA.
15.9.2 Log Severity Levels
The following table shows information on log severity levels. Levels range from 0 to 6 with 0 being the most severe level log and 6 being an informational log only.
Log levels are not displayed in the logs and are for your reference only.
Table 118 Log Severity Levels
LEVEL
0
1
DESCRIPTION
Emergency
Alert
358
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 118 Log Severity Levels (continued)
5
6
3
4
LEVEL
2
DESCRIPTION
Critical
Error
Warning
Notice
Info
15.9.3 Log Messages
Here are some example log messages.
Table 119 Log Messages
CLASS SEVERITY
Auto upload INFO
Auto upload INFO
Auto upload WARNING
Auto upload INFO
MESSAGE
%s is queued.
%s uploaded (Flickr or YouTube Upload).
error uploading "%s" (%s): %s
%s will not be uploaded to %s for there is already a duplicate file.
Failed to upload %s to %s (FTP Upload) : %s
Successfully upload %s to %s (FTP Upload)
[USB %s] Backup Folder Does Not Exist.
Auto upload INFO
Auto upload INFO
ERROR Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
ERROR
ERROR Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
ERROR
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
[USB %s] Target Folder Does Not Exist.
[USB Sync] Failed at %s: It is a Folder in Internal Volume.
But It is not a Folder in USB.
[USB Sync] Failed at %s: It is a Folder in USB. But It is not a Folder in Internal Volume.
[USB Sync] Failed at File %s.
[USB Sync] Sync Failed at Folder %s.
Modify COPY/SYNC Button Configuration: %s
Please Change Your Folder Name. Invalid Path: %s
[USB Sync] Copying %s from Internal Volume to Backup
Folder.
[USB Sync] Copying %s from Internal Volume to USB.
[USB Sync] Copying %s from USB to Backup Folder.
[USB Sync] Copying %s from USB to Internal Volume.
NSA210 User’s Guide
359
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 119 Log Messages (continued)
CLASS
Copy/Sync
Button
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Copy/Sync
Button
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
SEVERITY
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
NOTICE
ERROR
ERROR
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
MESSAGE
[USB Sync] Deleting %s from Internal Volume.
[USB Sync] Deleting %s from USB.
[USB Sync] Deleting %s from USB Recursively.
[USB Sync] Finished. Elapsed Time %s Seconds.
[USB Sync] Moving %s from Internal Volume to Backup
Folder.
[USB Sync] Moving %s from USB to Backup Folder
[USB Sync] Skip %s: File not Exist
[USB Sync] Skip %s: Not a Regular File.
[USB Sync] Start Pre-Processing: Generating File Lists.
[USB Sync] Start Copying Files.
Download service cannot find a volume
Download service failed to find ipfilter.dat
Download service add a URL download job %s
Download service delete %s by user
Download service download %s error (0x%08x)
Download service download %s finished in %s
Download service found a new torrent file %s
Download service initialized
Download service pause %s by user
Download service set %s to %s priority by user
Download service set default download location to %s
Download service set max BT download rate to %d KB/s by user
360
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 119 Log Messages (continued)
CLASS
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
Download
Service
SEVERITY
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
WARNING
MESSAGE
Download service set max BT upload rate to %d KB/s by user
Download service set max download slot to %d
Download service set seeding time to %d minutues
Download service set TCP port to %d and UDP port to %d
Download service set torrent monitor location to %s
Download service start to download %s
Download service stopped
Download service suspend %s because of no data income detected or to limit max download slot
Download service add comment %s to %s by user
Download service set min upload/download ratio to %d%
Download service set max seed slot to %d
Download service start loading ipfilter.dat
Download service clear all ipfilter rules
Download service blocked peer removed from peer list
Download service disconnected blocked peer
Download service incoming connection blocked by IP filter
Download service peer from tracker blocked by IP filter
Download service abort loading ipfilter.dat
Download service will update ipfilter.dat from %s after %d day(s)
Download service added %d rules from ipfilter.dat
Download service detected invalid ip range %s in ipfilter.dat
Download service default location does not exist. Load default
NSA210 User’s Guide
361
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 119 Log Messages (continued)
CLASS
Download
Service
Groups
Groups
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Network
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
SEVERITY
WARNING
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
NOTICE
NOTICE
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
MESSAGE
Download service default torrent location does not exist.
Load default
Add new group %s.
Delete group %s.
%s is active because of changing Port Group. Enable DHCP client.
%s is inactive because of changing Port Group. Disable
DHCP client.
%s MTU > (%s MTU - 8), %s may not work correctly.
(%s MTU - 8) < %s MTU, %s may not work correctly.
Add interface %s.
Because %s link down. Default route will not apply until %s link up.
Because base interface %s will be disabled.Interface %s is disabled now., base_ud_iface
Network Config setting is changed
Interface %s was disabled.
Interface %s was enabled.
Port Group on %s is changed. Renew DHCP client.
Account pppoe was changed
Add account pppoe
ADD interface ppp0
Interface ppp0 will reapply because Device-Ha become active status.
Interface ppp0 will reapply because Device-Ha is not running.
Network port is disabled
Network port is enabled
HTTP management port has changed to %s
Clock timezone is set to GMT%s
Clock timezone is set to default
Clock daylight saving is enabled
Clock daylight saving is disabled
Clock has disable daylight saving
MyClock has enable daylight saving
MyClock has set timezone to %s
MyClock has set timezone to default
The date and time are updated from NTP server.
The date and time are updated manually.
The time is updated manually.
362
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Shares
Shares
Shares
Shares
Shares
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Table 119 Log Messages (continued)
CLASS
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Services
Shares
SEVERITY
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
WARNING
WARNING
WARNING
INFO
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
INFO
INFO
ERROR
INFO
ERROR
ERROR
INFO
INFO
NOTICE
NOTICE
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
MESSAGE
FTP server stops
FTP server starts
MyClock has changed daylight saving interval
MyClock has disabled daylight saving interval
NTP server has set to '%s'
NTP server has set to null
The NTP service is disabled.
The NTP service is enabled.
Reaching Maximum Allowed Rules
Rule is empty
The Rule Does Not Exist
Expire recycle-bin finish for share %s, process time: %s seconds, remove %s file (%s bytes)
Add new disabled share %s for unshared folder: %s in volume: %s.
Add new share %s.
Delete share %s.
Purge all files in recycle-bin folder in share: %s.
Recycle-bin disabled. Remove recycle-bin folder in share:
%s.
Eject External Disk (%s): FAILED
Eject External Disk (%s): SUCCESS
Relabel Raid to [%s]: FAILED
Start Repairing Degraded Raid by disk%s: FAILED
Relabel Raid to [%s]: SUCCESS
Start Repairing Degraded Raid by disk%s: SUCCESS
Auto Repair Degraded RAID by disk%s.
There is a RAID Degraded.
Cancel External Volume Scan: FAILED
Cancel Internal Volume Scan: FAILED
Cannot Unmount Volume and RAID. System Busy Using
Volume and RAID: Please Reboot and Try Again
Create External Normal Volume [%s] (%s): FAILED
Create Internal Volume [%s] (%s): FAILED
Rename External Volume to [%s]: FAILED
Scan External Volume: FAILED
Scan Internal Volume (%s operation): FAILED
Cancel External Volume Scan: SUCCESS
Cancel Internal Volume Scan: SUCCESS
NSA210 User’s Guide
363
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Users
Users
Users
Users
Users
Users
Users
Users
Users
Table 119 Log Messages (continued)
CLASS
Storage
System
System
System
System
System
System
System
System
Storage
Storage
Storage
Storage
System
System
System
System
SEVERITY
INFO
INFO
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
System
System
USB
USB
USB
USB
Users
Users
Users
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
ALERT
ALERT
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
MESSAGE
Create External Normal Volume [%s] (%s): SUCCESS
Create Internal Volume [%s] (%s): SUCCESS
Rename External Volume to [%s]: SUCCESS
Scan External Volume: SUCCESS
Scan Internal Volume (%s operation): SUCCESS
NTP update failed
NTP updates successfully from %s
NTP fails to update from %s
Device is rebooted by administrator!
Device is shutdown by administrator!
DNS server is changed.
Hostname is cleared.
Hostname is set to '%s'.
System description is changed.
System description is empty now.
DNS server setting is changed
DNS server address is changed to be given from DHCP server
DNS server address is changed to be assigned by user
Name server is changed.
An external APC UPS device is plugged/unplugged.
An external Mass Storage device is plugged/unplugged.
An external Printer device is plugged/unplugged.
An external USB hub device is plugged/unplugged.
Failed %s login attempt (incorrect password or inexistent username)
Failed %s login attempt (incorrect password or inexistent username)
User %s has logged in from %s!
User %s has logged out from %s!
User %s from %s has been logged out (re-auth timeout)!
User %s from %s has been logged out (lease timeout)!
Add new user %s by %s from %s.
User %s password has been changed.
Delete user %s by %s from %s.
The user %s from %s has attempted to change the user %s password but old password verification fail.
User %s on %u.%u.%u.%u has been denied access from
%s
User %s password has been changed by %s from %s.
364
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
Table 119 Log Messages (continued)
CLASS
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Power
Management
Power
Management
Power
Management
Power
Management
Power
Management
Power
Management
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Backup/
Restore
Power
Management
Power
Management
Power
Management
Power
Management
SEVERITY
ERROR
INFO
ERROR
ERROR
INFO
INFO
ERROR
INFO
INFO
ERROR
ERROR
ERROR
INFO
INFO
ERROR
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
INFO
MESSAGE
When query remote target [%s]: %s
Backup job [%s] successfully
When backup [%s]: %s
When backup [%s], error happens: %s
Start to restore backup job [%s].
Restore backup job [%s] successfully.
Restore backup job [%s] failed: %s
Start to restore backup job [%s] from [%s].
Restore from [%s] successfully.
Restore from [%s] failed: %s
When restore [%s]: %s
When restore job [%s], error happens: %s
Job [%s] is triggered by schedule
Job [%s] is triggered by user
Job [%s] is resulted as failed
Job [%s] is finished successfully
Job [%s] is pending because other job is running
Job [%s] is canceled by user
Restore job [%s] is triggered by user
[Power On] schedule is triggered.
[Power Off] schedule is triggered.
[Reboot] schedule is triggered.
NSA210 User’s Guide
365
Chapter 15 Maintenance Screens
366
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 6
Protecting Your Data
16.1 Overview
This chapter compares the different ways of protecting data on the NSA and explains how to use backup management software included on the CD.
16.2 Protection Methods
There are a variety of ways to protect your data on the NSA. Below is a summary table of what can be done in each situation.
Table 120 Overview of Protection Methods
SITUATION
Unexpected NSA behavior after configuration changes
Need to transfer data from your computer to the NSA after volume(s) have been created
Data infected by virus
ACTION
Back up the NSA configuration file before you make major configuration changes.
Use the Memeo Autobackup program.
Use anti-virus software on your computer to scan files before saving them onto the NSA.
Although this may be slow so you may want to schedule it to occur while no one is using the NSA.
Hard drive malfunction.
NSA malfunction
Network down
Natural disaster such as a fire or earthquake occurs where your NSA is located
Use a firewall with anti-virus capability on your network.
Use RAID.
Back up data to another NSA or external USB hard drive.
The following sections describe these methods in more detail. See
Section 7.5.2 on page 180 for more information on RAID.
367
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 16 Protecting Your Data
16.3 Configuration File Backup and Restoration
Use the Maintenance > Configuration menus to create a file of your NSA configurations such as passwords, shares and volumes created, network settings and so on. If you’re going to do some major configuration changes, then it is advisable to create a configuration backup file. If things go wrong after you make the configuration changes, you can always go back to the previous configuration by restoring an earlier configuration file.
If you forgot the NSA password, then use the RESET button (see
Section 1.4.2 on page 27 ) to return the NSA to the factory default configuration.
Note: Configuration File Backup and Restoration does not affect data (your files and folders), volumes on the NSA.
16.4 Memeo Autobackup
Use the Memeo Autobackup software (included on the CD) on your computer to schedule and manage backups. You can backup from your computer to the NSA.
You can also backup from one NSA on your network to another. You can set the
Memeo Autobackup software to automatically back up files from your computer to the NSA whenever you modify the files.
Install the included DLNA-compliant Memeo Autobackup software on your
Windows XP or later computers to let them browse and play files stored on the
NSA.
Note: The Memeo Autobackup program uses the same network port as the NAS
Starter Utility to discover the NSA. To avoid a port conflict, do not run the
Memeo Autobackup program at the same time as the NAS Starter Utility.
Use the Memeo Autobackup software included on the CD to automatically back up selected files from your computer to the NSA whenever you modify the files.
Memeo Autobackup works with Windows XP, Windows Vista, and both the 32 bit and 64 bit versions of Windows 7.
16.4.1 Memeo Autobackup Installation and Setup
Note: The Memeo Autobackup program uses the same network port as the discovery utility to discover the NSA. To avoid a port conflict, turn off the discovery utility before using Memeo Autobackup.
368
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 16 Protecting Your Data
1
Since a computer restart is required, close your other files and programs before installing the Memeo Autobackup software.
2
Insert the included CD into your CD-ROM drive. Click the Tools icon in the screen that displays. Then click Memeo Instant Backup Software.
Note: If this screen does not display, use Windows Explorer (My Computer) to go to the CD-ROM (commonly drive D). Double-click setup.exe.
3
Follow the instructions to install the software.
Note: Memeo Autobackup requires Microsoft.NET version 2.0. The wizard installs it for you if it is not already on your computer.
4
When you see the following screen, select Network Places and click the link to select your backup folder.
Figure 202 Memeo Autobackup Configuration
5
Select the NSA’s mapped drive and click OK.
Figure 203 Mapped Drive
NSA210 User’s Guide
369
Chapter 16 Protecting Your Data
6
In this screen, select the items that you want to back up.
Figure 204 Backup Items
7
This screen lists the items you selected for backup. Confirm your selections and click Next.
Figure 205 Confirm Backup Items
370
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 16 Protecting Your Data
8
Specify a name for your backup plan (or just use the default). Click Next and then
Done.
Figure 206 Backup Plan Name
16.4.2 Using Memeo Autobackup After the Initial Setup
After you have installed and configured Memeo Autobackup, double-click the icon in the system tray to open the program’s start screen.
If the icon is not displayed, you can click Start > Programs > Memeo
Autobackup > Memeo Autobackup to start it.
Figure 207 Memeo Autobackup
NSA210 User’s Guide
371
Chapter 16 Protecting Your Data
372
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 7
Using Time Machine with the
NSA
17.1 Overview
Time Machine is a backup system provided by Mac OS X. It automatically backs up everything on your Mac, including pictures, music, videos, documents, applications, and settings. This chapter helps you to enable Time Machine in OS X to allow and use your NSA as a backup volume.
Follow the steps below to set up Time Machine on your Mac so your NSA can be used for backup.
1
Create an Account and a Share on the NSA
2
Set Time Machine to Support Network Volume
3
4
Creating a Sparse Bundle File for the NSA
5
17.2 Create an Account and a Share on the NSA
Before configuring Time Machine on your Mac, you need to create an account and a share on the NSA through Web GUI using a Web browser.
373
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
1
Login to your NSA. Click Sharing > Users to display the Users screen. Click Add
User.
2
Enter user1 as the Username and 12345 as the New Password. Retype the password to confirm. Then click Apply to finish adding the new user account.
User1 will be added to the list on the Users screen. (If you need more information about adding user account, please refer to
3
Click Sharing > Shares to display the Shares screen. Click Add Share.
374
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
4
Enter share01 as the Share Name. In the Make this share owned by list, select user1. Then in the Share Access list, select Keep it private to owner.
Click Apply to save the settings. Share01 is added to the list on the Shares screen. (If you need more information about adding share, refer to
5
Now the account user1 and share share1 have been created on your NSA. You may begin with configurations on your computer.
Note: It is suggested to set a static IP address for the NSA so you do not need to
update the IP each time your computer connects to the NSA. Refer to
for more information on how to set your NSA to a static IP
address.
17.3 Set Time Machine to Support Network
Volume
Follow the steps below to set Time Machine function so it can support the network volume NSA.
NSA210 User’s Guide
375
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
1
Click Finder > Go > Utilities to open the Utilities window. Open the Terminal application.
376
2
Enter the following in Terminal: defaults write com.apple.systempreferences
TMShowUnsupportedNetworkVolumes 1 then press [Enter].
3
This allows Time Machine to support a network volume. Reboot your computer.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
17.4 Mounting the NSA on the Mac
Now you need to mount share01 on the NSA to your computer. This is the place where you will backup your files.
1
Click Finder > Go > Connect to Server. The Connect to Server window opens.
2
In the Sever Address box, enter: smb://username@ip-address-of-nas/backupfolder. For this example, enter: smb://[email protected]/share01. Then click
Connect.
3
When share01 is successfully mounted to the Mac, the screen looks like this:
NSA210 User’s Guide
377
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
17.5 Creating a Sparse Bundle File for the NSA
Now you need to create a sparse bundle disk image file, which is a virtual file system image that Time Machine can backup your files. It should be created locally on the Mac and then mounted to share01 of the NSA.
17.5.1 Finding out Computer Name and MAC Address
Before creating a spare bundle, you need to know the computer name and MAC address of your computer.
1
To find out your computer name, go to the Apple menu > System Preferences
> Sharing. The computer name is at the top of the screen.
2
To find out the MAC address of your computer, click Apple > About This MAC >
More Info > Network > Locations. The MAC address is under Ethernet.
378
3
Another way to find out the MAC address is to enter the following in Terminal: ifconfig en0 | grep ether | sed s/://g | sed s/ether//
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
Press [Enter] to display the MAC address.
17.5.2 Creating a Sparse Bundle File
There are two ways to create a sparse bundle disk image file. You can use Disk
Utility or Terminal.
17.5.2.1 Disk Utility
Click Finder > Go > Utilities. Open the Disk Utility application.
NSA210 User’s Guide
379
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
4
Click File > New > Blank Disk Image.
5
In the New Blank Image screen, do the following:
5a
Enter the name of the sparse bundle in Save As. The format of the name is
“ComputerName_MacAddress”. Use “-” for spaces in the computer name and remove all colons in the MAC address. In this example, the sparse bundle name is Coffee-Bean_001f5bed6c7a. Then select the place that you want to save the file in Where.
5b
Enter a name for the volume. Here, we use TimeMachine.
5c
Setup the Volume Format, Encryption, Partitions, and Image Format as step c shows in the screen below.
5d
After finishing steps a - c, setup the Volume Size of the sparse bundle. This is the virtual volume size for you to save your files. Select Custom if you want to manually enter the volume size. It is suggested to set the size larger than that of your physical hard drive so all files on your hard drive can be backed up. to Click Create to start creating the sparse bundle.
380
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
Note: Set the Volume Size after you’ve set Image Format to sparse bundle disk
image.
The size of a sparse bundle file is smaller than the full physical size because it only takes up as much actual disk space as the data contained within (without unused space). You might not be able to set the Volume
Size if your image format is not correct.
a b d c
17.5.2.2 Terminal
You can also create a sparse bundle file by using Terminal. Enter the following: sudo hdiutil create -size $SPECSIZE -type SPARSEBUNDLE nospotlight -volname $VOLUMENAME -fs "Case-sensitive Journaled
HFS+" -verbose ./$COMPUTERNAME_MACADDRESS
In
$SPECSIZE
, enter the volume size for the sparse bundle. Here, the size is set to
200g. In
$VOLUMENAME
, enter the volume name TimeMachine. For
$COMPUTERNAME_MACADDRESS
, enter the computer name and MAC address: Coffee-
Bean_001f5bed6c7a. Click [Enter] to start creating. The sparse bundle file will be in your Home folder.
NSA210 User’s Guide
381
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
17.5.3 Mounting the Sparse Bundle to the NSA
1
After the sparse bundle file is created on the desktop or Home folder, copy the file to share01 of the NSA.
2
Open share01 on your NSA. There should be a sparse bundle folder. This is the place where all your backup files from Time Machine will be. Remove the local sparse bundle file on your computer and the hidden file ._Coffee-
Bean_001f5bed6c7a.sparsebundle in share01.
17.6 Using Time Machine
Now the NSA is ready to be used as a backup volume for your computer.
382
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
1
Click Apple > System Preferences. Then go to System and select Time
Machine.
2
Turn Time Machine ON. Then click Change Disk.
3
Select share01 as the backup disk. Then click Use for Backup.
NSA210 User’s Guide
383
Chapter 17 Using Time Machine with the NSA
4
When prompted, the username and password of share01, enter user1/12345.
Then click Connect.
5
Time Machine starts backing up files to share01 after 120 seconds. If you want to backup immediately, click Time Machine icon and select Backup Now.
6
The screen shows the status of the backup once the process begins.
7
If you want to stop the backup process, click Time Machine icon and select Stop
Backing Up. Then turn Time Machine OFF.
384
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 8
Troubleshooting
18.1 Troubleshooting Overview
This chapter offers some suggestions to solve problems you might encounter. The potential problems are divided into the following categories.
•
Power, Hardware, Connections, and LEDs
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Some Features’ Screens Do Not Display
•
•
Download Service and Broadcatching Functions
•
•
•
•
385
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
18.2 Power, Hardware, Connections, and LEDs
The NSA PWR LED does not turn on (no LEDs are on).
• Make sure the NSA is turned on.
• Make sure you are using the power adaptor or cord included with the NSA.
• Make sure the power adaptor or cord is connected to the NSA and plugged in to an appropriate power source. Make sure the power source is turned on.
• Turn the NSA off and on.
• If the problem continues, contact the vendor.
The HDD LED is off.
The HDD LED is off when the NSA cannot detect a hard drive in the drive bay.
Replace or install a hard drive. See
Installing or replacing a hard drive.
The HDD LED is orange.
Orange means that the NSA detected an error on the hard drive (like a bad sector for example). The NSA automatically tries to recover a bad sector, but the LED stays orange until the NSA restarts. Even if the hard drive still functions, it is recommended that you replace it since errors are a sign that the hard drive may fail soon. See
Installing or replacing a hard drive.
The HDD LED is red.
Red means the hard drive has failed and the NSA can no longer detect it. Replace
the hard drive. See Installing or replacing a hard drive.
If you are using a RAID I volume, you may still be able to use the volume but you should replace the faulty drive as soon as possible.
386
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
I want to install another hard disk in my NSA.
• The NSA has one internal hard disk bay. It can only support one internal hard disk.
• You can attach an external (SATA) hard disk to your NSA. Use the eSATA port in the rear panel of the device. The hard disk can be configured as an internal volume in the Storage > Volume screen. See
for more details.
Installing or replacing a hard drive.
Do not remove or install the hard drive while the NSA is turned on.
The NSA must be turned off before you remove or install the hard drive.
1
Turn the NSA off, remove the front panel and the drive tray and make sure:
• there is a SATA I or SATA 3.0 Gbit/s compatible hard drive installed.
• the hard drive is installed correctly in the drive tray. Push the tray back into
NSA drive bay until the screw hole at the top of the drive tray is flush with the drive bay (see the NSA Quick Start Guide and
• the hard drive could be faulty. Try a different hard drive or test the original hard drive in a different NSA or computer.
2
If you had to replace the drive, turn on the NSA and go to the Storage screen.
I want to install my internal (SATA) hard disk and access the data inside it.
The NSA needs to install its firmware on the internal (SATA) hard disk. It formats the hard disk and creates partitions such that the firmware is installed on one partition, and data is stored on another. In the process, the NSA deletes all existing data in the hard disk.
I want to connect my external (SATA) hard disk and access the data inside it.
NSA210 User’s Guide
387
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
You need to turn the external (SATA) hard disk into a volume using the Storage >
Volume screen before the NSA can use it. In the process, all existing data in the hard disk is deleted.
The LAN LED (by the LAN port) is off.
• Make sure the Ethernet cable is connected properly to the NSA and connected to another (Ethernet) device. Make sure the other device is turned on. If it’s connected directly to a computer, make sure that the computer network card is working (ping 127.0.0.1 on the computer).
• Use another Ethernet cable. If you’re connecting to a Gigabit Ethernet, make sure you’re using an 8-wire Ethernet cable.
• If the problem continues, contact the vendor.
See Section 1.4 on page 26 for a description of NSA LEDs.
My NSA turns off or reboots by itself.
Check the Power Management screen. This is where you configure power settings for the NSA, including power saving, UPS, power on/off during power failure and power on/off schedule. The NSA may be set to turn off under certain conditions.
A power failure occurred while the NSA is downloading files.
• If power failure occurs during the active download period, the NSA will verify whether the downloaded files were damaged.
• If a file is corrupted, the NSA will download the file again.
• If the file is intact but not completely downloaded, the NSA will resume the download task after it restarts.
388
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
18.3 NAS Starter Utility
The NAS Starter Utility cannot discover my NSA.
• Close the NAS Starter Utility and reopen it.
• Check your hardware connections and make sure they are set up correctly.
• Only one instance of the NAS Starter Utility can run on your computer. Make sure you close any duplicate windows for this application.
• Wait for the SYS LED to stop blinking before clicking Discover.
• Confirm that the computer running the NAS Starter Utility has a network connection. See the section on the NSA’s LAN connection for related information.
• The computer running the NAS Starter Utility can only discover NSAs in the same subnet. NSAs connected to the same switch or router as your NAS Starter
Utility computer are usually in the same subnet unless the router is doing subnetting or the switch is implementing VLAN.
• The Memeo Autobackup program uses the same network port as the NAS
Starter Utility to discover the NSA. To avoid a port conflict, do not run the
Memeo Autobackup program at the same time as the NAS Starter Utility.
I was able to access the NSA on a previous attempt but I cannot access the NSA anymore.
If you enable jumbo frames on the NSA in a network that does not support them, you will lose access to the NSA. If this occurs, you will have to restore the factory default configuration. The reset process does NOT affect the volume settings, nor data stored on the NSA. Push the RESET button on the NSA’s rear panel and release it after you hear a beep (
).
I want to initialize my internal (SATA) hard disk again.
Initializing the hard disk deletes all existing data in it! Back up your files before doing this procedure.
If you want to initialize an internal (SATA) hard disk that has been initialized by the NSA previously, you will need to reformat the hard disk using your computer.
To do this:
NSA210 User’s Guide
389
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
1
Connect the hard disk to your Windows computer (follow the instructions of your hard disk manufacturer on how to do this). Go to My Computer > Manage >
Disk Management. Locate the hard disk (on some systems, the hard disk shows up as the disk without a drive letter assigned to it).
2
Right-click on all partitions in the hard disk and click Format.
Make sure you select the correct hard disk. Otherwise, all data in the formatted hard disk will be gone.
I don’t want to initialize my hard disk but I cannot clear the Initialize Hard Disk check box in the Firmware Path screen.
The checkbox in the Firmware Path screen can be cleared only if the hard disk format is compatible with the NSA. If the hard disk format is not compatible with the NSA, this checkbox is checked by default and cannot be modified.
I have at least two NSAs in my network, how do I identify which one I want to configure in the NAS Starter Utility screens.
If you have several NSAs connected to your computer/network, you can do the following to identify the NSA you want to configure:
1
Go to the Device List screen.
2
Hover your mouse over the host name under Host until a box pops up. This shows the details of each NSA device.
3
You can identify the device you want to configure by checking the MAC addresses of the NSAs. You can check the MAC address of your NSA by checking the attached sticker in the device housing.
18.4 NSA Login and Access
390
I forgot the server name of the NSA.
• The default server name is nsa210.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
• Use the NAS Starter Utility to discover your NSA. If you have admin privileges, you can directly change the IP address of the NSA using the NAS Starter Utility.
• If the server name has changed and you don’t have the NAS Starter Utility, see
Section 18.4.1 on page 392 to use the RESET button to return the default
setting.
I cannot get to the NSA login screen.
• Use the NAS Starter Utility to discover your NSA. If you have admin privileges, you can directly change the IP address of the NSA using the NAS Starter Utility.
• Make sure you have used the NAS Starter Utility to initialize your NSA. The hard disk has to have the firmware installed before the NSA can be used.
• If you used the RESET button, the NSA may have a new IP address. Close and reopen the NAS Starter Utility to discover the NSA.
• Make sure the NSA is turned on.
• If you are trying to login directly by typing the server name into your web browser’s address field, make sure you are using the correct server name as the web site address.
• The default server name is nsa210, if you have changed the server name, use the new one.
• If the server name has been changed and you do not know the new server name, see the troubleshooting suggestions for
I forgot the server name of the
• If it still doesn’t work, try using the NAS Starter Utility.
• Check the hardware connections, and make sure the LEDs are behaving as
expected. See the Quick Start Guide and Section 1.4 on page 26 .
• By default, the NSA gets an IP address automatically. The NSA assigns itself an
IP address if no device assigns one. If your computer is also set to get an IP address automatically, the computer and the NSA can both assign themselves IP addresses and communicate. See
Section 8.4 on page 187 if you need to
configure the NSA with a static IP address.
• Make sure your computer’s IP address is in the same subnet as the NSA’s IP address. You can use the NAS Starter Utility to find the NSA’s IP address. See
Appendix A on page 415 for how to change your computer’s IP address. Skip this if you know that there are routers between your computer and the NSA.
• Ping the NSA from your computer. Make sure your computer’s Ethernet adapter is installed and functioning properly. In a (Windows) computer, click Start, (All)
Programs, Accessories and then Command Prompt. In the Command
Prompt window, type “ping” followed by the NSA’s IP address (use the NAS
Starter Utility to find the NSA’s IP address if you don’t know it) and then press
[ENTER].
• Make sure you are using Internet Explorer 6.0 (and later) or Firefox 1.07 (and later).
NSA210 User’s Guide
391
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
• Make sure your Internet browser does not block pop-up windows and has
JavaScript and Java enabled. See Appendix B on page 447 . With Internet
Explorer 6, you may also have to enable scripting of safe ActiveX controls. See
18.4.1 Reset the NSA
If you forget your password or cannot access the Web Configurator, use the
RESET button at the rear of the NSA. When you use the following reset procedure, the system name and admin password are returned to the factory defaults.
You may need to close and re-open the NAS Starter Utility to discover the NSA.
This is because the NSA automatically re-acquires IP address information, so its IP address may change since. If no IP address information is assigned, the NSA uses
Auto-IP to assign itself an IP address and subnet mask. For example, you could connect the NSA directly to your computer. If the computer is also set to get an IP address automatically, the computer and the NSA will choose addresses for themselves and be able to communicate.
1
Press and hold the RESET button (for about two seconds) until you hear a beep, and then release it.
2
The NSA automatically restarts to complete the reset.
I forgot the password.
• The default password is 1234.
• If you have changed the password and forgotten it, you will have to reset the
NSA.
18.4.2 Enabling Scripting of Safe ActiveX Controls
If pages of the Web Configurator do not display properly in Internet Explorer, check that scripting of safe ActiveX controls is enabled.
392
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
1
In Internet Explorer, click Tools, Internet Options and then the Security tab.
Figure 208 Internet Options: Security
2
Click the Custom Level... button.
3
Under Script ActiveX controls marked safe for scripting, make sure that
Enable is selected (the default).
4
Click OK to close the window.
Figure 209 Security Settings - Script Safe ActiveX Controls
NSA210 User’s Guide
393
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
I can see the login screen, but I cannot log in to the NSA.
• Make sure you have entered the username and password correctly. The default username is admin, and the default password is 1234. These fields are casesensitive, so make sure [Caps Lock] is not on.
• Turn the NSA off and on.
• If this does not work, see
Section 18.4.1 on page 392 to reset the device.
I cannot see the multi-language Web Configurator screens while using Internet
Explorer.
Use
Section 18.4.2 on page 392 to enable the scripting of safe ActiveX controls.
The Web Configurator logs out by itself.
The Web Configurator management session automatically times out if it is left idle for 15 minutes. Simply log back into the NSA if this happens to you.
18.5 I Cannot Access The NSA
I cannot access a share.
• Check that the NSA is turned on and connected to the network. Try to ping the
NSA or use the NAS Starter Utility to discover it.
• Make sure you have used the NAS Starter Utility to initialize your NSA. The hard disk has to have the firmware installed before the NSA can be used. See
for more information.
• Check that you entered your login name and password correctly.
• Check that the share exists and check its access settings.
• Check if the shared folder is a subfolder of another (parent) share. Check that the parent share’s access rights do not conflict with the subfolder share. It is recommended that you do not create subfolder shares.
394
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
• Check if there are any existing mapped network drives to the NSA. You may need to disconnect existing mapped network drives as a new mapped network drive connection may use (different) previously-saved login information. To do this, open Windows Explorer and click Tools > Disconnect Mapped Network
Drives.
• Check that the volume in which the share resides, exists and is not down or degraded. If it is down or degraded, see
.
• Make sure you have the client for Microsoft networks installed and enabled in your network connection’s properties.
• In Windows XP, click Start > Settings > Control Panel > Network
Connections > Local Area Connection > Properties.
• Check that Client for Microsoft Networks is in the list of components and has its check box selected.
18.6 Users Cannot Access the NSA
A local user cannot access a share
• Check that the NSA is turned on and connected to the network. The local user should try to ping the NSA or use the NAS Starter Utility to discover it.
• The local user should check that he entered his login name and password correctly.
• Check if the share exists and has the correct access settings for this user.
• Check the Access Control List (ACL) of read/write permissions associated with specific files and/or folders. Account names added to the list are linked to the files and folders that they are allowed to access, along with what kinds of actions they are allowed to perform with those files and folders (delete, move, rename, and so on).
• The user’s computer may already be connected to another of the NSA’s shares using a different user name and/or password. This can happen without the user realizing it if the user’s computer automatically connects to a share at logon.
Right-click any other connected shares and click Disconnect. Then re-attempt to connect to the desired share.
• Check if the share has an ANONYMOUS or EVERYONE access right. If the user is already logged into a share using her username and password, she will NOT be able to access a share that has ANONYMOUS FTP only access rights (as these require ‘no login’). In this case she should log out and try to access the share again without logging in. See
Section 14.3.3 on page 338 for more details.
• Check if the shared folder is a subfolder of another (parent) share. Check that the parent share’s access rights do not conflict with the subfolder share. It is recommended that you do not create subfolder shares.
NSA210 User’s Guide
395
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
• Check if the user belongs to a group with conflicting access rights. DENY always takes precedence. If you allow a user FULL access to a share but set his group to DENY, then he will NOT be able to access the share.
• The local user should check if there are any existing mapped network drives to the NSA. He may need to disconnect existing CIFS connections as new CIFS connection may use previously-saved login information that may be different to
NSA login.
• Check that the array in which the share resides, exists and is not down or
degraded. If the array is down or degraded, see Section 18.2 on page 386 .
• If the user is using DFS links, then he can only access the NSA using CIFS and not FTP.
• Check that the share has not been disabled.
I cannot import domain user or user group information even though testing of the connection to the domain controller is OK.
• Check the NSA’s DNS setting. The DNS server the NSA is using must be able to resolve the domain controller’s address. If the domain controller uses a private
IP address, the NSA needs to use a private DNS server. If the domain controller uses a public IP address, the NSA needs to use a public DNS server.
• Leave the domain and re-join it.
A domain user can’t access a share.
In addition to the checks listed previously for local users, check that the domain controller is turned on and connected to the network.
A user can access a share but cannot access individual folders or files within the share.
• Check the Access Control List (ACL) of read/write permissions associated with the share’s specific files and/or folders. Account names added to the list are linked to the files and folders that they are allowed to access, along with what kinds of actions they are allowed to perform with those files and folders
(delete, move, rename, and so on).
396
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
18.7 Storage Volumes
I want to use my external (SATA) hard disk to create a RAID 1 volume but I cannot see RAID 1 in the list when I click Create a SATA volume.
• Refer to Section 4.6.1 on page 86 for a tutorial on how to create a RAID 1
volume.
• Make sure that the eSATA hard disk is connected to the NSA’s eSATA port located in the device’s rear panel. The eSATA LED’s light should be on.
• The capacity of your eSATA hard disk must be equal to or greater than the internal (SATA) hard disk capacity.
• If the eSATA hard disk is detected by the NSA but you still do not see RAID 1 in the list, check if the internal hard disk is already configured as a JBOD volume.
Note that after installing the firmware on the internal hard disk, the internal hard disk is configured as a JBOD volume by default. If this is the case, create a
RAID 1 volume by clicking the Migrate button (
Section 4.6.2 on page 87 ) in the
Storage > Volume screen.
• The RAID 1 option when you click the Create a SATA volume button is only visible when there are no existing volumes in your NSA.
I want to choose another storage method for my internal (SATA) hard disk/ external (SATA) hard disk.
• If you are not using an eSATA hard disk, JBOD is the only storage method you can use for your internal hard disk.
• If you are using an eSATA hard disk, you can configure the internal hard disk and the external hard disk as a RAID 1 volume.
• For the eSATA hard disk alone, you can configure it as a JBOD or PC
Compatible Volume.
• If you want to change an existing storage method for your hard disk, go to the
Storage > Volume screen. Delete the volume you want to configure again.
Deleting an existing volume in the NSA deletes all data in that volume.
One of the hard disks (in a RAID 1 volume) failed.
NSA210 User’s Guide
397
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
• If you are using RAID 1 and the hard disk inside the NSA fails but the eSATA hard disk is still working, you can remove the hard disk inside the NSA and install the eSATA hard disk inside the NSA. Your NSA runs normally again, but you will need to have another eSATA hard disk attached to the NSA in order to employ RAID 1.
• If the eSATA hard disk in the RAID 1 volume fails, the NSA automatically repairs a degraded RAID if you connect an empty eSATA hard disk without an existing file system. If you connect an eSATA hard disk that is already formatted, you must manually to turn it into a volume in the Storage > Volume screen. All data in the hard disk is deleted.
18.8 External USB Drives
The COPY LED is red.
Copying files from a USB device failed. The USB device may not be compatible with the NSA. Try save the files onto a computer and then from the computer to the NSA (through the network connection).
18.9 Firmware
I want to know the firmware version of my NSA.
Go to the Status screen. The Firmware field shows you the current firmware version running.
18.10 File Transfer
I want to transfer my file(s) from my local computer or storage device to the NSA.
• After you initialize your hard disk, you can directly access the folders in your
NSA and transfer files in the same way you transfer files in your local computer:
398
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
1
On your Windows computer, click Start > Run or open a web browser.
2
Enter \\nsa210 (default) or the Server Name you assigned the NSA. This shows you the folders in the NSA.
3
Use drag-and-drop or copy-and-paste to transfer files over to your NSA.
• Use the COPY/SYNC button to transfer files from an external (USB) storage device to the NSA.
• If the file you want to transfer is less than or equal to 2GB, you can use the My
NSA screen (see
).
I want to transfer my file(s) from the NSA to my local computer or storage device.
• After you initialize your hard disk, you can directly access the folders in your
NSA and transfer files in the same way you transfer files in your local computer:
1
On your Windows computer, click Start > Run or open a web browser.
2
Enter \\nsa210 (default) or the Server Name you assigned the NSA. This shows you the folders in the NSA.
3
Use drag-and-drop or copy-and-paste to transfer files from your NSA to your local computer’s folder or your storage device.
• You can download the files from your NSA. Just click on the file(s) in the Share
Browsing screen (
Section 3.4.6 on page 63 ). Your computer will prompt you
for the location where you want to save the file.
18.11 Networking
I want to control who can access my folder(s)/file(s).
• If you are an administrator, you can configure a user’s access rights. Use the
Shares screen (
) to do this.
• If you enabled Web Publishing for a folder, anyone on your network can play the media files in the published shares. No user name and password or other form of security is used. The media server is enabled by default with the video, photo, and music shares published.
NSA210 User’s Guide
399
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
One of the computers in my network cannot use the printer I connected to the
NSA.
• You must install the printer driver on each computer that will use the printer.
• Check
and check for related connectivity issues.
18.12 Some Features’ Screens Do Not Display
Many NSA features require a valid internal volume.
Features like the print server, download service, broadcatching, FTP and Windows/
CIFS access will not work without a valid internal volume. Make sure you have a volume on an internal disk and that the volume is in the healthy state.
• Install an internal disk if one is not installed yet or has failed. See the Quick
Start Guide for how to install an internal disk.
• Create a new volume if you do not have one on the internal disk yet.
• Make sure the volume on the installed internal disk is in a healthy state.
I cannot use some applications in the Web Configurator.
• The firmware installed in your NSA includes the features mentioned in Section
3.5.2 on page 72 . This does not include the applications you can install using
the Package Management screen.
• You can use the Package Management screen (
install more applications from a web location (specified in the firmware) to your
NSA.
• If you have installed the application and can see the application’s configuration screen but still cannot use it, check that you have Enabled the application.
400
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
18.13 Media Server Functions
I set the media server function to publish a folder, but some of the files in the folder do not display in the list on the media client.
Files with formats that are not supported on the media server may not display in the list. See
Section 19.4 on page 416 for the file formats that the media server
supports.
The names of videos listed in the video screens do not match their file names.
The NSA’s media server function lists files by their embedded titles if they are available. You can use the File Browser screens if you need to view file names or search by file names.
Title, artist, album, and genre information for some media files does not display properly.
The NSA may be using the wrong character set to display the information. See
for how to set which character sets the NSA attempts to use and the order the NSA tries them in.
A video file does not play properly through my Windows computer’s browser.
Some files play better in VLC player while others work better in Windows Media
Player (WMP). Use the button circled below to switch to the other media player.
Figure 210 Video Playback Switch Media Player Button
NSA210 User’s Guide
401
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
I published a folder with the media server function, but the media client does not play some of the files (or does not play them properly).
1
Files with formats that are not supported on the media server may not display in the list. See
Section 19.4 on page 416 for the file formats that the media server
supports.
2
If you are using media client software, you may need to install codecs on your computer. Since the media client software uses your computer’s installed codecs, files do not play if the required codec is not installed on your computer.
3
The media client may not support the file’s format.
iTunes does not display the names of all the music or video files I just put on the
NSA.
1
Make sure the files are a format supported by iTunes. See
2
Go to Applications > Media Server. Make sure the share containing the music and video files is published and the iTunes server option is enabled.
3
If an iTunes client is connected, the NSA’s iTunes server function scans the published media server folders for files every three minutes. Leave iTunes connected to the NSA for three minutes. Then use the NSA’s eject button (as shown next) to disconnect.
Figure 211 iTunes Eject Button
402
NSA210 User’s Guide
4
Then click the NSA’s link to reconnect.
Figure 212 iTunes Reconnected
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
5
Another way to get the NSA’s iTunes server function to scan the published media server folders for files is to go to Applications > Media Server and disable and re-enable the iTunes server option. If you uploaded many files, it may take awhile for the NSA to find and list all of them. Then try reconnecting your iTunes client.
I cannot use iTunes to play files located on my NSA.
1
Make sure the files are a format supported by iTunes. See
2
If you have files from the iTunes Store that use DRM, you need to use your Apple account ID and password to authorize other computers to play the files. Apple permits you to authorize up to five computers at a time. To authorize a computer, open iTunes and click Store > Authorize Computer.
3
If you are connecting through a NAT router, make sure that TCP port 3689 and
UDP port 5353 are open for traffic on both the server and the client and all points in between (especially the NAT router). If your router includes a firewall, make sure it also allows TCP port 3689 and UDP port 5353 traffic.
NSA210 User’s Guide
403
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
18.14 Download Service and Broadcatching
Functions
The download list or broadcatching items are missing after I removed a hard drive.
The NSA’s download and broadcatching lists are stored on the system volume. If you have two JBOD volumes, it is possible to remove one and still use the other.
However if you remove the system volume, you may lose the download and broadcasting lists. With two JBOD volumes, the hard disk that was installed first is usually the system volume.
The channel I added in the Broadcatching screen is active but no files are downloaded to the NSA.
Check the Download Policy for that channel (see
Section 9.8.1 on page 223 ). It
may be set to manual download. You can configure your NSA to download all items or only new items automatically once the channel is updated.
I cannot find the download files.
By default, the Download Service and Broadcatching features store downloaded files as follows:
• BitTorrent jobs are stored in /*/incoming (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• HTTP/FTP jobs are stored in /* (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
• All jobs triggered by RSS channels create the subfolder in /* using the channel name where it store all files downloaded from that channel (where ‘*’ is a folder that you have set.)
Check your Preferences in the Download Service (
and Broadcatching (
) screens to know or configure where downloaded files are stored.
404
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
18.15 Web Publishing
A web-published share cannot be accessed by web browser from the Internet.
• Make sure the person trying to access the share is using the correct web address (and port number if the NSA’s web publishing feature is not using port
for details.
• Make sure the publishing feature is turned on and the share is in the list of published shares.
• Make sure the person trying to access the share is using Internet Explorer 6.0
(and later) or Firefox 1.07 (and later).
• You need to use a public address to access the NSA’s web-published shares from the Internet. If your NSA uses a private IP address, use the public IP address of your Internet gateway (firewall) and configure NAT or port forwarding on your
Internet gateway and possibly firewall rules in order to let people access the
NSA’s web-published shares from the Internet.
• Make sure the firewall’s public IP address is static or that the firewall uses a
Dynamic Domain Name (DDNS).
• Web publishing uses TCP protocol and the port number you specify. Make sure there is not another service using TCP protocol with the same port number. See
for a list of common services and their associated protocols and port numbers.
• If Firefox access to the share does not work, check that you did not set the Web publishing feature to use one of the following ports. (Firefox blocks these ports by default.)
Table 121 Ports Blocked By Default in Firefox
PORT SERVICE
1 tcpmux
15
17
19
20
7
9
11
13
21
22
23
25 echo discard systat daytime netstat qotd chargen ftp data ftp control ssh telnet smtp
PORT SERVICE
95 supdup
115
117
119
123
109
110
111
113
101
102
103
104 hostriame iso-tsap gppitnp acr-nema
POP2
POP3 sunrpc auth sftp uucp-path
NNTP
NTP
PORT SERVICE
513 login
531
532
540
556
514
515
526
530
563
587
601
636 shell printer tempo courier chat netnews uucp remotefs
NNTP+SSL submission syslog
LDAP+SSL
NSA210 User’s Guide
405
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
Table 121 Ports Blocked By Default in Firefox
PORT SERVICE
37 time
42
43
53
77
79
87 name nicname domain priv-rjs finger ttylink
PORT SERVICE
135 loc-srv epmap
139
143
179
389
465
512 netbios
IMAP2
BGP
LDAP
SMTP+SSL print exec
PORT SERVICE
993 IMAP+SSL
995 POP3+SSL
2049 nfs
4045 lockd
6000 X11
• Make sure your ISP allows you to run a server and is not blocking the port number of the NSA’s web publishing feature.
18.16 Auto Upload
The NSA does not automatically upload files to Flickr or YouTube.
1
Make sure the NSA is connected to the Internet. See
for details about testing network connections.
2
Click Maintenance > Log to check the NSA’s log for a message about the file.
2a
If the log message displays “no such file or directory”, the file may have been removed from the NSA. Make sure the file still exists in the watch folder.
2b
If the log message displays “filename is queued”, the file may still be waiting for auto upload. Check the grace period setting in the service’s Configuration screen. You can set a smaller grace period to shorten the queue time.
2c
If you cannot find any log messages about the file:
• Make sure the Folder Watch List includes the folder containing the file.
You can upload the file to the watch folder again.
• Make sure the file’s format is supported by Flickr or YouTube. You can find the supported file extensions in the Folder Watch List.
2d
If the log message displays “not authorized yet”, check if you can enter the
NSA’s Configuration screen for the service. If you changed the password of your Flickr or YouTube account, you cannot access the service’s Configuration screen, and the NSA cannot auto upload files. Make sure you also update the account information in the NSA.
406
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
3
Make sure the file size does not exceed the limit imposed by the service. At the time of writing, Flickr restricts the file size to 10 MB, and YouTube restricts the file size to 100 MB.
4
Make sure you did not exceed the service’s upload quota. Flickr and YouTube have different policies about how much you can upload within a certain period, for example, 100 MB/week.
5
The NSA may have temporarily failed to connect to the service. You can upload the file to the watch folder again.
18.17 Package Management
The NSA won’t install the package(s) I selected in the Package Management screen.
• The web location of the package may be undergoing maintenance. Try again at a later time. Upgrade the firmware of the NSA.
• If a new firmware is available, do an upgrade and try installing the package(s) again.
The eMule Search screen does not work.
You need to be connected to an eMule server before you can use the Search screen. Wait for the NSA to connect to a server before configuring the Search screen.
I want to know how my hard disk is performing.
Use S.M.A.R.T. (Self Monitoring, Analysis, and Reporting Technology) to monitor hard disks. It detects and reports the reliability of hard disks using standard indicators, enabling administrators to anticipate possible disk failures. Go to the
Package Management screen to install the S.M.A.R.T. application.
NSA210 User’s Guide
407
Chapter 18 Troubleshooting
18.18 Backups
I cannot make a backup.
• Check that enough space is available on the external disk. If there isn’t you may need to purge older backups or delete other files on the backup USB disk or NSA
(see
• If you are using BackupPlanner ( Section 10.10 on page 277
):
• You can look at the Backup screen’s Last Run Result display.
• If you’re backing up to another NSA, another NSA, or a computer, check that it allows the NSA to write files to it. For a synchronization backup, the target must be another NSA or another compatible model.
• Check that the NSA is not performing another backup job. Scheduler queues backups when a different backup is already going on at the time a backup is scheduled.
The backup does not run at the time configured.
• Check that the correct time is configured on the NSA.
• Check that the NSA is able to access the time server from which it gets the time; see
408
NSA210 User’s Guide
C
H A P T E R
1 9
Product Specifications
See also
for a general overview of the key features.
19.1 Physical Features
These are the main external physical features.
Table 122 Physical Features
USB Ports 2 USB (version 2) ports.
Gigabit Ethernet Port
SATA Interface eSATA Interface
Copy or sync files directly from the NSA to compatible USB devices like card readers, MP3 players, mass storage devices, and digital cameras without using a computer. Copy or sync files directly from a USB device to the NSA.
Expand the NSA’s storage capacity with compatible USB devices (like hard drives).
The 10/100/1000 Mbps auto-negotiating Ethernet port allows the NSA to detect the speed of incoming transmissions and adjust appropriately without manual intervention. It allows data transfer of either 100 Mbps or
1000 Mbps in either half-duplex or full-duplex mode depending on your Ethernet network. Use an 8-wire
Ethernet cable for Gigabit connections. The port is also autocrossover (MDI/MDI-X) meaning it automatically adjusts to either a crossover or straight-through Ethernet cable.
Actual data throughput varies depending on the network conditions and environmental factors, including volume of network traffic, network overhead and building materials.
Serial ATA is a low cost interface technology that allows high speed data transfer. Serial ATA also allows more efficient internal airflow and also smaller chassis design. eSATA is the “external” counterpart of the SATA interface. It has all of SATA’s features but with the added advantage of being mobile.
409
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
Table 122 Physical Features
Power Button
Press the Power button for one second to turn it on.
Turn off the NSA before unplugging the device.
COPY/SYNC Button
RESET Button
Press the Power button for 3 seconds until you hear one beep, then release it. The NSA goes starts to shutdown its software and turns off.
Press the Power button for 5 seconds until you hear two beeps, then release it. This NSA turns off immediately.
The COPY/SYNC button is used to copy or sync data from the NSA to a compatible external (USB) storage device or from the external (USB) storage device to the NSA.
Press the COPY/SYNC button to copy data from Public folder (default) of the NSA. Use the Web Configurator to configure the folder locations for the COPY/SYNC function.
During the data transfer, the COPY LED blinks and stops when the transfer is complete.
If you want to sync the data in the NSA with the external
(USB) storage device, press the COPY/SYNC button until you hear one beep.
If the COPY LED turns red, an error has occurred and the transfer is stopped. Press the COPY/SYNC button once and the COPY LED turns green.
Press the RESET button for 2 seconds to restart the NSA.
If you forget your (admin) password, press the RESET button for 10 seconds to restore the factory default password to “1234” (with username “admin”), and auto-IP address (DHCP client).
19.2 Firmware Features
These are some of the main firmware features of the NSA.
Table 123 Firmware Features
DLNA Server The NSA is a DLNA-compliant media server that lets DLNAcompliant media clients play video, audio, and photo content files stored on the NSA.
RAID File Storage
User Passwords
Use RAID 1 if you have two drives and want to mirror primary data to the second drive. If one drive fails, replace it and then re-synchronize to recover all data.
Configure a password for an individual User to restrict access to the NSA.
410
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
Table 123 Firmware Features
Client Support Data can be shared among all Windows, Mac, Linux, and
UNIX users that have FTP client software or CIFS file sharing support (such as Samba for Linux and UNIX users).
HTTP
DHCP (Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol)
Full Network
Management
Hard Disk Drive Power
Saving
Firmware Upload and
Configuration File
Management
NAS Starter Utility
Memeo Autobackup
Time and Date
Auto Upload iTunes Server
Package Management
The NSA is also a DLNA-certified media server that lets
DLNA-compliant media clients play video, audio, and photo content files stored on the NSA.
Access the NSA using a regular web connection (HTTP).
DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol) allows the NSA to obtain an IP address and subnet mask at start-up from a centralized DHCP server. Alternatively, you can give the NSA a static IP address and subnet mask.
The embedded Web Configurator is an platform-independent web-based utility that allows you to easily access the NSA’s management settings.
If a hard disk inside the NSA is idle for six minutes, the NSA puts it to sleep until you use it again.
Upload new firmware to the NSA using the Web Configurator.
You can also back up and restore the NSA configuration file containing all its settings to/from your computer.
Use the NAS Starter Utility from a Windows computer to find
NSA(s) in your network, access the NSA login page, change its IP address configuration or map to a Windows network drive.
Memeo Autobackup is a tool for Windows users to create backups of data stored on their Windows computers to an
NSA. This software is included on the CD.
Configure a time server and set a time zone for your NSA to show the correct times in logs.
The auto upload feature uploads media files stored in the NSA to the Flickr and/or YouTube sharing websites.
It is a convenient way to share media files with your friends and family. You can link the NSA to your Flickr and/or YouTube account and select shares for the NSA to upload. The NSA uploads the media files stored in the specified shares to your Flickr and/or YouTube account. When you add new files to the specified shares, the NSA also automatically uploads the new files to your Flickr and/or YouTube account.
The NSA can mimic the iTunes application and download content from the iTunes server.
Package Management can be used to set up more useful applications in your NSA, including eMule, DyDNS, NFS,
SMART, BackupPlanner, Gallery, PHP-MySQL-phpMyAdmin,
SqueezeCenter, WordPress, Syslog Server, and TFTP Server.
The NSA can download multiple packages/files at once and automatically goes through all the installation steps.
NSA210 User’s Guide
411
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
Table 123 Firmware Features
DyDNS
Dynamic DNS allows you to update your current dynamic IP address with a dynamic DNS service so that anyone can contact you (in NetMeeting, CUSeeMe, etc.). You can also access your FTP server or Web site on your own computer using a domain name (for instance myhost.dhs.org, where myhost is a name of your choice) that will never change instead of using an
IP address that changes each time you reconnect. Your friends or relatives will always be able to call you even if they don't know your IP address.
Download Service
Power Schedule
The NSA’s download service downloads files from the
Internet directly to the NSA. You do not have to download to your computer and then copy to the NSA.
This can free up your computer’s system resources.
The download service also handles your broadcatching downloads.
Use this screen to manage power settings for the NSA, including power saving, UPS, power on/off during power failure and power on/off schedule.
19.3 Specification Tables
The NSA hardware specifications are shown in the following table.
Table 124 NSA Hardware Specifications
Default IP Address DHCP client. If no DHCP server is found, the NSA uses Auto-IP to choose an IP address in the 169.254.X.X subnet (where X is a number from 1 to 254).
Default Subnet Mask DHCP client by default. If no DHCP server is found, the subnet mask defaults to 255.255.255.0 (24 bits).
Default Username
Default Password admin
1234
Dimensions
Weight
Drive Trays
Compatible Hard
Disks
Maximum Number of
Folders Per Share
195.5 (D)* 58 (W)* 130 (H) mm
0.66 kg (without hard drives)
One
SATA I and SATA II 3.0 Gbit/s (Serial Advanced Technology
Attachment) compatible hard drives.
The NSA’s media server function can detect up to 8,000 folders within a single published share.
After 8,000 folders have been created, new folder contents will not be added to the media server's list. However you can still access the folders using Samba.
Ports
Ethernet One auto-negotiating, auto MDI/MDI-X 10/100/1000
A
Mbps RJ-45
Ethernet port (1000BASE-T)
412
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
Table 124 NSA Hardware Specifications (continued)
USB v2.0 Storage One port in the back panel and one port in the front panel.
Windows: NTFS, FAT32 and FAT16 eSATA port
LEDs
Operating
Temperature
Power Supply
Linux: ReiserFS, XFS, EXT2, and EXT3.
One port in the back panel.
PWR, SYSTEM, HDD, eSATA, USB and COPY.
0º C ~ 40º C
Input: 100 - 240 V AC, 0.9 A, 50-60 Hz
Output: 12 V DC, 2.5 A
Storage Temperature -30º C ~ 70º C
Operating Humidity
Storage Humidity
Certifications
0% ~ 95% RH (non-condensing)
0% ~ 95% RH (non-condensing)
Device: CE, FCC Part 15B, C-Tick, BSMI
Power Adapter: CE, FCC, CUL, TUV/GS, RCM, BSMI, Efficiency
Level V (CEC regulation)
A. Use an 8-wire Ethernet cable for Gigabit connections.
The NSA firmware specifications are shown in the following table
Table 125 NSA Firmware Specifications
File Storage System JBOD, RAID 1
Network Protocols TCP/IP, UDP/IP
File Management
Network File Sharing
Protocol
Network Security
DHCP Client
FTP
HTTP
Create/Delete System Volume
CIFS/SMB for Windows and Mac OSX
HTTP for web browser
FTP
Authentication
Share level
Windows XP (SP2) Supported Clients
Windows Vista (32 bit)
Windows 7 (32 and 64 bit)
Maximum Number of Users
Allowed
Windows Server 2003
Mac OS X 10.4 and later versions
64
A
NSA210 User’s Guide
413
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
Table 125 NSA Firmware Specifications (continued)
Maximum Number of
Concurrent FTP Sessions
32
Maximum Number of
Concurrent CIFS Sessions
32
System Management Remote Management via Web Configurator (HTTP)
Logging/Monitoring
Firmware Upgrade
Web Browsers Supported
NAS Starter Utility
Centralized Logs
Web Configurator
Internet Explorer 6.0 and later versions
Firefox 2.00 and later versions
Safari 4.04 and later versions
A. Limits may vary depending on user-share resource usage.
The following list, which is not exhaustive, illustrates the standards and recommendations supported in the NSA.
Table 126 Supported Standards and Recommendations
CSS level 1 Cascading Style Sheets.
Cascading Style Sheets. CSS level 2 revision 1
(“CSS 2.1”)
DATETIME
DLNA v1.5 Server
ECMA-262
ECMA-262 Edition 2
ECMA-262 Edition 3
ECMA-357
HTML 3.2 Reference
Specification
HTML 4.01
Specification
ISO 3166-1
ISO 639-2
MIMETYPES
"Date and Time Formats", W3C (World Wide Web Consortium)
Note, M. Wolf and C. Wicksteed, 15 September 1997. Revised 27
August 1998. See http://www.w3.org/TR/1998/NOTE-datetime-
19980827
The DLNA (Digital Living Network Alliance) group of companies works to make products compatible and able to work in a home network in order to make digital living easy and seamless. DLNA clients play files stored on DLNA servers.
The original ECMAScript standard, also known as JavaScript.
The ECMAScript standard’s second revision; also ISO standard
16262.
The ECMAScript standard’s third revision; corresponds to
JavaScript 1.5.
ECMAScript for XML (E4X). See also the E4X errata.
The HyperText Markup Language (HTML).
Defines the HyperText Markup Language (HTML), the publishing language of the World Wide Web.
Country names (official short names in English) in alphabetical order as given in ISO 3166-1 and the corresponding ISO 3166-1alpha-2 code elements.
Two-letter and three-letter language code sets.
IANA registered content types (MIME types). See the IANA web site (ftp://ftp.isi.edu/in-notes/iana/assignments/media-types/).
414
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
RFC 1034
RFC 1035
RFC 1305
RFC 1415
RFC 1510
RFC 1738
RFC 1808
RFC 1945
RFC 2131
RFC 2396
RFC 2396
RFC 2616
RFC 2854
Table 126 Supported Standards and Recommendations
ISO 15740 Picture Transfer Protocol (PTP) from the International imaging
Industry Association allows you to transfer pictures from digital cameras or other devices without needing additional device drivers.
RFC 1001
RFC 1002
(STD-19) - Protocol standard for NetBIOS service on a TCP/UDP transport: Concepts and methods
(STD-19) - Protocol standard for NetBIOS service on a TCP/UDP transport: Detailed specifications
(STD-13) - Domain names - concepts and facilities
(STD-13) - Domain names - implementation and specification
Network Time Protocol (NTP version 3)
FTP-FTAM Gateway Specification
The Kerberos Network Authentication Service (V5)
Uniform Resource Locators (URL)
Relative Uniform Resource Locators
The Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) 1.0.
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol
Uniform Resource Identifier (URI)
Uniform Resource Identifiers (URI): Generic Syntax
Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) 1.1.
History of HTML development, and lists the relevant W3C (World
Wide Web Consortium) recommendations for the "text/html"
MIME type.
Language tags RFC 3066, BCP 47
(Best Current
Practice)
RFC 3282
RFC 3986
RFC 4120
RFC 4248
RFC 793
RFC 959
SATA
UPnP
USB 2.0
XHTML 1.0
XHTML 1.1
"Content-language:" headers.
(STD-66) - Uniform Resource Identifier (URI): Generic Syntax
The Kerberos Network Authentication Service (V5)
The telnet URI Scheme
(STD-7) - Transmission Control Protocol
(STD-9) - File Transfer Protocol
SATA I and SATA II 3.0 Gbit/s (Serial Advanced Technology
Attachment) compatible hard drives.
Universal Plug and Play (UPnP) is a distributed, open networking standard that uses TCP/IP for simple peer-to-peer network connectivity between devices.
USB (Universal Serial Bus) version 2.0 allows for interfacing devices with data transfers rates of up to 480 Mbps.
Extensible HyperText Markup Language (Second Edition)
Module-based XHTML
NSA210 User’s Guide
415
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
19.4 Supported Media Server Content Formats
The following describes the details about the files that the NSA media server can publish.
Table 127 Supported Media Server Content Formats
CATEGORY FILE TYPE
Video MPEG-1/MPEG-2
MPEG-4
AVI
EXTENSION
dat, dvr-ms, iso, m1v, m2p, m2t, m2v, mp2, mpe, mpeg, mpeg2, mpg, mpg2, ts, vob, m2ts, tts m4v, mp4 avi
Music
Photo
Motion JPEG
Quick Time Video
RealMedia
Ogg mjpeg, mjpg mov rmvb, rm ogm
Matroska
ASF mkv asf
Windows Media Video asf, wmv
Subtitle srt, ssa, idx, sub
MP3
Ogg Vorbis
RealMedia
WAVE mp3, mpa ogg ra, ram wav
Windows Media Audio wma
Matroska mka
Monkeys Audio
MP1 ape mp1
MP4
PCM
LPCM
DTS
AC3
Free Lossless Audio
Codec
Au
AAC
3GPP
AIFF
Playlist
Bitmap mp4, m4a, m4p pcm lpcm dts ac3 flac au aac
3gp, 3g2 aif, aiff wpl, pls, m3u bmp
416
NSA210 User’s Guide
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
Table 127 Supported Media Server Content Formats
CATEGORY FILE TYPE
JPEG
EXTENSION
jpe, jpeg, jpg
PNG png
Note: Not all published file types can be viewed by all client applications.
19.5 Supported iTunes Server Content Formats
At the time of writing, the NSA’s supports iTunes versions 7 through 9 and publishing mp3, m4a, m4p, wav, mp4, and m4v format audio files.
19.6 Power Consumption
The NSA was tested using the specified power sources with the external power adapter and with two hard drives installed.
Note: This table is a laboratory test of NSA power consumption for your reference only.
Table 128 Full loading Power consumption in Watts (W)*
POWER
SOURCE
240V/50Hz
100V/60Hz
SYSTEM READ/
WRITE
26.4W (max)
25.2W (max)
*Full loading test condition: 1.5 TB internal hard drive with 2 x USB storage and 1 x eSATA storage.
NSA210 User’s Guide
417
Chapter 19 Product Specifications
418
NSA210 User’s Guide
A
P P E N D I X
A
Setting Up Your Computer’s IP
Address
Note: Your specific NSA may not support all of the operating systems described in this appendix. See the product specifications for more information about which operating systems are supported.
This appendix shows you how to configure the IP settings on your computer in order for it to be able to communicate with the other devices on your network.
Windows Vista/XP/2000, Mac OS 9/OS X, and all versions of UNIX/LINUX include the software components you need to use TCP/IP on your computer.
If you manually assign IP information instead of using a dynamic IP, make sure that your network’s computers have IP addresses that place them in the same subnet.
In this appendix, you can set up an IP address for:
•
Windows XP/NT/2000 on page 420
•
•
•
on
•
on
•
Linux: Ubuntu 8 (GNOME) on page 437
•
on
419
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Windows XP/NT/2000
The following example uses the default Windows XP display theme but can also apply to Windows 2000 and Windows NT.
1
Click Start > Control Panel.
2
In the Control Panel, click the Network Connections icon.
420
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
3
Right-click Local Area Connection and then select Properties.
4
On the General tab, select Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) and then click
Properties.
NSA210 User’s Guide
421
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
5
The Internet Protocol TCP/IP Properties window opens.
6
Select Obtain an IP address automatically if your network administrator or ISP assigns your IP address dynamically.
Select Use the following IP Address and fill in the IP address, Subnet mask, and Default gateway fields if you have a static IP address that was assigned to you by your network administrator or ISP. You may also have to enter a Preferred
DNS server and an Alternate DNS server, if that information was provided.
7
Click OK to close the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) Properties window.
8
Click OK to close the Local Area Connection Properties window.
Verifying Settings
1
Click Start > All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.
2
In the Command Prompt window, type "ipconfig" and then press [ENTER].
You can also go to Start > Control Panel > Network Connections, right-click a network connection, click Status and then click the Support tab to view your IP address and connection information.
422
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Windows Vista
This section shows screens from Windows Vista Professional.
1
Click Start > Control Panel.
2
In the Control Panel, click the Network and Internet icon.
3
Click the Network and Sharing Center icon.
NSA210 User’s Guide
423
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
4
Click Manage network connections.
5
Right-click Local Area Connection and then select Properties.
Note: During this procedure, click Continue whenever Windows displays a screen saying that it needs your permission to continue.
424
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
6
Select Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4) and then select Properties.
NSA210 User’s Guide
425
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
7
The Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4) Properties window opens.
426
8
Select Obtain an IP address automatically if your network administrator or ISP assigns your IP address dynamically.
Select Use the following IP Address and fill in the IP address, Subnet mask, and Default gateway fields if you have a static IP address that was assigned to you by your network administrator or ISP. You may also have to enter a Preferred
DNS server and an Alternate DNS server, if that information was provided.Click Advanced.
9
Click OK to close the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) Properties window.
10
Click OK to close the Local Area Connection Properties window.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Verifying Settings
1
Click Start > All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.
2
In the Command Prompt window, type "ipconfig" and then press [ENTER].
You can also go to Start > Control Panel > Network Connections, right-click a network connection, click Status and then click the Support tab to view your IP address and connection information.
Windows 7
This section shows screens from Windows 7 Enterprise.
1
Click Start > Control Panel.
2
In the Control Panel, click View network status and tasks under the
Network and Internet category.
NSA210 User’s Guide
427
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
3
Click Change adapter settings.
4
Double click Local Area Connection and then select Properties.
428
Note: During this procedure, click Continue whenever Windows displays a screen saying that it needs your permission to continue.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
5
Select Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4) and then select Properties.
NSA210 User’s Guide
429
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
6
The Internet Protocol Version 4 (TCP/IPv4) Properties window opens.
430
7
Select Obtain an IP address automatically if your network administrator or ISP assigns your IP address dynamically.
Select Use the following IP Address and fill in the IP address, Subnet mask, and Default gateway fields if you have a static IP address that was assigned to you by your network administrator or ISP. You may also have to enter a Preferred
DNS server and an Alternate DNS server, if that information was provided.
Click Advanced if you want to configure advanced settings for IP, DNS and WINS.
8
Click OK to close the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) Properties window.
9
Click OK to close the Local Area Connection Properties window.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Verifying Settings
1
Click Start > All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.
2
In the Command Prompt window, type "ipconfig" and then press [ENTER].
3
The IP settings are displayed as follows.
Mac OS X: 10.3 and 10.4
The screens in this section are from Mac OS X 10.4 but can also apply to 10.3.
1
Click Apple > System Preferences.
NSA210 User’s Guide
431
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
2
In the System Preferences window, click the Network icon.
3
When the Network preferences pane opens, select Built-in Ethernet from the network connection type list, and then click Configure.
432
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
4
For dynamically assigned settings, select Using DHCP from the Configure IPv4 list in the TCP/IP tab.
5
For statically assigned settings, do the following:
• From the Configure IPv4 list, select Manually.
• In the IP Address field, type your IP address.
• In the Subnet Mask field, type your subnet mask.
• In the Router field, type the IP address of your device.
6
Click Apply Now and close the window.
NSA210 User’s Guide
433
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Verifying Settings
Check your TCP/IP properties by clicking Applications > Utilities > Network
Utilities, and then selecting the appropriate Network Interface from the Info tab.
Figure 213 Mac OS X 10.4: Network Utility
Mac OS X: 10.5 and 10.6
The screens in this section are from Mac OS X 10.5 but can also apply to 10.6.
1
Click Apple > System Preferences.
434
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
2
In System Preferences, click the Network icon.
3
When the Network preferences pane opens, select Ethernet from the list of available connection types.
4
From the Configure list, select Using DHCP for dynamically assigned settings.
NSA210 User’s Guide
435
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
5
For statically assigned settings, do the following:
• From the Configure list, select Manually.
• In the IP Address field, enter your IP address.
• In the Subnet Mask field, enter your subnet mask.
• In the Router field, enter the IP address of your NSA.
436
6
Click Apply and close the window.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Verifying Settings
Check your TCP/IP properties by clicking Applications > Utilities > Network
Utilities, and then selecting the appropriate Network interface from the Info tab.
Figure 214 Mac OS X 10.5: Network Utility
Linux: Ubuntu 8 (GNOME)
This section shows you how to configure your computer’s TCP/IP settings in the
GNU Object Model Environment (GNOME) using the Ubuntu 8 Linux distribution.
The procedure, screens and file locations may vary depending on your specific distribution, release version, and individual configuration. The following screens use the default Ubuntu 8 installation.
Note: Make sure you are logged in as the root administrator.
NSA210 User’s Guide
437
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Follow the steps below to configure your computer IP address in GNOME:
1
Click System > Administration > Network.
2
When the Network Settings window opens, click Unlock to open the
Authenticate window. (By default, the Unlock button is greyed out until clicked.)
You cannot make changes to your configuration unless you first enter your admin password.
438
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
3
In the Authenticate window, enter your admin account name and password then click the Authenticate button.
4
In the Network Settings window, select the connection that you want to configure, then click Properties.
NSA210 User’s Guide
439
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
5
The Properties dialog box opens.
6
• In the Configuration list, select Automatic Configuration (DHCP) if you have a dynamic IP address.
• In the Configuration list, select Static IP address if you have a static IP address. Fill in the IP address, Subnet mask, and Gateway address fields.
Click OK to save the changes and close the Properties dialog box and return to the Network Settings screen.
7
If you know your DNS server IP address(es), click the DNS tab in the Network
Settings window and then enter the DNS server information in the fields provided.
440
8
Click the Close button to apply the changes.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Verifying Settings
Check your TCP/IP properties by clicking System > Administration > Network
Tools, and then selecting the appropriate Network device from the Devices tab. The Interface Statistics column shows data if your connection is working properly.
Figure 215 Ubuntu 8: Network Tools
NSA210 User’s Guide
441
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
Linux: openSUSE 10.3 (KDE)
This section shows you how to configure your computer’s TCP/IP settings in the K
Desktop Environment (KDE) using the openSUSE 10.3 Linux distribution. The procedure, screens and file locations may vary depending on your specific distribution, release version, and individual configuration. The following screens use the default openSUSE 10.3 installation.
Note: Make sure you are logged in as the root administrator.
Follow the steps below to configure your computer IP address in the KDE:
1
Click K Menu > Computer > Administrator Settings (YaST).
442
2
When the Run as Root - KDE su dialog opens, enter the admin password and click OK.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
3
When the YaST Control Center window opens, select Network Devices and then click the Network Card icon.
4
When the Network Settings window opens, click the Overview tab, select the appropriate connection Name from the list, and then click the Configure button.
NSA210 User’s Guide
443
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
5
When the Network Card Setup window opens, click the Address tab
Figure 216 openSUSE 10.3: Network Card Setup
444
6
Select Dynamic Address (DHCP) if you have a dynamic IP address.
Select Statically assigned IP Address if you have a static IP address. Fill in the
IP address, Subnet mask, and Hostname fields.
7
Click Next to save the changes and close the Network Card Setup window.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
8
If you know your DNS server IP address(es), click the Hostname/DNS tab in
Network Settings and then enter the DNS server information in the fields provided.
9
Click Finish to save your settings and close the window.
Verifying Settings
Click the KNetwork Manager icon on the Task bar to check your TCP/IP properties. From the Options sub-menu, select Show Connection Information.
Figure 217 openSUSE 10.3: KNetwork Manager
NSA210 User’s Guide
445
Appendix A Setting Up Your Computer’s IP Address
When the Connection Status - KNetwork Manager window opens, click the
Statistics tab to see if your connection is working properly.
Figure 218 openSUSE: Connection Status - KNetwork Manager
446
NSA210 User’s Guide
A
P P E N D I X
B
Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
In order to use the Web Configurator you need to allow:
• Web browser pop-up windows from your device.
• JavaScript (enabled by default).
• Java permissions (enabled by default).
Note: The screens used below belong to Internet Explorer version 6, 7 and 8. Screens for other Internet Explorer versions may vary.
Internet Explorer Pop-up Blockers
You may have to disable pop-up blocking to log into your device.
Either disable pop-up blocking (enabled by default in Windows XP SP (Service
Pack) 2) or allow pop-up blocking and create an exception for your device’s IP address.
Disable Pop-up Blockers
1
In Internet Explorer, select Tools, Pop-up Blocker and then select Turn Off
Pop-up Blocker.
Figure 219 Pop-up Blocker
You can also check if pop-up blocking is disabled in the Pop-up Blocker section in the Privacy tab.
NSA210 User’s Guide
447
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
1
In Internet Explorer, select Tools, Internet Options, Privacy.
2
Clear the Block pop-ups check box in the Pop-up Blocker section of the screen.
This disables any web pop-up blockers you may have enabled.
Figure 220 Internet Options: Privacy
3
Click Apply to save this setting.
Enable Pop-up Blockers with Exceptions
Alternatively, if you only want to allow pop-up windows from your device, see the following steps.
1
In Internet Explorer, select Tools, Internet Options and then the Privacy tab.
448
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
2
Select Settings…to open the Pop-up Blocker Settings screen.
Figure 221 Internet Options: Privacy
3
Type the IP address of your device (the web page that you do not want to have blocked) with the prefix “http://”. For example, http://192.168.167.1.
NSA210 User’s Guide
449
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
4
Click Add to move the IP address to the list of Allowed sites.
Figure 222 Pop-up Blocker Settings
5
Click Close to return to the Privacy screen.
6
Click Apply to save this setting.
JavaScript
If pages of the Web Configurator do not display properly in Internet Explorer, check that JavaScript are allowed.
450
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
1
In Internet Explorer, click Tools, Internet Options and then the Security tab.
Figure 223 Internet Options: Security
2
Click the Custom Level... button.
3
Scroll down to Scripting.
4
Under Active scripting make sure that Enable is selected (the default).
5
Under Scripting of Java applets make sure that Enable is selected (the default).
NSA210 User’s Guide
451
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
6
Click OK to close the window.
Figure 224 Security Settings - Java Scripting
Java Permissions
1
From Internet Explorer, click Tools, Internet Options and then the Security tab.
2
Click the Custom Level... button.
3
Scroll down to Microsoft VM.
4
Under Java permissions make sure that a safety level is selected.
452
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
5
Click OK to close the window.
Figure 225 Security Settings - Java
JAVA (Sun)
1
From Internet Explorer, click Tools, Internet Options and then the Advanced tab.
2
Make sure that Use Java 2 for <applet> under Java (Sun) is selected.
NSA210 User’s Guide
453
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
3
Click OK to close the window.
Figure 226 Java (Sun)
Mozilla Firefox
Mozilla Firefox 2.0 screens are used here. Screens for other versions may vary slightly. The steps below apply to Mozilla Firefox 3.0 as well.
You can enable Java, JavaScript and pop-ups in one screen. Click Tools, then click
Options in the screen that appears.
Figure 227 Mozilla Firefox: TOOLS > Options
454
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
Click Content to show the screen below. Select the check boxes as shown in the following screen.
Figure 228 Mozilla Firefox Content Security
Opera
Opera 10 screens are used here. Screens for other versions may vary slightly.
NSA210 User’s Guide
455
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
Allowing Pop-Ups
From Opera, click Tools, then Preferences. In the General tab, go to Choose
how you prefer to handle pop-ups and select Open all pop-ups.
Figure 229 Opera: Allowing Pop-Ups
456
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
Enabling Java
From Opera, click Tools, then Preferences. In the Advanced tab, select
Content from the left-side menu. Select the check boxes as shown in the following screen.
Figure 230 Opera: Enabling Java
To customize JavaScript behavior in the Opera browser, click JavaScript Options.
Figure 231 Opera: JavaScript Options
Select the items you want Opera’s JavaScript to apply.
NSA210 User’s Guide
457
Appendix B Pop-up Windows, JavaScript and Java Permissions
458
NSA210 User’s Guide
A
P P E N D I X
C
Common Services
The following table lists some commonly-used services and their associated protocols and port numbers. For a comprehensive list of port numbers, ICMP type/ code numbers and services, visit the IANA (Internet Assigned Number Authority) web site.
• Name: This is a short, descriptive name for the service. You can use this one or create a different one, if you like.
• Protocol: This is the type of IP protocol used by the service. If this is TCP/
UDP, then the service uses the same port number with TCP and UDP. If this is
USER-DEFINED, the Port(s) is the IP protocol number, not the port number.
• Port(s): This value depends on the Protocol. Please refer to RFC 1700 for further information about port numbers.
• If the Protocol is TCP, UDP, or TCP/UDP, this is the IP port number.
• If the Protocol is USER, this is the IP protocol number.
• Description: This is a brief explanation of the applications that use this service or the situations in which this service is used.
Table 129 Commonly Used Services
NAME
AH
(IPSEC_TUNNEL)
AIM/New-ICQ
AUTH
BGP
BOOTP_CLIENT
BOOTP_SERVER
CU-SEEME
DNS
PROTOCOL
User-Defined
TCP
TCP
TCP
UDP
UDP
TCP
UDP
TCP/UDP
PORT(S) DESCRIPTION
51 The IPSEC AH (Authentication
Header) tunneling protocol uses this service.
5190
113
179
68
67
7648
24032
53
AOL’s Internet Messenger service. It is also used as a listening port by
ICQ.
Authentication protocol used by some servers.
Border Gateway Protocol.
DHCP Client.
DHCP Server.
A popular videoconferencing solution from White Pines Software.
Domain Name Server, a service that matches web names (for example www.zyxel.com
) to IP numbers.
459
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix C Common Services
Table 129 Commonly Used Services (continued)
NAME
ESP
(IPSEC_TUNNEL)
FINGER
FTP
H.323
HTTP
HTTPS
ICMP
ICQ
IGMP
(MULTICAST)
IKE
IRC
MSN Messenger
NEW-ICQ
NEWS
NFS
NNTP
PING
POP3
PROTOCOL
User-Defined
TCP
TCP
TCP
TCP
TCP
TCP
User-Defined
UDP
User-Defined
UDP
TCP/UDP
TCP
TCP
TCP
UDP
TCP
User-Defined
TCP
PORT(S) DESCRIPTION
50 The IPSEC ESP (Encapsulation
Security Protocol) tunneling protocol uses this service.
79
20
21
1720
80
443
1
4000
2
500
6667
1863
5190
144
2049
119
1
110
Finger is a UNIX or Internet related command that can be used to find out if a user is logged on.
File Transfer Program, a program to enable fast transfer of files, including large files that may not be possible by e-mail.
NetMeeting uses this protocol.
Hyper Text Transfer Protocol - a client/server protocol for the world wide web.
HTTPS is a secured http session often used in e-commerce.
Internet Control Message Protocol is often used for diagnostic or routing purposes.
This is a popular Internet chat program.
Internet Group Management Protocol is used when sending packets to a specific group of hosts.
The Internet Key Exchange algorithm is used for key distribution and management.
This is another popular Internet chat program.
Microsoft Networks’ messenger service uses this protocol.
An Internet chat program.
A protocol for news groups.
Network File System - NFS is a client/ server distributed file service that provides transparent file sharing for network environments.
Network News Transport Protocol is the delivery mechanism for the
USENET newsgroup service.
Packet INternet Groper is a protocol that sends out ICMP echo requests to test whether or not a remote host is reachable.
Post Office Protocol version 3 lets a client computer get e-mail from a
POP3 server through a temporary connection (TCP/IP or other).
460
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix C Common Services
Table 129 Commonly Used Services (continued)
NAME
PPTP
PPTP_TUNNEL
(GRE)
RCMD
REAL_AUDIO
REXEC
RLOGIN
RTELNET
RTSP
SFTP
SMTP
SNMP
SNMP-TRAPS
SQL-NET
SSH
STRM WORKS
SYSLOG
TACACS
TELNET
PROTOCOL
TCP
User-Defined
TCP
TCP
TCP
TCP
TCP
TCP/UDP
TCP
TCP
TCP/UDP
TCP/UDP
TCP
TCP/UDP
UDP
UDP
UDP
TCP
512
7070
514
513
107
554
PORT(S) DESCRIPTION
1723 Point-to-Point Tunneling Protocol enables secure transfer of data over public networks. This is the control channel.
47
115
25
161
162
1521
22
1558
514
49
23
PPTP (Point-to-Point Tunneling
Protocol) enables secure transfer of data over public networks. This is the data channel.
Remote Command Service.
A streaming audio service that enables real time sound over the web.
Remote Execution Daemon.
Remote Login.
Remote Telnet.
The Real Time Streaming (media control) Protocol (RTSP) is a remote control for multimedia on the
Internet.
Simple File Transfer Protocol.
Simple Mail Transfer Protocol is the message-exchange standard for the
Internet. SMTP enables you to move messages from one e-mail server to another.
Simple Network Management
Protocol.
Traps for use with the SNMP
(RFC:1215).
Structured Query Language is an interface to access data on many different types of database systems, including mainframes, midrange systems, UNIX systems and network servers.
Secure Shell Remote Login Program.
Stream Works Protocol.
Syslog allows you to send system logs to a UNIX server.
Login Host Protocol used for (Terminal
Access Controller Access Control
System).
Telnet is the login and terminal emulation protocol common on the
Internet and in UNIX environments. It operates over TCP/IP networks. Its primary function is to allow users to log into remote host systems.
NSA210 User’s Guide
461
Appendix C Common Services
Table 129 Commonly Used Services (continued)
NAME
TFTP
VDOLIVE
PROTOCOL
UDP
TCP
PORT(S) DESCRIPTION
69 Trivial File Transfer Protocol is an
Internet file transfer protocol similar to FTP, but uses the UDP (User
Datagram Protocol) rather than TCP
(Transmission Control Protocol).
7000 Another videoconferencing solution.
462
NSA210 User’s Guide
A
P P E N D I X
D
Importing Certificates
This appendix shows you how to import public key certificates into your web browser.
Public key certificates are used by web browsers to ensure that a secure web site is legitimate. When a certificate authority such as VeriSign, Comodo, or Network
Solutions, to name a few, receives a certificate request from a website operator, they confirm that the web domain and contact information in the request match those on public record with a domain name registrar. If they match, then the certificate is issued to the website operator, who then places it on the site to be issued to all visiting web browsers to let them know that the site is legitimate.
Many ZyXEL products, such as the NSA-2401, issue their own public key certificates. These can be used by web browsers on a LAN or WAN to verify that they are in fact connecting to the legitimate device and not one masquerading as it. However, because the certificates were not issued by one of the several organizations officially recognized by the most common web browsers, you will need to import the ZyXEL-created certificate into your web browser and flag that certificate as a trusted authority.
Note: You can see if you are browsing on a secure website if the URL in your web browser’s address bar begins with https:// or there is a sealed padlock icon ( ) somewhere in the main browser window (not all browsers show the padlock in the same location.)
In this appendix, you can import a public key certificate for:
• Internet Explorer on
• Firefox on
• Opera on
• Konqueror on
Internet Explorer
The following example uses Microsoft Internet Explorer 7 on Windows XP
Professional; however, they can also apply to Internet Explorer on Windows Vista.
NSA210 User’s Guide
463
Appendix D Importing Certificates
1
If your device’s Web Configurator is set to use SSL certification, then the first time you browse to it you are presented with a certification error.
Figure 232 Internet Explorer 7: Certification Error
2
Click Continue to this website (not recommended).
Figure 233 Internet Explorer 7: Certification Error
3
In the Address Bar, click Certificate Error > View certificates.
Figure 234 Internet Explorer 7: Certificate Error
464
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
4
In the Certificate dialog box, click Install Certificate.
Figure 235 Internet Explorer 7: Certificate
5
In the Certificate Import Wizard, click Next.
Figure 236 Internet Explorer 7: Certificate Import Wizard
NSA210 User’s Guide
465
Appendix D Importing Certificates
6
If you want Internet Explorer to Automatically select certificate store based
on the type of certificate, click Next again and then go to step 9.
Figure 237 Internet Explorer 7: Certificate Import Wizard
7
Otherwise, select Place all certificates in the following store and then click
Browse.
Figure 238 Internet Explorer 7: Certificate Import Wizard
466
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
8
In the Select Certificate Store dialog box, choose a location in which to save the certificate and then click OK.
Figure 239 Internet Explorer 7: Select Certificate Store
9
In the Completing the Certificate Import Wizard screen, click Finish.
Figure 240 Internet Explorer 7: Certificate Import Wizard
NSA210 User’s Guide
467
Appendix D Importing Certificates
10
If you are presented with another Security Warning, click Yes.
Figure 241 Internet Explorer 7: Security Warning
11
Finally, click OK when presented with the successful certificate installation message.
Figure 242 Internet Explorer 7: Certificate Import Wizard
12
The next time you start Internet Explorer and go to a ZyXEL Web Configurator page, a sealed padlock icon appears in the address bar. Click it to view the page’s
Website Identification information.
Figure 243 Internet Explorer 7: Website Identification
468
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
Installing a Stand-Alone Certificate File in Internet Explorer
Rather than browsing to a ZyXEL Web Configurator and installing a public key certificate when prompted, you can install a stand-alone certificate file if one has been issued to you.
1
Double-click the public key certificate file.
Figure 244 Internet Explorer 7: Public Key Certificate File
2
In the security warning dialog box, click Open.
Figure 245 Internet Explorer 7: Open File - Security Warning
3
Refer to steps 4-12 in the Internet Explorer procedure beginning on
to complete the installation process.
Removing a Certificate in Internet Explorer
This section shows you how to remove a public key certificate in Internet Explorer
7.
NSA210 User’s Guide
469
Appendix D Importing Certificates
1
Open Internet Explorer and click Tools > Internet Options.
Figure 246 Internet Explorer 7: Tools Menu
2
In the Internet Options dialog box, click Content > Certificates.
Figure 247 Internet Explorer 7: Internet Options
470
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
3
In the Certificates dialog box, click the Trusted Root Certificates Authorities tab, select the certificate that you want to delete, and then click Remove.
Figure 248 Internet Explorer 7: Certificates
4
In the Certificates confirmation, click Yes.
Figure 249 Internet Explorer 7: Certificates
5
In the Root Certificate Store dialog box, click Yes.
Figure 250 Internet Explorer 7: Root Certificate Store
NSA210 User’s Guide
471
Appendix D Importing Certificates
6
The next time you go to the web site that issued the public key certificate you just removed, a certification error appears.
Firefox
The following example uses Mozilla Firefox 2 on Windows XP Professional; however, the screens can also apply to Firefox 2 on all platforms.
1
If your device’s Web Configurator is set to use SSL certification, then the first time you browse to it you are presented with a certification error.
2
Select Accept this certificate permanently and click OK.
Figure 251 Firefox 2: Website Certified by an Unknown Authority
472
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
3
The certificate is stored and you can now connect securely to the Web
Configurator. A sealed padlock appears in the address bar, which you can click to open the Page Info > Security window to view the web page’s security information.
Figure 252 Firefox 2: Page Info
Installing a Stand-Alone Certificate File in Firefox
Rather than browsing to a ZyXEL Web Configurator and installing a public key certificate when prompted, you can install a stand-alone certificate file if one has been issued to you.
NSA210 User’s Guide
473
Appendix D Importing Certificates
1
Open Firefox and click Tools > Options.
Figure 253 Firefox 2: Tools Menu
2
In the Options dialog box, click Advanced > Encryption > View Certificates.
Figure 254 Firefox 2: Options
474
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
3
In the Certificate Manager dialog box, click Web Sites > Import.
Figure 255 Firefox 2: Certificate Manager
4
Use the Select File dialog box to locate the certificate and then click Open.
Figure 256 Firefox 2: Select File
5
The next time you visit the web site, click the padlock in the address bar to open the Page Info > Security window to see the web page’s security information.
NSA210 User’s Guide
475
Appendix D Importing Certificates
Removing a Certificate in Firefox
This section shows you how to remove a public key certificate in Firefox 2.
1
Open Firefox and click Tools > Options.
Figure 257 Firefox 2: Tools Menu
2
In the Options dialog box, click Advanced > Encryption > View Certificates.
Figure 258 Firefox 2: Options
476
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
3
In the Certificate Manager dialog box, select the Web Sites tab, select the certificate that you want to remove, and then click Delete.
Figure 259 Firefox 2: Certificate Manager
4
In the Delete Web Site Certificates dialog box, click OK.
Figure 260 Firefox 2: Delete Web Site Certificates
5
The next time you go to the web site that issued the public key certificate you just removed, a certification error appears.
Opera
The following example uses Opera 9 on Windows XP Professional; however, the screens can apply to Opera 9 on all platforms.
NSA210 User’s Guide
477
Appendix D Importing Certificates
1
If your device’s Web Configurator is set to use SSL certification, then the first time you browse to it you are presented with a certification error.
2
Click Install to accept the certificate.
Figure 261 Opera 9: Certificate signer not found
3
The next time you visit the web site, click the padlock in the address bar to open the Security information window to view the web page’s security details.
Figure 262 Opera 9: Security information
478
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
Installing a Stand-Alone Certificate File in Opera
Rather than browsing to a ZyXEL Web Configurator and installing a public key certificate when prompted, you can install a stand-alone certificate file if one has been issued to you.
1
Open Opera and click Tools > Preferences.
Figure 263 Opera 9: Tools Menu
NSA210 User’s Guide
479
Appendix D Importing Certificates
2
In Preferences, click Advanced > Security > Manage certificates.
Figure 264 Opera 9: Preferences
480
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
3
In the Certificates Manager, click Authorities > Import.
Figure 265 Opera 9: Certificate manager
4
Use the Import certificate dialog box to locate the certificate and then click
Open.
Figure 266 Opera 9: Import certificate
NSA210 User’s Guide
481
Appendix D Importing Certificates
5
In the Install authority certificate dialog box, click Install.
Figure 267 Opera 9: Install authority certificate
6
Next, click OK.
Figure 268 Opera 9: Install authority certificate
7
The next time you visit the web site, click the padlock in the address bar to open the Security information window to view the web page’s security details.
Removing a Certificate in Opera
This section shows you how to remove a public key certificate in Opera 9.
482
NSA210 User’s Guide
1
Open Opera and click Tools > Preferences.
Figure 269 Opera 9: Tools Menu
Appendix D Importing Certificates
2
In Preferences, Advanced > Security > Manage certificates.
Figure 270 Opera 9: Preferences
NSA210 User’s Guide
483
Appendix D Importing Certificates
3
In the Certificates manager, select the Authorities tab, select the certificate that you want to remove, and then click Delete.
Figure 271 Opera 9: Certificate manager
4
The next time you go to the web site that issued the public key certificate you just removed, a certification error appears.
Note: There is no confirmation when you delete a certificate authority, so be absolutely certain that you want to go through with it before clicking the button.
Konqueror
The following example uses Konqueror 3.5 on openSUSE 10.3, however the screens apply to Konqueror 3.5 on all Linux KDE distributions.
1
If your device’s Web Configurator is set to use SSL certification, then the first time you browse to it you are presented with a certification error.
484
NSA210 User’s Guide
2
Click Continue.
Figure 272 Konqueror 3.5: Server Authentication
Appendix D Importing Certificates
3
Click Forever when prompted to accept the certificate.
Figure 273 Konqueror 3.5: Server Authentication
4
Click the padlock in the address bar to open the KDE SSL Information window and view the web page’s security details.
Figure 274 Konqueror 3.5: KDE SSL Information
NSA210 User’s Guide
485
Appendix D Importing Certificates
Installing a Stand-Alone Certificate File in Konqueror
Rather than browsing to a ZyXEL Web Configurator and installing a public key certificate when prompted, you can install a stand-alone certificate file if one has been issued to you.
1
Double-click the public key certificate file.
Figure 275 Konqueror 3.5: Public Key Certificate File
2
In the Certificate Import Result - Kleopatra dialog box, click OK.
Figure 276 Konqueror 3.5: Certificate Import Result
The public key certificate appears in the KDE certificate manager, Kleopatra.
Figure 277 Konqueror 3.5: Kleopatra
486
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix D Importing Certificates
3
The next time you visit the web site, click the padlock in the address bar to open the KDE SSL Information window to view the web page’s security details.
Removing a Certificate in Konqueror
This section shows you how to remove a public key certificate in Konqueror 3.5.
1
Open Konqueror and click Settings > Configure Konqueror.
Figure 278 Konqueror 3.5: Settings Menu
2
In the Configure dialog box, select Crypto.
3
On the Peer SSL Certificates tab, select the certificate you want to delete and then click Remove.
Figure 279 Konqueror 3.5: Configure
NSA210 User’s Guide
487
Appendix D Importing Certificates
4
The next time you go to the web site that issued the public key certificate you just removed, a certification error appears.
Note: There is no confirmation when you remove a certificate authority, so be absolutely certain you want to go through with it before clicking the button.
488
NSA210 User’s Guide
A
P P E N D I X
E
Open Source Licences
End-User License Agreement for “NSA210”
WARNING: ZyXEL Communications Corp. IS WILLING TO
LICENSE THE SOFTWARE TO YOU ONLY UPON THE CONDITION
THAT YOU ACCEPT ALL OF THE TERMS CONTAINED IN THIS
LICENSE AGREEMENT. PLEASE READ THE TERMS CAREFULLY
BEFORE COMPLETING THE INSTALLATION PROCESS AS
INSTALLING THE SOFTWARE WILL INDICATE YOUR ASSENT TO
THEM. IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THESE TERMS, THEN ZyXEL
IS UNWILLING TO LICENSE THE SOFTWARE TO YOU, IN WHICH
EVENT YOU SHOULD RETURN THE UNINSTALLED SOFTWARE
AND PACKAGING TO THE PLACE FROM WHICH IT WAS
ACQUIRED OR ZyXEL, AND YOUR MONEY WILL BE REFUNDED.
HOWEVER, CERTAIN ZYXEL’S PRODUCTS MAY CONTAIN–IN
PART-SOME THIRD PARTY’S FREE AND OPEN SOFTWARE
PROGRAMS WHICH ALLOW YOU TO FREELY COPY, RUN,
DISTRIBUTE, MODIFY AND IMPROVE THE SOFTWARE UNDER
THE APPLICABLE TERMS OF SUCH THRID PARTY’S LICENSES
(“OPEN-SOURCED COMPONENTS”). THE OPEN-SOURCED
COMPONENTS ARE LISTED IN THE NOTICE OR APPENDIX
BELOW. ZYXEL MAY HAVE DISTRIBUTED TO YOU HARDWARE
AND/OR SOFTWARE, OR MADE AVAILABLE FOR ELECTRONIC
DOWNLOADS THESE FREE SOFTWARE PROGRAMS OF THRID
PARTIES AND YOU ARE LICENSED TO FREELY COPY, MODIFY
AND REDISTIBUTE THAT SOFTWARE UNDER THE APPLICABLE
LICENSE TERMS OF SUCH THIRD PARTY. NONE OF THE
STATEMENTS OR DOCUMENTATION FROM ZYXEL INCLUDING
ANY RESTRICTIONS OR CONDITIONS STATED IN THIS END USER
LICENSE AGREEMENT SHALL RESTRICT ANY RIGHTS AND
LICENSES YOU MAY HAVE WITH RESPECT TO THE OPEN-
SOURCED COMPONENTS UNDER THE APPLICABLE LICENSE
TERMS OF SUCH THIRD PARTY.
1.Grant of License for Personal Use
NSA210 User’s Guide
489
Appendix E Open Source Licences
ZyXEL Communications Corp. ("ZyXEL") grants you a non-exclusive, nonsublicense, non-transferable license to use the program with which this license is distributed (the "Software"), including any documentation files accompanying the
Software ("Documentation"), for internal business use only, for up to the number of users specified in sales order and invoice. You have the right to make one backup copy of the Software and Documentation solely for archival, back-up or disaster recovery purposes. You shall not exceed the scope of the license granted hereunder. Any rights not expressly granted by ZyXEL to you are reserved by
ZyXEL, and all implied licenses are disclaimed.
2.Ownership
You have no ownership rights in the Software. Rather, you have a license to use the Software as long as this License Agreement remains in full force and effect.
Ownership of the Software, Documentation and all intellectual property rights therein shall remain at all times with ZyXEL. Any other use of the Software by any other entity is strictly forbidden and is a violation of this License Agreement.
3.Copyright
The Software and Documentation contain material that is protected by international copyright law, trade secret law, international treaty provisions, and the applicable national laws of each respective country. All rights not granted to you herein are expressly reserved by ZyXEL. You may not remove any proprietary notice of ZyXEL or any of its licensors from any copy of the Software or
Documentation.
4.Restrictions
You may not publish, display, disclose, sell, rent, lease, modify, store, loan, distribute, or create derivative works of the Software, or any part thereof. You may not assign, sublicense, convey or otherwise transfer, pledge as security or otherwise encumber the rights and licenses granted hereunder with respect to the
Software. ZyXEL is not obligated to provide any maintenance, technical or other support for the resultant modified Software. You may not copy, reverse engineer, decompile, reverse compile, translate, adapt, or disassemble the Software, or any part thereof, nor shall you attempt to create the source code from the object code for the Software. Except as and only to the extent expressly permitted in this
License, you may not market, co-brand, and private label or otherwise permit third parties to link to the Software, or any part thereof. You may not use the
Software, or any part thereof, in the operation of a service bureau or for the benefit of any other person or entity. You may not cause, assist or permit any third party to do any of the foregoing. Portions of the Software utilize or include third party software and other copyright material. Acknowledgements, licensing terms and disclaimers for such material are contained in the License Notice as below for the third party software, and your use of such material is exclusively governed by their respective terms. ZyXEL has provided, as part of the Software
490
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences package, access to certain third party software as a convenience. To the extent that the Software contains third party software, ZyXEL has no express or implied obligation to provide any technical or other support for such software other than compliance with the applicable license terms of such third party, and makes no warranty (express, implied or statutory) whatsoever with respect thereto. Please contact the appropriate software vendor or manufacturer directly for technical support and customer service related to its software and products.
5.Confidentiality
You acknowledge that the Software contains proprietary trade secrets of ZyXEL and you hereby agree to maintain the confidentiality of the Software using at least as great a degree of care as you use to maintain the confidentiality of your own most confidential information. You agree to reasonably communicate the terms and conditions of this License Agreement to those persons employed by you who come into contact with the Software, and to use reasonable best efforts to ensure their compliance with such terms and conditions, including, without limitation, not knowingly permitting such persons to use any portion of the Software for the purpose of deriving the source code of the Software.
6.No Warranty
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS." TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY
LAW, ZyXEL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND NON-
INFRINGEMENT. ZyXEL DOES NOT WARRANT THAT THE FUNCTIONS CONTAINED
IN THE SOFTWARE WILL MEET ANY REQUIREMENTS OR NEEDS YOU MAY HAVE,
OR THAT THE SOFTWARE WILL OPERATE ERROR FREE, OR IN AN UNINTERUPTED
FASHION, OR THAT ANY DEFECTS OR ERRORS IN THE SOFTWARE WILL BE
CORRECTED, OR THAT THE SOFTWARE IS COMPATIBLE WITH ANY PARTICULAR
PLATFORM. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE WAIVER OR EXCLUSION
OF IMPLIED WARRANTIES SO THEY MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. IF THIS EXCLUSION
IS HELD TO BE UNENFORCEABLE BY A COURT OF COMPETENT JURISDICTION,
THEN ALL EXPRESS AND IMPLIED WARRANTIES SHALL BE LIMITED IN DURATION
TO A PERIOD OF THIRTY (30) DAYS FROM THE DATE OF PURCHASE OF THE
SOFTWARE, AND NO WARRANTIES SHALL APPLY AFTER THAT PERIOD.
7.Limitation of Liability
IN NO EVENT WILL ZyXEL BE LIABLE TO YOU OR ANY THIRD PARTY FOR ANY
INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION,
INDIRECT, SPECIAL, PUNITIVE, OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF
BUSINESS, LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF BUSINESS
INFORMATION) ARISING OUT OF THE USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THE
SOFTWARE OR PROGRAM, OR FOR ANY CLAIM BY ANY OTHER PARTY, EVEN IF
ZyXEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. ZyXEL's
NSA210 User’s Guide
491
Appendix E Open Source Licences
TOTAL AGGREGATE LIABILITY WITH RESPECT TO ITS OBLIGATIONS UNDER THIS
AGREEMENT OR OTHERWISE WITH RESPECT TO THE SOFTWARE AND
DOCUMENTATION OR OTHERWISE SHALL BE EQUAL TO THE PURCHASE PRICE,
BUT SHALL IN NO EVENT EXCEED THE PRODUCT’S PRICE. BECAUSE SOME
STATES/COUNTRIES DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF
LIABILITY FOR CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, THE ABOVE
LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU.
8.Export Restrictions
THIS LICENSE AGREEMENT IS EXPRESSLY MADE SUBJECT TO ANY APPLICABLE
LAWS, REGULATIONS, ORDERS, OR OTHER RESTRICTIONS ON THE EXPORT OF
THE SOFTWARE OR INFORMATION ABOUT SUCH SOFTWARE WHICH MAY BE
IMPOSED FROM TIME TO TIME. YOU SHALL NOT EXPORT THE SOFTWARE,
DOCUMENTATION OR INFORMATION ABOUT THE SOFTWARE AND
DOCUMENTATION WITHOUT COMPLYING WITH SUCH LAWS, REGULATIONS,
ORDERS, OR OTHER RESTRICTIONS. YOU AGREE TO INDEMNIFY ZyXEL AGAINST
ALL CLAIMS, LOSSES, DAMAGES, LIABILITIES, COSTS AND EXPENSES,
INCLUDING REASONABLE ATTORNEYS' FEES, TO THE EXTENT SUCH CLAIMS
ARISE OUT OF ANY BREACH OF THIS SECTION 8.
9.Audit Rights
ZyXEL SHALL HAVE THE RIGHT, AT ITS OWN EXPENSE, UPON REASONABLE PRIOR
NOTICE, TO PERIODICALLY INSPECT AND AUDIT YOUR RECORDS TO ENSURE
YOUR COMPLIANCE WITH THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF THIS LICENSE
AGREEMENT.
10.Termination
This License Agreement is effective until it is terminated. You may terminate this
License Agreement at any time by destroying or returning to ZyXEL all copies of the Software and Documentation in your possession or under your control. ZyXEL may terminate this License Agreement for any reason, including, but not limited to, if ZyXEL finds that you have violated any of the terms of this License
Agreement. Upon notification of termination, you agree to destroy or return to
ZyXEL all copies of the Software and Documentation and to certify in writing that all known copies, including backup copies, have been destroyed. All provisions relating to confidentiality, proprietary rights, and non-disclosure shall survive the termination of this Software License Agreement.
11.General
This License Agreement shall be construed, interpreted and governed by the laws of Republic of China without regard to conflicts of laws provisions thereof. The exclusive forum for any disputes arising out of or relating to this License
Agreement shall be an appropriate court or Commercial Arbitration Association
492
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences sitting in ROC, Taiwan if the parties agree to a binding arbitration. This License
Agreement shall constitute the entire Agreement between the parties hereto. This
License Agreement, the rights granted hereunder, the Software and
Documentation shall not be assigned by you without the prior written consent of
ZyXEL. Any waiver or modification of this License Agreement shall only be effective if it is in writing and signed by both parties hereto. If any part of this
License Agreement is found invalid or unenforceable by a court of competent jurisdiction, the remainder of this License Agreement shall be interpreted so as to reasonably effect the intention of the parties.
NOTE: Some components of this product incorporate free software programs covered under the open source code licenses which allows you to freely copy, modify and redistribute the software. For at least three (3) years from the date of distribution of the applicable product or software, we will give to anyone who contacts us at the ZyXEL Technical Support ([email protected]), for a charge of no more than our cost of physically performing source code distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of the complete corresponding source code for the version of the Programs that we distributed to you if we are in possession of such.
This Product includes cups, libgcgi, libgphoto2, libraw1394, pam_mount, wxWidgets, wxWidgets, flac and libjson software under LGPL 2.1 license.
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2.1, February 1999
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. [This is the first released version of the
Lesser GPL. It also counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence the version number 2.1.
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for all its users.
NSA210 User’s Guide
493
Appendix E Open Source Licences
This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some specially designated software packages--typically libraries--of the Free Software
Foundation and other authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we suggest you first think carefully about whether this license or the ordinary General
Public License is the better strategy to use in any particular case, based on the explanations below.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use, not price.
Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get it if you want it; that you can change the software and use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed that you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. If you link other code with the library, you must provide complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them with the library after making changes to the library and recompiling it.
And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the library, and
(2) we offer you this license, which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the library.
To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear that there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the library is modified by someone else and passed on, the recipients should know that what they have is not the original version, so that the original author's reputation will not be affected by problems that might be introduced by others.
Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of any free program. We wish to make sure that a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent holder.
Therefore, we insist that any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with the full freedom of use specified in this license.
Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the ordinary GNU
General Public License. This license, the GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary
494
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
General Public License. We use this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into non-free programs.
When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using a shared library, the combination of the two is legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the original library. The ordinary General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the entire combination fits its criteria of freedom. The
Lesser General Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other code with the library.
We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License because it does Less to protect the user's freedom than the ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free software developers Less of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These disadvantages are the reason we use the ordinary
General Public License for many libraries. However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain special circumstances.
For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. A more frequent case is that a free library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, so we use the Lesser General Public License. In other cases, permission to use a particular library in non-free programs enables a greater number of people to use a large body of free software. For example, permission to use the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system.
Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the user of a program that is linked with the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a modified version of the Library.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
Pay close attention to the difference between a "work based on the library" and a
"work that uses the library". The former contains code derived from the library, whereas the latter must be combined with the library in order to run.
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING,
DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License Agreement applies to any software library or other program which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or other authorized party saying it
NSA210 User’s Guide
495
Appendix E Open Source Licences may be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Public License (also called "this License").
Each licensee is addressed as "you".
A "library" means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs (which use some of those functions and data) to form executables. The "Library", below, refers to any such software library or work which has been distributed under these terms. A "work based on the Library" means either the Library or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term
"modification".)
"Source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the library. Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of running a program using the Library is not restricted, and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true depends on what the Library does and what the program that uses the Library does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Library's complete source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this License along with the
Library. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library, and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: a) The modified work must itself be a software library. b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and the date of any change. c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this License. d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be supplied by an application program that uses the facility, other than as an argument passed when the facility is invoked, then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such function or table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful. (For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is
496
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences entirely well-defined independent of the application. Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied function or table used by this function must be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square root function must still compute square roots.) These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Library, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Library, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Library. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Library with the Library (or with a work based on the Library) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.
3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the ordinary GNU
General Public License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change in these notices. Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to all subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy. This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the Library into a program that is not a library.
4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or a portion or derivative of it, under
Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you accompany it with the complete corresponding machinereadable source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange. If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is called a
"work that uses the Library". Such a work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside the scope of this License.
NSA210 User’s Guide
497
Appendix E Open Source Licences
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with the Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library (because it contains portions of the
Library), rather than a "work that uses the library". The executable is therefore covered by this License. Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executables. When a "work that uses the Library" uses material from a header file that is part of the Library, the object code for the work may be a derivative work of the Library even though the source code is not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the work can be linked without the Library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and accessors, and small macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. (Executables containing this object code plus portions of the Library will still fall under Section 6.) Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library, you may distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are linked directly with the Library itself.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may also combine or link a "work that uses the Library" with the Library to produce a work containing portions of the Library, and distribute that work under terms of your choice, provided that the terms permit modification of the work for the customer's own use and reverse engineering for debugging such modifications. You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by this License. You must supply a copy of this License. If the work during execution displays copyright notices, you must include the copyright notice for the Library among them, as well as a reference directing the user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do one of these things: a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code for the Library including whatever changes were used in the work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked with the Library, with the complete machinereadable "work that uses the Library", as object code and/or source code, so that the user can modify the Library and then relink to produce a modified executable containing the modified Library. (It is understood that the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the Library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application to use the modified definitions.) b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the library already present on the user's computer system, rather than copying library functions into the executable, and (2) will operate properly with a modified version of the library, if the user installs one, as long as the modified version is interface-compatible with the version that the work was made with. c)
Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give the same user the materials specified in Subsection 6a, above, for a charge no more
498
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences than the cost of performing this distribution. d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above specified materials from the same place. e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you have already sent this user a copy. For an executable, the required form of the "work that uses the Library" must include any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the executable.
It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a contradiction means you cannot use both them and the Library together in an executable that you distribute.
7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on the Library side-by-side in a single library together with other library facilities not covered by this License, and distribute such a combined library, provided that the separate distribution of the work based on the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, and provided that you do these two things: a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must be distributed under the terms of the
Sections above. b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the Library is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
9. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it.
However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Library or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Library (or any work based on the Library), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Library or works based on it.
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any work based on the Library), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute, link with or modify the Library subject to these terms and conditions.
You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the
NSA210 User’s Guide
499
Appendix E Open Source Licences rights granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this
License. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the Library at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Library by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Library. If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply, and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances. It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is implemented by public license practices.
Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice. This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this License.
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the Library under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the
Library does not specify a license version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library into other free programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for
500
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.
Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
NO WARRANTY
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/
OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY
KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME
THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY
MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE
TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING
RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR
A FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF
SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCHDAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS.
This Product includes Linux Kernel, uboot, cups, busybox, dhcpcd 1.3.22-p14, fuse, gphoto2, gphotofs, ipkg, libeeprog, libiconv, libid3tag, libol, lm-sensors, mdadm, mt-daapd, mtd-utils, ntfs-3g, pciutils, quotatool, reiserfsprogs, samba, sg3_utils, syslog-ng, upnpigdctrl, dar, ez-ipupdate, inadyn, aMule, Glib, pango, pkg-config, gallery, nfs-utils, mysql, phpMyAdmin, smartmontools, squeezeboxserver, WordPress, Audio-Scan, DBD-mysql, DBI, flac, PERL, AutoXS-
Header, Class-C3-XS, Class-XSAccessor, Class-XSAccessor-Array, Compress-Raw-
Zlib, Digest-SHA1, EV, ExtUtils-Cbuilder, GD, HTML-Parser, JSON-XS, Module-Build,
Sub-Name, Template-Toolkit, XML-Parser and libchardet software under GPL 2.0 license.
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
NSA210 User’s Guide
501
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Version 2, June 1991
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This General Public License applies to most of the
Free Software Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by the GNU Library General Public License instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our
General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it. For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software. Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original authors' reputations.
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. To prevent this, we
502
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences have made it clear that any patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed under the terms of this
General Public License. The "Program", below, refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program" means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term "modification".) Each licensee is addressed as "you". Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
Program (independent of having been made by running the Program). Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty; and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License along with the Program. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this License. c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when run, you must cause it, when started running for such interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this License. (Exception: if the Program
NSA210 User’s Guide
503
Appendix E Open Source Licences itself is interactive but does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Program. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program with the Program (or with a work based on the
Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.
3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it, under Section
2) in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following: a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or, b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or, c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer to distribute corresponding source code.
(This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you received the program in object code or executable form with such an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.) The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components
(compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the executable. If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same
504
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences place counts as distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it.
However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Program or works based on it.
6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this
License.
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you
(whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this
License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Program. If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances. It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system, which is implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice. This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this License.
NSA210 User’s Guide
505
Appendix E Open Source Licences
8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the Program under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the
Program does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this.
Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
NO WARRANTY
11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.
EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/
OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF
ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE
DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR
CORRECTION.
12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY
MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE
LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE
THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING
RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR
A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN
506
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
All other trademarks or trade names mentioned herein, if any, are the property of their respective owners.
This Product includes mediainfo software under below license
MediaInfo(Lib) License
Version 1.1, 3 January 2010
Copyright 2002-2010 MediaArea.net SARL. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1.Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2.Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with modification, are permitted provided that the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or any later version is met.
Dynamic or static linking to this software are not deemed a modification.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY MEDIAAREA.NET SARL ``AS IS'' AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL MEDIAAREA.NET OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
________________________________________
NSA210 User’s Guide
507
Appendix E Open Source Licences
GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 3, 29 June 2007
Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
This version of the GNU Lesser General Public License incorporates the terms and conditions of version 3 of the GNU General Public License, supplemented by the additional permissions listed below.
0. Additional Definitions.
As used herein, “this License” refers to version 3 of the GNU Lesser General Public
License, and the “GNU GPL” refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License.
“The Library” refers to a covered work governed by this License, other than an
Application or a Combined Work as defined below.
An “Application” is any work that makes use of an interface provided by the
Library, but which is not otherwise based on the Library. Defining a subclass of a class defined by the Library is deemed a mode of using an interface provided by the Library.
A “Combined Work” is a work produced by combining or linking an Application with the Library. The particular version of the Library with which the Combined Work was made is also called the “Linked Version”.
The “Minimal Corresponding Source” for a Combined Work means the
Corresponding Source for the Combined Work, excluding any source code for portions of the Combined Work that, considered in isolation, are based on the
Application, and not on the Linked Version.
The “Corresponding Application Code” for a Combined Work means the object code and/or source code for the Application, including any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the Combined Work from the Application, but excluding the System Libraries of the Combined Work.
1. Exception to Section 3 of the GNU GPL.
You may convey a covered work under sections 3 and 4 of this License without being bound by section 3 of the GNU GPL.
2. Conveying Modified Versions.
508
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
If you modify a copy of the Library, and, in your modifications, a facility refers to a function or data to be supplied by an Application that uses the facility (other than as an argument passed when the facility is invoked), then you may convey a copy of the modified version:
•a) under this License, provided that you make a good faith effort to ensure that, in the event an Application does not supply the function or data, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful, or
•b) under the GNU GPL, with none of the additional permissions of this License applicable to that copy.
3. Object Code Incorporating Material from Library Header Files.
The object code form of an Application may incorporate material from a header file that is part of the Library. You may convey such object code under terms of your choice, provided that, if the incorporated material is not limited to numerical parameters, data structure layouts and accessors, or small macros, inline functions and templates (ten or fewer lines in length), you do both of the following:
•a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the object code that the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by this License.
•b) Accompany the object code with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license document.
4. Combined Works.
You may convey a Combined Work under terms of your choice that, taken together, effectively do not restrict modification of the portions of the Library contained in the Combined Work and reverse engineering for debugging such modifications, if you also do each of the following:
•a) Give prominent notice with each copy of the Combined Work that the Library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by this License.
•b) Accompany the Combined Work with a copy of the GNU GPL and this license document.
•c) For a Combined Work that displays copyright notices during execution, include the copyright notice for the Library among these notices, as well as a reference directing the user to the copies of the GNU GPL and this license document.
•d) Do one of the following: o0) Convey the Minimal Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, and the Corresponding Application Code in a form suitable for, and under terms
NSA210 User’s Guide
509
Appendix E Open Source Licences that permit, the user to recombine or relink the Application with a modified version of the Linked Version to produce a modified Combined Work, in the manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL for conveying Corresponding
Source. o1) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the Library. A suitable mechanism is one that (a) uses at run time a copy of the Library already present on the user's computer system, and (b) will operate properly with a modified version of the Library that is interface-compatible with the Linked Version.
•e) Provide Installation Information, but only if you would otherwise be required to provide such information under section 6 of the GNU GPL, and only to the extent that such information is necessary to install and execute a modified version of the Combined Work produced by recombining or relinking the Application with a modified version of the Linked Version. (If you use option 4d0, the Installation
Information must accompany the Minimal Corresponding Source and
Corresponding Application Code. If you use option 4d1, you must provide the
Installation Information in the manner specified by section 6 of the GNU GPL for conveying Corresponding Source.)
5. Combined Libraries.
You may place library facilities that are a work based on the Library side by side in a single library together with other library facilities that are not Applications and are not covered by this License, and convey such a combined library under terms of your choice, if you do both of the following:
•a) Accompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the
Library, uncombined with any other library facilities, conveyed under the terms of this License.
•b) Give prominent notice with the combined library that part of it is a work based on the Library, and explaining where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work.
6. Revised Versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License.
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
GNU Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Library as you received it specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU Lesser General
Public License “or any later version” applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that published version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the Library as you received it does
510
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences not specify a version number of the GNU Lesser General Public License, you may choose any version of the GNU Lesser General Public License ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
If the Library as you received it specifies that a proxy can decide whether future versions of the GNU Lesser General Public License shall apply, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of any version is permanent authorization for you to choose that version for the Library.
________________________________________
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 3, 29 June 2007
Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for software and other kinds of works.
The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, the GNU General
Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our
General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs, and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same freedoms that you received. You
NSA210 User’s Guide
511
Appendix E Open Source Licences must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: (1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it.
For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to authors of previous versions.
Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users.
Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the
GPL assures that patents cannot be used to render the program non-free.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS
0. Definitions.
“This License” refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License.
“Copyright” also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of works, such as semiconductor masks.
“The Program” refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this License. Each licensee is addressed as “you”. “Licensees” and “recipients” may be individuals or organizations.
To “modify” a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an exact copy.
The resulting work is called a “modified version” of the earlier work or a work
“based on” the earlier work.
512
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
A “covered work” means either the unmodified Program or a work based on the
Program.
To “propagate” a work means to do anything with it that, without permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a computer or modifying a private copy.
Propagation includes copying, distribution (with or without modification), making available to the public, and in some countries other activities as well.
To “convey” a work means any kind of propagation that enables other parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying.
An interactive user interface displays “Appropriate Legal Notices” to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion.
1. Source Code.
The “source code” for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. “Object code” means any non-source form of a work.
A “Standard Interface” means an interface that either is an official standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that is widely used among developers working in that language.
The “System Libraries” of an executable work include anything, other than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of packaging a Major
Component, but which is not part of that Major Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that Major Component, or to implement a Standard
Interface for which an implementation is available to the public in source code form. A “Major Component”, in this context, means a major essential component
(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system (if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
The “Corresponding Source” for a work in object code form means all the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to control those activities. However, it does not include the work's System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source
NSA210 User’s Guide
513
Appendix E Open Source Licences includes interface definition files associated with source files for the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require, such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those subprograms and other parts of the work.
The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding Source.
The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that same work.
2. Basic Permissions.
All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of copyright on the
Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you.
Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 makes it unnecessary.
3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article 11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such measures.
When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of technological measures.
4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
514
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; keep intact all notices stating that this
License and any non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all recipients a copy of this License along with the Program.
You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee.
5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
•a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified it, and giving a relevant date.
•b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is released under this
License and any conditions added under section 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to “keep intact all notices”.
•c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not invalidate such permission if you have separately received it.
•d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display Appropriate
Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your work need not make them do so.
A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an “aggregate” if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other parts of the aggregate.
6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, in one of these ways:
NSA210 User’s Guide
515
Appendix E Open Source Licences
•a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange.
•b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the Corresponding
Source from a network server at no charge.
•c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord with subsection 6b.
•d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements.
•e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no charge under subsection 6d.
A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded from the
Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be included in conveying the object code work.
A “User Product” is either (1) a “consumer product”, which means any tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product, doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular product received by a particular user, “normally used” refers to a typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial commercial,
516
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent the only significant mode of use of the product.
“Installation Information” for a User Product means any methods, procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from a modified version of its
Corresponding Source. The information must suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because modification has been made.
If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has been installed in ROM).
The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a network may be denied when the modification itself materially and adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and protocols for communication across the network.
Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly documented (and with an implementation available to the public in source code form), and must require no special password or key for unpacking, reading or copying.
7. Additional Terms.
“Additional permissions” are terms that supplement the terms of this License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by this License without regard to the additional permissions.
When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
NSA210 User’s Guide
517
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms:
•a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the terms of sections
15 and 16 of this License; or
•b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal Notices displayed by works containing it; or
•c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in reasonable ways as different from the original version; or
•d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or authors of the material; or
•e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or
•f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on those licensors and authors.
All other non-permissive additional terms are considered “further restrictions” within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is governed by this License along with a term that is a further restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this
License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms of that license document, provided that the further restriction does not survive such relicensing or conveying.
If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating where to find the applicable terms.
Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; the above requirements apply either way.
8. Termination.
You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or modify it is void, and
518
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences will automatically terminate your rights under this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third paragraph of section 11).
However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation.
Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice.
Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same material under section 10.
9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or run a copy of the
Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so.
10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
An “entity transaction” is a transaction transferring control of an organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered work results from an entity transaction, each party to that transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the Corresponding
Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
NSA210 User’s Guide
519
Appendix E Open Source Licences
You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it.
11. Patents.
A “contributor” is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this License of the
Program or a work on which the Program is based. The work thus licensed is called the contributor's “contributor version”.
A contributor's “essential patent claims” are all patent claims owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For purposes of this definition, “control” includes the right to grant patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of this License.
Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and propagate the contents of its contributor version.
In the following three paragraphs, a “patent license” is any express agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent (such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to sue for patent infringement). To
“grant” such a patent license to a party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a patent against the party.
If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, and the
Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, then you must either (1) cause the
Corresponding Source to be so available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent license to downstream recipients. “Knowingly relying” means you have actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that country that you have reason to believe are valid.
If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties receiving the covered work authorizing them
520
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences to use, propagate, modify or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered work and works based on it.
A patent license is “discriminatory” if it does not include within the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily for and in connection with specific products or compilations that contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007.
Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law.
12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom.
If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed under version 3 of the GNU Affero
General Public License into a single combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public
License, section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the combination as such.
14. Revised Versions of this License.
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in
NSA210 User’s Guide
521
Appendix E Open Source Licences spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General Public License “or any later version” applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered version or of any later version published by the Free
Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the
GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published by the
Free Software Foundation.
If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of the GNU
General Public License can be used, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Program.
Later license versions may give you additional or different permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a later version.
15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM “AS IS”
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK
AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU.
SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. Limitation of Liability.
IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES
AND/OR CONVEYS THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING
RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR
A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN
IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES.
17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
522
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a copy of the Program in return for a fee.
This Product includes rsync software under GPL 3.0 license
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 3, 29 June 2007
Copyright © 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for software and other kinds of works.
The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast, the GNU General
Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our
General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs, and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
NSA210 User’s Guide
523
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps: (1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it.
For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to authors of previous versions.
Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users.
Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents. States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the
GPL assures that patents cannot be used to render the program non-free.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS
0. Definitions.
“This License” refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License.
“Copyright” also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of works, such as semiconductor masks.
“The Program” refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this License. Each licensee is addressed as “you”. “Licensees” and “recipients” may be individuals or organizations.
To “modify” a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an exact copy.
The resulting work is called a “modified version” of the earlier work or a work
“based on” the earlier work.
A “covered work” means either the unmodified Program or a work based on the
Program.
524
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
To “propagate” a work means to do anything with it that, without permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a computer or modifying a private copy.
Propagation includes copying, distribution (with or without modification), making available to the public, and in some countries other activities as well.
To “convey” a work means any kind of propagation that enables other parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying.
An interactive user interface displays “Appropriate Legal Notices” to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2) tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion.
1. Source Code.
The “source code” for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. “Object code” means any non-source form of a work.
A “Standard Interface” means an interface that either is an official standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that is widely used among developers working in that language.
The “System Libraries” of an executable work include anything, other than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of packaging a Major
Component, but which is not part of that Major Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that Major Component, or to implement a Standard
Interface for which an implementation is available to the public in source code form. A “Major Component”, in this context, means a major essential component
(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system (if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
The “Corresponding Source” for a work in object code form means all the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to control those activities. However, it does not include the work's System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source includes interface definition files associated with source files for the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically linked subprograms that the work
NSA210 User’s Guide
525
Appendix E Open Source Licences is specifically designed to require, such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those subprograms and other parts of the work.
The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding Source.
The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that same work.
2. Basic Permissions.
All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of copyright on the
Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you.
Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10 makes it unnecessary.
3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article 11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such measures.
When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of technological measures.
526
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice; keep intact all notices stating that this
License and any non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code; keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all recipients a copy of this License along with the Program.
You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey, and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee.
5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
•a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified it, and giving a relevant date.
•b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is released under this
License and any conditions added under section 7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to “keep intact all notices”.
•c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7 additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts, regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not invalidate such permission if you have separately received it.
•d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display Appropriate
Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your work need not make them do so.
A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work, and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an “aggregate” if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other parts of the aggregate.
NSA210 User’s Guide
527
Appendix E Open Source Licences
6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License, in one of these ways:
•a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange.
•b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the Corresponding
Source from a network server at no charge.
•c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord with subsection 6b.
•d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party) that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements.
•e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no charge under subsection 6d.
A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded from the
Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be included in conveying the object code work.
A “User Product” is either (1) a “consumer product”, which means any tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family, or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation into a dwelling. In
528
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences determining whether a product is a consumer product, doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular product received by a particular user, “normally used” refers to a typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent the only significant mode of use of the product.
“Installation Information” for a User Product means any methods, procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from a modified version of its
Corresponding Source. The information must suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because modification has been made.
If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has been installed in ROM).
The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a network may be denied when the modification itself materially and adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and protocols for communication across the network.
Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided, in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly documented (and with an implementation available to the public in source code form), and must require no special password or key for unpacking, reading or copying.
7. Additional Terms.
“Additional permissions” are terms that supplement the terms of this License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions. Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by this License without regard to the additional permissions.
NSA210 User’s Guide
529
Appendix E Open Source Licences
When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work, for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms:
•a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the terms of sections
15 and 16 of this License; or
•b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal Notices displayed by works containing it; or
•c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in reasonable ways as different from the original version; or
•d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or authors of the material; or
•e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or
•f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on those licensors and authors.
All other non-permissive additional terms are considered “further restrictions” within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is governed by this License along with a term that is a further restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this
License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms of that license document, provided that the further restriction does not survive such relicensing or conveying.
If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating where to find the applicable terms.
530
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions; the above requirements apply either way.
8. Termination.
You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third paragraph of section 11).
However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation.
Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice.
Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same material under section 10.
9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or run a copy of the
Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However, nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so.
10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
An “entity transaction” is a transaction transferring control of an organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an organization, or merging
NSA210 User’s Guide
531
Appendix E Open Source Licences organizations. If propagation of a covered work results from an entity transaction, each party to that transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the Corresponding
Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it.
11. Patents.
A “contributor” is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this License of the
Program or a work on which the Program is based. The work thus licensed is called the contributor's “contributor version”.
A contributor's “essential patent claims” are all patent claims owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version, but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For purposes of this definition, “control” includes the right to grant patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of this License.
Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and propagate the contents of its contributor version.
In the following three paragraphs, a “patent license” is any express agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent (such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to sue for patent infringement). To
“grant” such a patent license to a party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a patent against the party.
If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license, and the
Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a publicly available network server or other readily accessible means, then you must either (1) cause the
Corresponding Source to be so available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent license to downstream recipients. “Knowingly relying” means you have actual knowledge
532
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences that, but for the patent license, your conveying the covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that country that you have reason to believe are valid.
If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered work and works based on it.
A patent license is “discriminatory” if it does not include within the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily for and in connection with specific products or compilations that contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement, or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007.
Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law.
12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom.
If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed under version 3 of the GNU Affero
General Public License into a single combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work, but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public
NSA210 User’s Guide
533
Appendix E Open Source Licences
License, section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the combination as such.
14. Revised Versions of this License.
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the
GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General Public License “or any later version” applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered version or of any later version published by the Free
Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the
GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published by the
Free Software Foundation.
If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of the GNU
General Public License can be used, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Program.
Later license versions may give you additional or different permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a later version.
15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM “AS IS”
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK
AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU.
SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. Limitation of Liability.
IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES
AND/OR CONVEYS THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE
PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING
RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR
534
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN
IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES.
17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms, reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a copy of the Program in return for a fee.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
NSA210 User’s Guide
535
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode:
<program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an “about box”.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school, if any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the program, if necessary. For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see <http:// www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General Public License instead of this
License. But first, please read <http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-notlgpl.html>.
This Product includes dojo, openssl, libupnp, sg3_utils, cherrypy and YAML-Syck software under BSD license
BSD
Copyright (c) [dates as appropriate to package]
The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
536
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Neither the name of the University nor of the Laboratory may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOS E ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
This Product includes flac software under FDL license
GNU Free Documentation License
Version 1.2, November 2002
Copyright (C) 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
0. PREAMBLE
The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other functional and useful document "free" in the sense of freedom: to assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible for modifications made by others. This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft license designed for free software.
We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free software, because free software needs free documentation: a free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the software does. But this
License is not limited to software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We
NSA210 User’s Guide
537
Appendix E Open Source Licences recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS
This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The "Document", below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you". You accept the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission under copyright law.
A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with modifications and/or translated into another language. A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding them.
The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice that says that the
Document is released under this License. If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The
Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none. The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover
Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a format whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for revising the document straightforwardly with generic text editors or
(for images composed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text or matters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not
538
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not "Transparent" is called "Opaque".
Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats include proprietary ormats that can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and the machine-generated HTML,
PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes only.
The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in formats which do not have any title page as such,
"Title Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text. A section "Entitled XYZ" means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as
"Acknowledgements", "Dedications", "Endorsements", or "History".) To "Preserve the Title" of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a section "Entitled XYZ" according to this definition.
The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no effect on the meaning of this License.
2. VERBATIM COPYING
You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3.
You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly display copies.
3. COPYING IN QUANTITY
NSA210 User’s Guide
539
Appendix E Open Source Licences
If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and
Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects.
If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent pages.
If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than
100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general network-using public has access to download using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the
Document, free of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public.
It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
4. MODIFICATIONS
You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release the Modified
Version under precisely this License, with the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in the
Modified Version:
A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the
Document, and from those of previous versions
(which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section of the
Document). You may use the same title as a previous version if the original publisher of that version gives permission.
B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
540
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you from this requirement.
C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the publisher.
D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other copyright notices.
F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.
G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required
Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.
H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.
I. Preserve the section Entitled "History", Preserve its Title, and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If there is no section Entitled "History" in the Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified Version as stated in the previous sentence.
J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network locations given in the Document for previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the
"History" section. You may omit a network location for a work that was published at least four years before the Document itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.
K. For any section Entitled "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications", Preserve the
Title of the section, and preserve in the section all
the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein.
L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
NSA210 User’s Guide
541
Appendix E Open Source Licences
M. Delete any section Entitled "Endorsements". Such a section may not be included in the Modified Version.
N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled "Endorsements" or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.
O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
You may add a section Entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a standard.
You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the
Modified Version. Only one passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover
Text may be added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the
Document already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS
You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty
Disclaimers.
The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but different contents, make the title of each such section unique by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique
542
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of Invariant
Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled "History" in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections Entitled "Acknowledgements", and any sections Entitled
"Dedications". You must delete all sections Entitled "Endorsements".
6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS
You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS
A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this
License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves derivative works of the Document.
If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these copies of the
Document, then if the Document is less than one half of the entire aggregate, the
Document's Cover Texts may be placed on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole aggregate.
8. TRANSLATION
Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4.
Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
NSA210 User’s Guide
543
Appendix E Open Source Licences translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a translation of this License, and all the license notices in the Document, and any
Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include the original English version of this License and the original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between the translation and the original version of this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
If a section in the Document is Entitled "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", or
"History", the requirement (section 4) to Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual title.
9. TERMINATION
You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided for under this License. Any other attempt to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE
The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of the GNU Free
Documentation License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/.
Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number. If the
Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents
To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of the License in the document and put the following copyright and license notices just after the title page:
Copyright (c) YEAR YOUR NAME.
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-
544
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License".
If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts, replace the "with...Texts." line with this: with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST.
If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the situation. If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free software license, such as the GNU
General Public License, to permit their use in free software.
This Product includes Encode-Detect software under MPL 1.1 license
MOZILLA PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 1.1
1. Definitions.
1.0.1. "Commercial Use" means distribution or otherwise making the
Covered Code available to a third party.
1.1. "Contributor" means each entity that creates or contributes to
the creation of Modifications.
1.2. "Contributor Version" means the combination of the Original
Code, prior Modifications used by a Contributor, and the Modifications
made by that particular Contributor.
1.3. "Covered Code" means the Original Code or Modifications or the
combination of the Original Code and Modifications, in each case
including portions thereof.
1.4. "Electronic Distribution Mechanism" means a mechanism generally
accepted in the software development community for the electronic
transfer of data.
NSA210 User’s Guide
545
Appendix E Open Source Licences
1.5. "Executable" means Covered Code in any form other than Source
Code.
1.6. "Initial Developer" means the individual or entity identified
as the Initial Developer in the Source Code notice required by Exhibit
A.
1.7. "Larger Work" means a work which combines Covered Code or
portions thereof with code not governed by the terms of this License.
1.8. "License" means this document.
1.8.1. "Licensable" means having the right to grant, to the maximum
extent possible, whether at the time of the initial grant or
subsequently acquired, any and all of the rights conveyed herein.
1.9. "Modifications" means any addition to or deletion from the
substance or structure of either the Original Code or any previous
Modifications. When Covered Code is released as a series of files, a
Modification is:
A. Any addition to or deletion from the contents of a file
containing Original Code or previous Modifications.
B. Any new file that contains any part of the Original Code or
previous Modifications.
1.10. "Original Code" means Source Code of computer software code
which is described in the Source Code notice required by Exhibit A as
Original Code, and which, at the time of its release under this
License is not already Covered Code governed by this License.
1.10.1. "Patent Claims" means any patent claim(s), now owned or
hereafter acquired, including without limitation, method, process,
546
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
and apparatus claims, in any patent Licensable by grantor.
1.11. "Source Code" means the preferred form of the Covered Code for
making modifications to it, including all modules it contains, plus
any associated interface definition files, scripts used to control
compilation and installation of an Executable, or source code
differential comparisons against either the Original Code or another
well known, available Covered Code of the Contributor's choice. The
Source Code can be in a compressed or archival form, provided the
appropriate decompression or de-archiving software is widely available
for no charge.
1.12. "You" (or "Your") means an individual or a legal entity
exercising rights under, and complying with all of the terms of, this
License or a future version of this License issued under Section 6.1.
For legal entities, "You" includes any entity which controls, is
controlled by, or is under common control with You. For purposes of
this definition, "control" means (a) the power, direct or indirect,
to cause the direction or management of such entity, whether by
contract or otherwise, or (b) ownership of more than fifty percent
(50%) of the outstanding shares or beneficial ownership of such
entity.
2. Source Code License.
2.1. The Initial Developer Grant.
The Initial Developer hereby grants You a world-wide, royalty-free,
non-exclusive license, subject to third party intellectual property
claims:
NSA210 User’s Guide
547
Appendix E Open Source Licences
(a) under intellectual property rights (other than patent or
trademark) Licensable by Initial Developer to use, reproduce,
modify, display, perform, sublicense and distribute the Original
Code (or portions thereof) with or without Modifications, and/or
as part of a Larger Work; and
(b) under Patents Claims infringed by the making, using or
selling of Original Code, to make, have made, use, practice,
sell, and offer for sale, and/or otherwise dispose of the
Original Code (or portions thereof).
(c) the licenses granted in this Section 2.1(a) and (b) are
effective on the date Initial Developer first distributes
Original Code under the terms of this License.
(d) Notwithstanding Section 2.1(b) above, no patent license is
granted: 1) for code that You delete from the Original Code; 2)
separate from the Original Code; or 3) for infringements caused
by: i) the modification of the Original Code or ii) the
combination of the Original Code with other software or devices.
2.2. Contributor Grant.
Subject to third party intellectual property claims, each Contributor
hereby grants You a world-wide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license
(a) under intellectual property rights (other than patent or
trademark) Licensable by Contributor, to use, reproduce, modify,
display, perform, sublicense and distribute the Modifications
created by such Contributor (or portions thereof) either on an
unmodified basis, with other Modifications, as Covered Code
548
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
and/or as part of a Larger Work; and
(b) under Patent Claims infringed by the making, using, or
selling of Modifications made by that Contributor either alone
and/or in combination with its Contributor Version (or portions
of such combination), to make, use, sell, offer for sale, have
made, and/or otherwise dispose of: 1) Modifications made by that
Contributor (or portions thereof); and 2) the combination of
Modifications made by that Contributor with its Contributor
Version (or portions of such combination).
(c) the licenses granted in Sections 2.2(a) and 2.2(b) are
effective on the date Contributor first makes Commercial Use of
the Covered Code.
(d) Notwithstanding Section 2.2(b) above, no patent license is
granted: 1) for any code that Contributor has deleted from the
Contributor Version; 2) separate from the Contributor Version;
3) for infringements caused by: i) third party modifications of
Contributor Version or ii) the combination of Modifications made
by that Contributor with other software (except as part of the
Contributor Version) or other devices; or 4) under Patent Claims
infringed by Covered Code in the absence of Modifications made by
that Contributor.
3. Distribution Obligations.
3.1. Application of License.
The Modifications which You create or to which You contribute are
governed by the terms of this License, including without limitation
NSA210 User’s Guide
549
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Section 2.2. The Source Code version of Covered Code may be
distributed only under the terms of this License or a future version
of this License released under Section 6.1, and You must include a
copy of this License with every copy of the Source Code You
distribute. You may not offer or impose any terms on any Source Code
version that alters or restricts the applicable version of this
License or the recipients' rights hereunder. However, You may include
an additional document offering the additional rights described in
Section 3.5.
3.2. Availability of Source Code.
Any Modification which You create or to which You contribute must be
made available in Source Code form under the terms of this License
either on the same media as an Executable version or via an accepted
Electronic Distribution Mechanism to anyone to whom you made an
Executable version available; and if made available via Electronic
Distribution Mechanism, must remain available for at least twelve (12)
months after the date it initially became available, or at least six
(6) months after a subsequent version of that particular Modification
has been made available to such recipients. You are responsible for
ensuring that the Source Code version remains available even if the
Electronic Distribution Mechanism is maintained by a third party.
3.3. Description of Modifications.
You must cause all Covered Code to which You contribute to contain a
file documenting the changes You made to create that Covered Code and
the date of any change. You must include a prominent statement that
550
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
the Modification is derived, directly or indirectly, from Original
Code provided by the Initial Developer and including the name of the
Initial Developer in (a) the Source Code, and (b) in any notice in an
Executable version or related documentation in which You describe the
origin or ownership of the Covered Code.
3.4. Intellectual Property Matters
(a) Third Party Claims.
If Contributor has knowledge that a license under a third party's
intellectual property rights is required to exercise the rights
granted by such Contributor under Sections 2.1 or 2.2,
Contributor must include a text file with the Source Code
distribution titled "LEGAL" which describes the claim and the
party making the claim in sufficient detail that a recipient will
know whom to contact. If Contributor obtains such knowledge after
the Modification is made available as described in Section 3.2,
Contributor shall promptly modify the LEGAL file in all copies
Contributor makes available thereafter and shall take other steps
(such as notifying appropriate mailing lists or newsgroups)
reasonably calculated to inform those who received the Covered
Code that new knowledge has been obtained.
(b) Contributor APIs.
If Contributor's Modifications include an application programming
interface and Contributor has knowledge of patent licenses which
are reasonably necessary to implement that API, Contributor must
also include this information in the LEGAL file.
NSA210 User’s Guide
551
Appendix E Open Source Licences
(c) Representations.
Contributor represents that, except as disclosed pursuant to
Section 3.4(a) above, Contributor believes that Contributor's
Modifications are Contributor's original creation(s) and/or
Contributor has sufficient rights to grant the rights conveyed by
this license.
3.5. Required Notices.
You must duplicate the notice in Exhibit A in each file of the Source
Code. If it is not possible to put such notice in a particular Source
Code file due to its structure, then You must include such notice in a
location (such as a relevant directory) where a user would be likely
to look for such a notice. If You created one or more Modification(s)
You may add your name as a Contributor to the notice described in
Exhibit A. You must also duplicate this License in any documentation
for the Source Code where You describe recipients' rights or ownership
rights relating to Covered Code. You may choose to offer, and to
charge a fee for, warranty, support, indemnity or liability
obligations to one or more recipients of Covered Code. However, You
may do so only on Your own behalf, and not on behalf of the Initial
Developer or any Contributor. You must make it absolutely clear than
any such warranty, support, indemnity or liability obligation is
offered by You alone, and You hereby agree to indemnify the Initial
Developer and every Contributor for any liability incurred by the
Initial Developer or such Contributor as a result of warranty,
support, indemnity or liability terms You offer.
552
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
3.6. Distribution of Executable Versions.
You may distribute Covered Code in Executable form only if the
requirements of Section 3.1-3.5 have been met for that Covered Code,
and if You include a notice stating that the Source Code version of
the Covered Code is available under the terms of this License,
including a description of how and where You have fulfilled the
obligations of Section 3.2. The notice must be conspicuously included
in any notice in an Executable version, related documentation or
collateral in which You describe recipients' rights relating to the
Covered Code. You may distribute the Executable version of Covered
Code or ownership rights under a license of Your choice, which may
contain terms different from this License, provided that You are in
compliance with the terms of this License and that the license for the
Executable version does not attempt to limit or alter the recipient's
rights in the Source Code version from the rights set forth in this
License. If You distribute the Executable version under a different
license You must make it absolutely clear that any terms which differ
from this License are offered by You alone, not by the Initial
Developer or any Contributor. You hereby agree to indemnify the
Initial Developer and every Contributor for any liability incurred by
the Initial Developer or such Contributor as a result of any such
terms You offer.
3.7. Larger Works.
You may create a Larger Work by combining Covered Code with other code
not governed by the terms of this License and distribute the Larger
NSA210 User’s Guide
553
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Work as a single product. In such a case, You must make sure the
requirements of this License are fulfilled for the Covered Code.
4. Inability to Comply Due to Statute or Regulation.
If it is impossible for You to comply with any of the terms of this
License with respect to some or all of the Covered Code due to
statute, judicial order, or regulation then You must: (a) comply with
the terms of this License to the maximum extent possible; and (b)
describe the limitations and the code they affect. Such description
must be included in the LEGAL file described in Section 3.4 and must
be included with all distributions of the Source Code. Except to the
extent prohibited by statute or regulation, such description must be
sufficiently detailed for a recipient of ordinary skill to be able to
understand it.
5. Application of this License.
This License applies to code to which the Initial Developer has
attached the notice in Exhibit A and to related Covered Code.
6. Versions of the License.
6.1. New Versions.
Netscape Communications Corporation ("Netscape") may publish revised
and/or new versions of the License from time to time. Each version
will be given a distinguishing version number.
6.2. Effect of New Versions.
Once Covered Code has been published under a particular version of the
License, You may always continue to use it under the terms of that
version. You may also choose to use such Covered Code under the terms
554
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
of any subsequent version of the License published by Netscape. No one
other than Netscape has the right to modify the terms applicable to
Covered Code created under this License.
6.3. Derivative Works.
If You create or use a modified version of this License (which you may
only do in order to apply it to code which is not already Covered Code
governed by this License), You must (a) rename Your license so that
the phrases "Mozilla", "MOZILLAPL", "MOZPL", "Netscape",
"MPL", "NPL" or any confusingly similar phrase do not appear in your
license (except to note that your license differs from this License)
and (b) otherwise make it clear that Your version of the license
contains terms which differ from the Mozilla Public License and
Netscape Public License. (Filling in the name of the Initial
Developer, Original Code or Contributor in the notice described in
Exhibit A shall not of themselves be deemed to be modifications of
this License.)
7. DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY.
COVERED CODE IS PROVIDED UNDER THIS LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, WARRANTIES THAT THE COVERED CODE IS
FREE OF DEFECTS, MERCHANTABLE, FIT FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON-
INFRINGING.
THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE COVERED
CODE IS WITH YOU. SHOULD ANY COVERED CODE PROVE DEFECTIVE IN ANY
RESPECT, YOU (NOT THE INITIAL DEVELOPER OR ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR)
ASSUME THE COST OF ANY NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
THIS DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY CONSTITUTES AN ESSENTIAL PART OF THIS
LICENSE. NO USE OF ANY COVERED CODE IS AUTHORIZED HEREUNDER EXCEPT
UNDER THIS DISCLAIMER.
NSA210 User’s Guide
555
Appendix E Open Source Licences
8. TERMINATION.
8.1. This License and the rights granted hereunder will terminate
automatically if You fail to comply with terms herein and fail to cure
such breach within 30 days of becoming aware of the breach. All
sublicenses to the Covered Code which are properly granted shall
survive any termination of this License. Provisions which, by their
nature, must remain in effect beyond the termination of this License
shall survive.
8.2. If You initiate litigation by asserting a patent infringement
claim (excluding declatory judgment actions) against Initial Developer
or a Contributor (the Initial Developer or Contributor against whom
You file such action is referred to as "Participant") alleging that:
(a) such Participant's Contributor Version directly or indirectly
infringes any patent, then any and all rights granted by such
Participant to You under Sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 of this License
shall, upon 60 days notice from Participant terminate prospectively,
unless if within 60 days after receipt of notice You either: (i)
agree in writing to pay Participant a mutually agreeable reasonable
royalty for Your past and future use of Modifications made by such
Participant, or (ii) withdraw Your litigation claim with respect to
the Contributor Version against such Participant. If within 60 days
of notice, a reasonable royalty and payment arrangement are not
mutually agreed upon in writing by the parties or the litigation claim
is not withdrawn, the rights granted by Participant to You under
Sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 automatically terminate at the expiration of
556
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
the 60 day notice period specified above.
(b) any software, hardware, or device, other than such Participant's
Contributor Version, directly or indirectly infringes any patent, then
any rights granted to You by such Participant under Sections 2.1(b)
and 2.2(b) are revoked effective as of the date You first made, used,
sold, distributed, or had made, Modifications made by that
Participant.
8.3. If You assert a patent infringement claim against Participant
alleging that such Participant's Contributor Version directly or
indirectly infringes any patent where such claim is resolved (such as
by license or settlement) prior to the initiation of patent
infringement litigation, then the reasonable value of the licenses
granted by such Participant under Sections 2.1 or 2.2 shall be taken
into account in determining the amount or value of any payment or
license.
8.4. In the event of termination under Sections 8.1 or 8.2 above,
all end user license agreements (excluding distributors and resellers)
which have been validly granted by You or any distributor hereunder
prior to termination shall survive termination.
9. LIMITATION OF LIABILITY.
UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES AND UNDER NO LEGAL THEORY, WHETHER TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), CONTRACT, OR OTHERWISE, SHALL YOU, THE
INITIAL DEVELOPER, ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR, OR ANY DISTRIBUTOR OF
COVERED CODE, OR ANY SUPPLIER OF ANY OF SUCH PARTIES, BE LIABLE TO ANY
PERSON FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES OF ANY CHARACTER INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES
FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL, WORK STOPPAGE, COMPUTER FAILURE OR
MALFUNCTION, OR ANY AND ALL OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES,
EVEN IF SUCH PARTY SHALL HAVE BEEN INFORMED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
NSA210 User’s Guide
557
Appendix E Open Source Licences
SUCH DAMAGES. THIS LIMITATION OF LIABILITY SHALL NOT APPLY TO LIABILITY
FOR DEATH OR PERSONAL INJURY RESULTING FROM SUCH PARTY'S NEGLIGENCE
TO THE EXTENT APPLICABLE LAW PROHIBITS SUCH LIMITATION. SOME
JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THIS EXCLUSION AND LIMITATION MAY NOT
APPLY TO YOU.
10. U.S. GOVERNMENT END USERS.
The Covered Code is a "commercial item," as that term is defined in
48 C.F.R. 2.101 (Oct. 1995), consisting of "commercial computer
software" and "commercial computer software documentation," as such
terms are used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212 (Sept. 1995). Consistent with 48
C.F.R. 12.212 and 48 C.F.R. 227.7202-1 through 227.7202-4 (June 1995),
all U.S. Government End Users acquire Covered Code with only those
rights set forth herein.
11. MISCELLANEOUS.
This License represents the complete agreement concerning subject
matter hereof. If any provision of this License is held to be
unenforceable, such provision shall be reformed only to the extent
necessary to make it enforceable. This License shall be governed by
California law provisions (except to the extent applicable law, if
any, provides otherwise), excluding its conflict-of-law provisions.
With respect to disputes in which at least one party is a citizen of,
or an entity chartered or registered to do business in the United
States of America, any litigation relating to this License shall be
subject to the jurisdiction of the Federal Courts of the Northern
District of California, with venue lying in Santa Clara County,
California, with the losing party responsible for costs, including
558
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
without limitation, court costs and reasonable attorneys' fees and
expenses. The application of the United Nations Convention on
Contracts for the International Sale of Goods is expressly excluded.
Any law or regulation which provides that the language of a contract
shall be construed against the drafter shall not apply to this
License.
12. RESPONSIBILITY FOR CLAIMS.
As between Initial Developer and the Contributors, each party is
responsible for claims and damages arising, directly or indirectly,
out of its utilization of rights under this License and You agree to
work with Initial Developer and Contributors to distribute such
responsibility on an equitable basis. Nothing herein is intended or
shall be deemed to constitute any admission of liability.
13. MULTIPLE-LICENSED CODE.
Initial Developer may designate portions of the Covered Code as
"Multiple-Licensed". "Multiple-Licensed" means that the Initial
Developer permits you to utilize portions of the Covered Code under
Your choice of the NPL or the alternative licenses, if any, specified
by the Initial Developer in the file described in Exhibit A.
EXHIBIT A -Mozilla Public License.
``The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License
Version 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this file except in
compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of the License at
http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
NSA210 User’s Guide
559
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS"
basis, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the
License for the specific language governing rights and limitations
under the License.
The Original Code is ______________________________________.
The Initial Developer of the Original Code is ________________________.
Portions created by ______________________ are Copyright (C) ______
_______________________. All Rights Reserved.
Contributor(s): ______________________________________.
Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms
of the _____ license (the "[___] License"), in which case the
provisions of [______] License are applicable instead of those
above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only
under the terms of the [____] License and not to allow others to use
your version of this file under the MPL, indicate your decision by
deleting the provisions above and replace them with the notice and
other provisions required by the [___] License. If you do not delete
the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file
under either the MPL or the [___] License."
[NOTE: The text of this Exhibit A may differ slightly from the text of
the notices in the Source Code files of the Original Code. You should
use the text of this Exhibit A rather than the text found in the
Original Code Source Code for Your Modifications.]
This Product includes DBD-mysql software under below license
Copyright (c) 2003 Rudolf Lippan
560
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Copyright (c) 1997-2003 Jochen Wiedmann
You may distribute under the terms of either the GNU General Public
License or the Artistic License, as specified in the Perl README file.
This Product includes sg3_utils software under below license
Upstream Authors: Douglas Gilbert <dgilbert at interlog dot com>,
Bruce Allen <ballen at gravity dot phys dot uwm dot edu>,
Peter Allworth <linsol at zeta dot org dot au>,
James Bottomley <jejb at parisc-linux dot org>,
Lars Marowsky-Bree <lmb at suse dot de>,
Kurt Garloff <garloff at suse dot de>,
Grant Grundler <grundler at parisc-linux dot org>,
Christophe Varoqui <christophe dot varoqui at free dot fr>,
Michael Weller <eowmob at exp-math dot uni-essen dot de>,
Eric Youngdale <eric at andante dot org>
Copyright:
This software is copyright(c) 1994-2007 by the authors
You are free to distribute this software under the terms of the GNU General Public License.
On Debian systems, the complete text of the GNU General Public
License can be found in /usr/share/common-licenses/GPL file.
many parts of this package are covered by the BSD license.
These include central error processing code (sg_lib.[hc]), common command code (sg_cmds_basic.[hc] and sg_cmds_extra.[hc]) and later utilities. They are Copyright: Douglas Gilbert.
The author's intention is that the BSD licensed code can be used
NSA210 User’s Guide
561
Appendix E Open Source Licences freely by others. On Debian systems, the complete text of the
BSD License can be found in `/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD'.
This Product includes DBI software under below license
The DBI module is Copyright (c) 1994-2008 Tim Bunce. Ireland.
All rights reserved.
You may distribute under the terms of either the GNU General Public
License or the Artistic License, as specified in the Perl README file.
This Product includes flac software under below license
This is the Win32 binary release for the FLAC project.
All programs and plugins are released under the GPL (see COPYING.GPL) except the Winamp 2 plugin which is LGPL (see COPYING.LGPL).
The documentation is released under the FDL (see COPYING.FDL).
This Product includes boost software under below license
BOOST SOFTWARE LICENSE
oLicense text oIntroduction oHistory oRationale oFAQ oTransition oAcknowledgements
INTRODUCTION
The Boost Software License specifies the terms and conditions of use for those
Boost libraries that it covers.
562
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Currently, some Boost libraries have their own licenses. The hope is that eventually all Boost libraries will be covered by the Boost Software License. In the meantime, all libraries comply with the Boost License requirements.
HISTORY
As Boost grew, it became unmanageable for each Boost file to have its own license. Users complained that each license needed to be reviewed, and that reviews were difficult or impossible if Boost libraries contained many different licenses. Boost moderators and maintainers spent excessive time dealing with license issues. Boost developers often copied existing licenses without actually knowing if the license wording met legal needs.
To clarify these licensing issues, the Boost moderators asked for help from the
Berkman Center for Internet & Society at Harvard Law School, Cambridge,
Massachusetts, USA. It was requested that a single Boost license be developed that met the traditional requirements that Boost licenses, particularly: oMust be simple to read and understand. oMust grant permission without fee to copy, use and modify the software for any use (commercial and non-commercial). oMust require that the license appear with all copies [including redistributions] of the software source code. oMust not require that the license appear with executables or other binary uses of the library. oMust not require that the source code be available for execution or other binary uses of the library.
Additionally, other common open source licenses were studied to see what additional issues were being treated, and additions representing good legal practice were also requested. The result is the Boost Software License:
Boost Software License - Version 1.0 - August 17th, 2003
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person or organization obtaining a copy of the software and accompanying documentation covered by this license (the "Software") to use, reproduce, display, distribute, execute, and transmit the Software, and to prepare derivative works of the
Software, and to permit third-parties to whom the Software is furnished to
NSA210 User’s Guide
563
Appendix E Open Source Licences do so, all subject to the following:
The copyright notices in the Software and this entire statement, including the above license grant, this restriction and the following disclaimer, must be included in all copies of the Software, in whole or in part, and all derivative works of the Software, unless such copies or derivative works are solely in the form of machine-executable object code generated by a source language processor.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO
EVENT
SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR ANYONE DISTRIBUTING THE SOFTWARE BE
LIABLE
FOR ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR
OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE
OR OTHER
DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
RATIONALE
The following rationale was provided by Devin Smith, the lawyer who wrote the
Boost Software License. It has been edited slightly for brevity. Editorial additions are shown in square brackets.
BENEFIT OF COMMON SOFTWARE LICENSE
If one of Boost's goals is to ease use and adoption of the various libraries made available by Boost, it does make sense to try to standardize the licenses under which the libraries are made available to users. (I make some recommendations about a possible short-form license below.)
[Standardizing the license will not] necessarily address the issue of satisfying corporate licensees. Each corporation will have its own concerns, based on their
564
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences own experiences with software licensing and distribution and, if they're careful, will want to carefully review each license, even if they've been told that they're all standard. I would expect that, unless we're remarkably brilliant (or lucky) in drafting the standard Boost license, the standard license won't satisfy the legal departments of all corporations. I imagine that some will, for instance, absolutely insist that licensors provide a warranty of title and provide indemnification for third-party intellectual property infringement claims. Others may want functional warranties. (If I were advising the corporations, I would point out that they're not paying anything for the code and getting such warranties from individual programmers, who probably do not have deep pockets, is not that valuable anyway, but other lawyers may disagree.)
But this can be addressed, not by trying to craft the perfect standard license, but by informing the corporations that they can, if they don't like the standard license, approach the authors to negotiate a different, perhaps even paid, license.
One other benefit of adopting a standard license is to help ensure that the license accomplishes, from a legal perspective, what the authors intend. For instance, many of the [original] licenses for the libraries available on boost.org do not disclaim the warranty of title, meaning that the authors could, arguably, be sued by a user if the code infringes the rights of a third party and the user is sued by that third party. I think the authors probably want to disclaim this kind of liability.
SHORT-FORM LICENSE
Without in anyway detracting from the draft license that's been circulated [to
Boost moderators], I'd like to propose an alternative "short-form" license that
Boost could have the library authors adopt. David [Abrahams] has expressed a desire to keep things as simple as possible, and to try to move away from past practice as little as possible, and this is my attempt at a draft.
This license, which is very similar to the BSD license and the MIT license, should satisfy the Open Source Initiative's Open Source Definition: (i) the license permits free redistribution, (ii) the distributed code includes source code, (iii) the license permits the creation of derivative works, (iv) the license does not discriminate against persons or groups, (v) the license does not discriminate against fields of endeavor, (vi) the rights apply to all to whom the program is redistributed, (vii) the license is not specific to a product, and (viii) the license is technologically neutral (i.e., it does not [require] an explicit gesture of assent in order to establish a contract between licensor and licensee).
This license grants all rights under the owner's copyrights (as well as an implied patent license), disclaims all liability for use of the code (including intellectual property infringement liability), and requires that all subsequent copies of the code [except machine-executable object code], including partial copies and derivative works, include the license.
NSA210 User’s Guide
565
Appendix E Open Source Licences
FAQ
How should Boost programmers apply the license to source and header files? Add a comment based on the following template, substituting appropriate text for the italicized portion:
// Copyright Joe Coder 2004 - 2006.
// Distributed under the Boost Software License, Version 1.0.
// (See accompanying file LICENSE_1_0.txt or copy at
// http://www.boost.org/LICENSE_1_0.txt)
Please leave an empty line before and after the above comment block. It is fine if the copyright and license messages are not on different lines; in no case there should be other intervening text. Do not include "All rights reserved" anywhere.
Other ways of licensing source files have been considered, but some of them turned out to unintentionally nullify legal elements of the license. Having fixed language for referring to the license helps corporate legal departments evaluate the boost distribution. Creativity in license reference language is strongly discouraged, but judicious changes in the use of whitespace are fine.
How should the license be applied to documentation files, instead? Very similarly to the way it is applied to source files: the user should see the very same text indicated in the template above, with the only difference that both the local and the web copy of LICENSE_1_0.txt should be linked to. Refer to the HTML source code of this page in case of doubt.
Note that the location of the local LICENSE_1_0.txt needs to be indicated relatively to the position of your documentation file (../LICENSE_1_0.txt, ../../
LICENSE_1_0.txt etc.)
How is the Boost license different from the GNU General Public License (GPL)? The
Boost license permits the creation of derivative works for commercial or noncommercial use with no legal requirement to release your source code. Other differences include Boost not requiring reproduction of copyright messages for object code redistribution, and the fact that the Boost license is not "viral": if you distribute your own code along with some Boost code, the Boost license applies only to the Boost code (and modified versions thereof); you are free to license your own code under any terms you like. The GPL is also much longer, and thus may be harder to understand.
Why the phrase "machine-executable object code generated by a source language processor"? To distinguish cases where we do not require reproduction of the copyrights and license, such as object libraries, shared libraries, and final program executables, from cases where reproduction is still required, such as distribution
566
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences of self-extracting archives of source code or precompiled header files. More detailed wording was rejected as not being legally necessary, and reducing readability.
Why is the "disclaimer" paragraph of the license entirely in uppercase?
Capitalization of these particular provisions is a US legal mandate for consumer protection. (Diane Cabell)
Does the copyright and license cover interfaces too? The conceptual interface to a library isn't covered. The particular representation expressed in the header is covered, as is the documentation, examples, test programs, and all the other material that goes with the library. A different implementation is free to use the same logical interface, however. Interface issues have been fought out in court several times; ask a lawyer for details.
Why doesn't the license prohibit the copyright holder from patenting the covered software? No one who distributes their code under the terms of this license could turn around and sue a user for patent infringement. (Devin Smith)
Boost's lawyers were well aware of patent provisions in licenses like the GPL and
CPL, and would have included such provisions in the Boost license if they were believed to be legally useful.
Why doesn't the copyright message say "All rights reserved"? Devin Smith says "I don't think it belongs in the copyright notice for anything (software, electronic documentation, etc.) that is being licensed. It belongs in books that are sold where, in fact, all rights (e.g., to reproduce the book, etc.) are being reserved in the publisher or author. I think it shouldn't be in the BSD license."
Do I have to copyright/license trivial files? Even a test file that just contains an empty main() should have a copyright. Files without copyrights make corporate lawyers nervous, and that's a barrier to adoption. The more of Boost is uniformly copyrighted and licensed, the less problem people will have with mounting a Boost release CD on a corporate server.
Can I use the Boost license for my own projects outside Boost? Sure; there are no restrictions on the use of the license itself.
Is the Boost license "Open Source"? Yes. The Open Source Initiative certified the
Boost Software License 1.0 in early 2008.
NSA210 User’s Guide
567
Appendix E Open Source Licences
TRANSITION
To ease the transition of the code base towards the new common license, several people decided to give a blanket permission for all their contributions to use the new license. This hopefully helps maintainers to switch to the new license once the list contains enough names without asking over and over again for each change.
Please consider adding your name to the list.
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
Dave Abrahams led the Boost effort to develop better licensing. The legal team was led by Diane Cabell, Director, Clinical Programs, Berkman Center for Internet
& Society, Harvard Law School. Devin Smith, attorney, Nixon Peabody LLP, wrote the Boost License. Eva Chan, Harvard Law School, contributed analysis of Boost issues and drafts of various legal documents. Boost members reviewed drafts of the license. Beman Dawes wrote this web page.
Revised $Date: 2009-06-07 07:14:52 -0400 (Sun, 07 Jun 2009) $
Copyright Beman Dawes, Daniel Frey, David Abrahams, 2003-2004.
Copyright Rene Rivera 2004-2005.
Distributed under the Boost Software License, Version 1.0.
This Product includes curl software under below license
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright (c) 1996 - 2009, Daniel Stenberg, <[email protected]>.
All rights reserved.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE
OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
568
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
License Issues
Curl and libcurl are released under a MIT/X derivate license. The license is very liberal and should not impose a problem for your project. This section is just a brief summary for the cases we get the most questions. (Parts of this section was much enhanced by Bjorn Reese.)
We are not lawyers and this is not legal advice. You should probably consult one if you want true and accurate legal insights without our prejudice.
6.1 I have a GPL program, can I use the libcurl library?
Yes!
Since libcurl may be distributed under the MIT/X derivate license, it can be used together with GPL in any software.
6.2 I have a closed-source program, can I use the libcurl library?
Yes! libcurl does not put any restrictions on the program that uses the library.
6.3 I have a BSD licensed program, can I use the libcurl library?
Yes! libcurl does not put any restrictions on the program that uses the library.
6.4 I have a program that uses LGPL libraries, can I use libcurl?
Yes!
The LGPL license doesn't clash with other licenses.
6.5 Can I modify curl/libcurl for my program and keep the changes secret?
Yes!
NSA210 User’s Guide
569
Appendix E Open Source Licences
The MIT/X derivate license practically allows you to do almost anything with the sources, on the condition that the copyright texts in the sources are left intact.
6.6 Can you please change the curl/libcurl license to XXXX?
No.
We have carefully picked this license after years of development and discussions and a large amount of people have contributed with source code knowing that this is the license we use. This license puts the restrictions we want on curl/libcurl and it does not spread to other programs or libraries that use it. It should be possible for everyone to use libcurl or curl in their projects, no matter what license they already have in use.
6.7 What are my obligations when using libcurl in my commercial apps?
Next to none. All you need to adhere to is the MIT-style license (stated in the COPYING file) which basically says you have to include the copyright notice in "all copies" and that you may not use the copyright holder's name when promoting your software.
You do not have to release any of your source code.
You do not have to reveal or make public any changes to the libcurl source code.
You do not have to reveal or make public that you are using libcurl within your app.
As can be seen here: http://curl.haxx.se/docs/companies.html and elsewhere, more and more companies are discovering the power of libcurl and take advantage of it even in commercial environments.
570
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
This Product includes httpd software under below license
Apache HTTP Server
Copyright 2008 The Apache Software Foundation.
This product includes software developed at
The Apache Software Foundation (http://www.apache.org/).
Portions of this software were developed at the National Center for Supercomputing Applications (NCSA) at the University of
Illinois at Urbana-Champaign.
This software contains code derived from the RSA Data Security
Inc. MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm, including various modifications by Spyglass Inc., Carnegie Mellon University, and
Bell Communications Research, Inc (Bellcore).
Regular expression support is provided by the PCRE library package, which is open source software, written by Philip Hazel, and copyright by the University of Cambridge, England. The original software is available from
ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/
Apache License
Version 2.0, January 2004
http://www.apache.org/licenses/
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE, REPRODUCTION, AND DISTRIBUTION
1. Definitions.
"License" shall mean the terms and conditions for use, reproduction,
and distribution as defined by Sections 1 through 9 of this document.
NSA210 User’s Guide
571
Appendix E Open Source Licences
"Licensor" shall mean the copyright owner or entity authorized by
the copyright owner that is granting the License.
"Legal Entity" shall mean the union of the acting entity and all
other entities that control, are controlled by, or are under common
control with that entity. For the purposes of this definition,
"control" means (i) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the
direction or management of such entity, whether by contract or
otherwise, or (ii) ownership of fifty percent (50%) or more of the
outstanding shares, or (iii) beneficial ownership of such entity.
"You" (or "Your") shall mean an individual or Legal Entity
exercising permissions granted by this License.
"Source" form shall mean the preferred form for making modifications,
including but not limited to software source code, documentation
source, and configuration files.
"Object" form shall mean any form resulting from mechanical
transformation or translation of a Source form, including but
not limited to compiled object code, generated documentation,
and conversions to other media types.
"Work" shall mean the work of authorship, whether in Source or
Object form, made available under the License, as indicated by a
copyright notice that is included in or attached to the work
572
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
(an example is provided in the Appendix below).
"Derivative Works" shall mean any work, whether in Source or Object
form, that is based on (or derived from) the Work and for which the
editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other modifications
represent, as a whole, an original work of authorship. For the purposes
of this License, Derivative Works shall not include works that remain
separable from, or merely link (or bind by name) to the interfaces of,
the Work and Derivative Works thereof.
"Contribution" shall mean any work of authorship, including
the original version of the Work and any modifications or additions
to that Work or Derivative Works thereof, that is intentionally
submitted to Licensor for inclusion in the Work by the copyright owner
or by an individual or Legal Entity authorized to submit on behalf of
the copyright owner. For the purposes of this definition, "submitted"
means any form of electronic, verbal, or written communication sent
to the Licensor or its representatives, including but not limited to
communication on electronic mailing lists, source code control systems,
and issue tracking systems that are managed by, or on behalf of, the
Licensor for the purpose of discussing and improving the Work, but
excluding communication that is conspicuously marked or otherwise
designated in writing by the copyright owner as "Not a Contribution."
"Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any individual or Legal Entity
NSA210 User’s Guide
573
Appendix E Open Source Licences
on behalf of whom a Contribution has been received by Licensor and
subsequently incorporated within the Work.
2. Grant of Copyright License. Subject to the terms and conditions of
this License, each Contributor hereby grants to You a perpetual,
worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable
copyright license to reproduce, prepare Derivative Works of,
publicly display, publicly perform, sublicense, and distribute the
Work and such Derivative Works in Source or Object form.
3. Grant of Patent License. Subject to the terms and conditions of
this License, each Contributor hereby grants to You a perpetual,
worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable
(except as stated in this section) patent license to make, have made,
use, offer to sell, sell, import, and otherwise transfer the Work,
where such license applies only to those patent claims licensable
by such Contributor that are necessarily infringed by their
Contribution(s) alone or by combination of their Contribution(s)
with the Work to which such Contribution(s) was submitted. If You
institute patent litigation against any entity (including a
cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that the Work
or a Contribution incorporated within the Work constitutes direct
or contributory patent infringement, then any patent licenses
granted to You under this License for that Work shall terminate
as of the date such litigation is filed.
574
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
4. Redistribution. You may reproduce and distribute copies of the
Work or Derivative Works thereof in any medium, with or without
modifications, and in Source or Object form, provided that You
meet the following conditions:
(a) You must give any other recipients of the Work or
Derivative Works a copy of this License; and
(b) You must cause any modified files to carry prominent notices
stating that You changed the files; and
(c) You must retain, in the Source form of any Derivative Works
that You distribute, all copyright, patent, trademark, and
attribution notices from the Source form of the Work,
excluding those notices that do not pertain to any part of
the Derivative Works; and
(d) If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file as part of its
distribution, then any Derivative Works that You distribute must
include a readable copy of the attribution notices contained
within such NOTICE file, excluding those notices that do not
pertain to any part of the Derivative Works, in at least one
of the following places: within a NOTICE text file distributed
as part of the Derivative Works; within the Source form or
NSA210 User’s Guide
575
Appendix E Open Source Licences
documentation, if provided along with the Derivative Works; or,
within a display generated by the Derivative Works, if and
wherever such third-party notices normally appear. The contents
of the NOTICE file are for informational purposes only and
do not modify the License. You may add Your own attribution
notices within Derivative Works that You distribute, alongside
or as an addendum to the NOTICE text from the Work, provided
that such additional attribution notices cannot be construed
as modifying the License.
You may add Your own copyright statement to Your modifications and
may provide additional or different license terms and conditions
for use, reproduction, or distribution of Your modifications, or
for any such Derivative Works as a whole, provided Your use,
reproduction, and distribution of the Work otherwise complies with
the conditions stated in this License.
5. Submission of Contributions. Unless You explicitly state otherwise,
any Contribution intentionally submitted for inclusion in the Work
by You to the Licensor shall be under the terms and conditions of
this License, without any additional terms or conditions.
Notwithstanding the above, nothing herein shall supersede or modify
the terms of any separate license agreement you may have executed
with Licensor regarding such Contributions.
576
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
6. Trademarks. This License does not grant permission to use the trade
names, trademarks, service marks, or product names of the Licensor,
except as required for reasonable and customary use in describing the
origin of the Work and reproducing the content of the NOTICE file.
7. Disclaimer of Warranty. Unless required by applicable law or
agreed to in writing, Licensor provides the Work (and each
Contributor provides its Contributions) on an "AS IS" BASIS,
WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or
implied, including, without limitation, any warranties or conditions
of TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY, or FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. You are solely responsible for determining the
appropriateness of using or redistributing the Work and assume any
risks associated with Your exercise of permissions under this License.
8. Limitation of Liability. In no event and under no legal theory,
whether in tort (including negligence), contract, or otherwise,
unless required by applicable law (such as deliberate and grossly
negligent acts) or agreed to in writing, shall any Contributor be
liable to You for damages, including any direct, indirect, special,
incidental, or consequential damages of any character arising as a
result of this License or out of the use or inability to use the
Work (including but not limited to damages for loss of goodwill,
work stoppage, computer failure or malfunction, or any and all
other commercial damages or losses), even if such Contributor
NSA210 User’s Guide
577
Appendix E Open Source Licences
has been advised of the possibility of such damages.
9. Accepting Warranty or Additional Liability. While redistributing
the Work or Derivative Works thereof, You may choose to offer,
and charge a fee for, acceptance of support, warranty, indemnity,
or other liability obligations and/or rights consistent with this
License. However, in accepting such obligations, You may act only
on Your own behalf and on Your sole responsibility, not on behalf
of any other Contributor, and only if You agree to indemnify,
defend, and hold each Contributor harmless for any liability
incurred by, or claims asserted against, such Contributor by reason
of your accepting any such warranty or additional liability.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
APPENDIX: How to apply the Apache License to your work.
To apply the Apache License to your work, attach the following
boilerplate notice, with the fields enclosed by brackets "[]"
replaced with your own identifying information. (Don't include
the brackets!) The text should be enclosed in the appropriate
comment syntax for the file format. We also recommend that a
file or class name and description of purpose be included on the
same "printed page" as the copyright notice for easier
identification within third-party archives.
578
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Copyright [yyyy] [name of copyright owner]
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License");
you may not use this file except in compliance with the License.
You may obtain a copy of the License at
http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software
distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS,
WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied.
See the License for the specific language governing permissions and
limitations under the License.
APACHE HTTP SERVER SUBCOMPONENTS:
The Apache HTTP Server includes a number of subcomponents with separate copyright notices and license terms. Your use of the source code for the these subcomponents is subject to the terms and conditions of the following licenses.
For the mod_mime_magic component:
/*
NSA210 User’s Guide
579
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* mod_mime_magic: MIME type lookup via file magic numbers
* Copyright (c) 1996-1997 Cisco Systems, Inc.
*
* This software was submitted by Cisco Systems to the Apache Group in July
* 1997. Future revisions and derivatives of this source code must
* acknowledge Cisco Systems as the original contributor of this module.
* All other licensing and usage conditions are those of the Apache Group.
*
* Some of this code is derived from the free version of the file command
* originally posted to comp.sources.unix. Copyright info for that program
* is included below as required.
* ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
* - Copyright (c) Ian F. Darwin, 1987. Written by Ian F. Darwin.
*
* This software is not subject to any license of the American Telephone and
* Telegraph Company or of the Regents of the University of California.
*
* Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose on any
* computer system, and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to
* the following restrictions:
*
* 1. The author is not responsible for the consequences of use of this
* software, no matter how awful, even if they arise from flaws in it.
*
* 2. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented, either by
580
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* explicit claim or by omission. Since few users ever read sources, credits
* must appear in the documentation.
*
* 3. Altered versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be
* misrepresented as being the original software. Since few users ever read
* sources, credits must appear in the documentation.
*
* 4. This notice may not be removed or altered.
* -------------------------------------------------------------------------
*
*/
For the modules\mappers\mod_imagemap.c component:
"macmartinized" polygon code copyright 1992 by Eric Haines, [email protected]
For the server\util_md5.c component:
/
*****************************************************************
*******
* NCSA HTTPd Server
* Software Development Group
* National Center for Supercomputing Applications
* University of Illinois at Urbana-Champaign
NSA210 User’s Guide
581
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* 605 E. Springfield, Champaign, IL 61820
*
* Copyright (C) 1995, Board of Trustees of the University of Illinois
*
*****************************************************************
*******
*
* md5.c: NCSA HTTPd code which uses the md5c.c RSA Code
*
* Original Code Copyright (C) 1994, Jeff Hostetler, Spyglass, Inc.
* Portions of Content-MD5 code Copyright (C) 1993, 1994 by Carnegie Mellon
* University (see Copyright below).
* Portions of Content-MD5 code Copyright (C) 1991 Bell Communications
* Research, Inc. (Bellcore) (see Copyright below).
* Portions extracted from mpack, John G. Myers - [email protected]
* Content-MD5 Code contributed by Martin Hamilton ([email protected])
*
*/
582
/* these portions extracted from mpack, John G. Myers - [email protected] */
/* (C) Copyright 1993,1994 by Carnegie Mellon University
* All Rights Reserved.
*
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software
* and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without
* fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies
* and that both that copyright notice and this permission notice
* appear in supporting documentation, and that the name of Carnegie
* Mellon University not be used in advertising or publicity
* pertaining to distribution of the software without specific,
* written prior permission. Carnegie Mellon University makes no
* representations about the suitability of this software for any
* purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied
* warranty.
*
* CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD
TO
* THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY
* AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
* FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY
DAMAGES
* WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER
IN
* AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
ARISING
* OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
* SOFTWARE.
*/
NSA210 User’s Guide
583
Appendix E Open Source Licences
/*
* Copyright (c) 1991 Bell Communications Research, Inc. (Bellcore)
*
* Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this material
* for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided
* that the above copyright notice and this permission notice
* appear in all copies, and that the name of Bellcore not be
* used in advertising or publicity pertaining to this
* material without the specific, prior written permission
* of an authorized representative of Bellcore. BELLCORE
* MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS ABOUT THE ACCURACY OR SUITABILITY
* OF THIS MATERIAL FOR ANY PURPOSE. IT IS PROVIDED "AS IS",
* WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES.
*/
For the srclib\apr\include\apr_md5.h component:
/*
* This is work is derived from material Copyright RSA Data Security, Inc.
*
* The RSA copyright statement and Licence for that original material is
* included below. This is followed by the Apache copyright statement and
* licence for the modifications made to that material.
*/
/* Copyright (C) 1991-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. Created 1991. All
584
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
rights reserved.
License to copy and use this software is granted provided that it
is identified as the "RSA Data Security, Inc. MD5 Message-Digest
Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing this software
or this function.
License is also granted to make and use derivative works provided
that such works are identified as "derived from the RSA Data
Security, Inc. MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material
mentioning or referencing the derived work.
RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either
the merchantability of this software or the suitability of this
software for any particular purpose. It is provided "as is"
without express or implied warranty of any kind.
These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this
documentation and/or software.
*/
For the srclib\apr\passwd\apr_md5.c component:
/*
* This is work is derived from material Copyright RSA Data Security, Inc.
NSA210 User’s Guide
585
Appendix E Open Source Licences
*
* The RSA copyright statement and Licence for that original material is
* included below. This is followed by the Apache copyright statement and
* licence for the modifications made to that material.
*/
/* MD5C.C - RSA Data Security, Inc., MD5 message-digest algorithm
*/
/* Copyright (C) 1991-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. Created 1991. All
rights reserved.
License to copy and use this software is granted provided that it
is identified as the "RSA Data Security, Inc. MD5 Message-Digest
Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing this software
or this function.
License is also granted to make and use derivative works provided
that such works are identified as "derived from the RSA Data
Security, Inc. MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material
mentioning or referencing the derived work.
RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either
the merchantability of this software or the suitability of this
software for any particular purpose. It is provided "as is"
586
NSA210 User’s Guide
without express or implied warranty of any kind.
Appendix E Open Source Licences
These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this
documentation and/or software.
*/
/*
* The apr_md5_encode() routine uses much code obtained from the FreeBSD 3.0
* MD5 crypt() function, which is licenced as follows:
* ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
* "THE BEER-WARE LICENSE" (Revision 42):
* <[email protected]> wrote this file. As long as you retain this notice you
* can do whatever you want with this stuff. If we meet some day, and you think
* this stuff is worth it, you can buy me a beer in return. Poul-Henning Kamp
* ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
*/
For the srclib\apr-util\crypto\apr_md4.c component:
* This is derived from material copyright RSA Data Security, Inc.
* Their notice is reproduced below in its entirety.
*
* Copyright (C) 1991-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. Created 1991. All
* rights reserved.
*
* License to copy and use this software is granted provided that it
NSA210 User’s Guide
587
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* is identified as the "RSA Data Security, Inc. MD4 Message-Digest
* Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing this software
* or this function.
*
* License is also granted to make and use derivative works provided
* that such works are identified as "derived from the RSA Data
* Security, Inc. MD4 Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material
* mentioning or referencing the derived work.
*
* RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either
* the merchantability of this software or the suitability of this
* software for any particular purpose. It is provided "as is"
* without express or implied warranty of any kind.
*
* These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this
* documentation and/or software.
*/
For the srclib\apr-util\include\apr_md4.h component:
*
* This is derived from material copyright RSA Data Security, Inc.
* Their notice is reproduced below in its entirety.
*
* Copyright (C) 1991-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. Created 1991. All
588
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* rights reserved.
*
* License to copy and use this software is granted provided that it
* is identified as the "RSA Data Security, Inc. MD4 Message-Digest
* Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing this software
* or this function.
*
* License is also granted to make and use derivative works provided
* that such works are identified as "derived from the RSA Data
* Security, Inc. MD4 Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material
* mentioning or referencing the derived work.
*
* RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either
* the merchantability of this software or the suitability of this
* software for any particular purpose. It is provided "as is"
* without express or implied warranty of any kind.
*
* These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this
* documentation and/or software.
*/
For the srclib\apr-util\test\testmd4.c component:
*
NSA210 User’s Guide
589
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* This is derived from material copyright RSA Data Security, Inc.
* Their notice is reproduced below in its entirety.
*
* Copyright (C) 1990-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. Created 1990. All
* rights reserved.
*
* RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either
* the merchantability of this software or the suitability of this
* software for any particular purpose. It is provided "as is"
* without express or implied warranty of any kind.
*
* These notices must be retained in any copies of any part of this
* documentation and/or software.
*/
For the srclib\apr-util\xml\expat\conftools\install-sh component:
#
# install - install a program, script, or datafile
# This comes from X11R5 (mit/util/scripts/install.sh).
#
# Copyright 1991 by the Massachusetts Institute of Technology
#
# Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software and its
# documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided that
590
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
# the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that
# copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting
# documentation, and that the name of M.I.T. not be used in advertising or
# publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific,
# written prior permission. M.I.T. makes no representations about the
# suitability of this software for any purpose. It is provided "as is"
# without express or implied warranty.
#
For the srclib\pcre\install-sh component:
#
# Copyright 1991 by the Massachusetts Institute of Technology
#
# Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this software and its
# documentation for any purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided that
# the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that
# copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting
# documentation, and that the name of M.I.T. not be used in advertising or
# publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific,
# written prior permission. M.I.T. makes no representations about the
# suitability of this software for any purpose. It is provided "as is"
# without express or implied warranty.
For the pcre component:
NSA210 User’s Guide
591
Appendix E Open Source Licences
PCRE LICENCE
------------
PCRE is a library of functions to support regular expressions whose syntax and semantics are as close as possible to those of the Perl 5 language.
Release 5 of PCRE is distributed under the terms of the "BSD" licence, as specified below. The documentation for PCRE, supplied in the "doc" directory, is distributed under the same terms as the software itself.
Written by: Philip Hazel <[email protected]>
University of Cambridge Computing Service,
Cambridge, England. Phone: +44 1223 334714.
Copyright (c) 1997-2004 University of Cambridge
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
592
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of the University of Cambridge nor the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS"
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF
USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND
ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF
THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
End PCRE LICENCE
For the test\zb.c component:
/* ZeusBench V1.01
===============
This program is Copyright (C) Zeus Technology Limited 1996.
This program may be used and copied freely providing this copyright notice
NSA210 User’s Guide
593
Appendix E Open Source Licences is not removed.
This software is provided "as is" and any express or implied waranties, including but not limited to, the implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose are disclaimed. In no event shall
Zeus Technology Ltd. be liable for any direct, indirect, incidental, special, exemplary, or consequential damaged (including, but not limited to, procurement of substitute good or services; loss of use, data, or profits; or business interruption) however caused and on theory of liability. Whether in contract, strict liability or tort (including negligence or otherwise) arising in any way out of the use of this software, even if advised of the possibility of such damage.
Written by Adam Twiss ([email protected]). March 1996
Thanks to the following people for their input:
Mike Belshe ([email protected])
Michael Campanella ([email protected])
*/
For the expat xml parser component:
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Center Ltd
and Clark Cooper
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the
594
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
"Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
==================================================
==================
This Product includes libtecla software under below license
Copyright (c) 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 by Martin C. Shepherd.
All rights reserved.
NSA210 User’s Guide
595
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the
"Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above copyright notice(s) and this permission notice appear in all copies of the Software and that both the above copyright notice(s) and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR HOLDERS INCLUDED IN THIS NOTICE BE LIABLE FOR
ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY
DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS
ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE
OF THIS SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a copyright holder shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this
Software without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
This Product includes libtorrent-rasterbar software under below license
Copyright (c) 2003 - 2007, Arvid Norberg
All rights reserved.
596
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of Rasterbar Software nor the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived
from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE
OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
This Product includes libupnp software under below license
Copyright (c) 2000-2003 Intel Corporation
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
NSA210 User’s Guide
597
Appendix E Open Source Licences modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither name of Intel Corporation nor the names of its contributors
may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS
``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL INTEL OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
This Product includes libxml2 software under below license
598
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Except where otherwise noted in the source code (e.g. the files hash.c, list.c and the trio files, which are covered by a similar licence but with different Copyright notices) all the files are:
Copyright (C) 1998-2003 Daniel Veillard. All Rights Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE DANIEL VEILLARD BE LIABLE FOR
ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION
WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of Daniel Veillard shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization from him.
This Product includes ntp software under below license
Copyright (c) University of Delaware 1992-2010
NSA210 User’s Guide
599
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice appears in all copies and that both the copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation, and that the name University of Delaware not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific, written prior permission. The
University of Delaware makes no representations about the suitability this software for any purpose. It is provided "as is" without express or implied warranty.
The following individuals contributed in part to the Network Time Protocol
Distribution Version 4 and are acknowledged as authors of this work.
1.Mark Andrews <[email protected]> Leitch atomic clock controller
2.Bernd Altmeier <[email protected]> hopf Elektronik serial line and PCI-bus devices
3.Viraj Bais <[email protected]> and Clayton Kirkwood
<[email protected]> port to WindowsNT 3.5
4.Michael Barone <michael,[email protected]> GPSVME fixes
5.Jean-Francois Boudreault <[email protected]>IPv6 support
6.Karl Berry <[email protected]> syslog to file option
7.Greg Brackley <[email protected]> Major rework of WINNT port.
Clean up recvbuf and iosignal code into separate modules.
8.Marc Brett <[email protected]> Magnavox GPS clock driver
9.Piete Brooks <[email protected]> MSF clock driver, Trimble PARSE support
10.Reg Clemens <[email protected]> Oncore driver (Current maintainer)
11.Steve Clift <[email protected]> OMEGA clock driver
12.Casey Crellin <[email protected]> vxWorks (Tornado) port and help with target configuration
13.Sven Dietrich <[email protected]> Palisade reference clock driver,
NT adj. residuals, integrated Greg's Winnt port.
600
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
14.John A. Dundas III <[email protected]> Apple A/UX port
15.Torsten Duwe <[email protected]> Linux port
16.Dennis Ferguson <[email protected]> foundation code for NTP Version 2 as specified in RFC-1119
17.John Hay <[email protected]> IPv6 support and testing
18.Dave Hart <[email protected]> General maintenance, Windows port interpolation rewrite.
19.Claas Hilbrecht <[email protected]> NeoClock4X clock driver
20.Glenn Hollinger <[email protected]> GOES clock driver
21.Mike Iglesias <[email protected]> DEC Alpha port
22.Jim Jagielski <[email protected]> A/UX port
23.Jeff Johnson <[email protected]> massive prototyping overhaul
24.Hans Lambermont <[email protected]> or
<[email protected]> ntpsweep
25.Poul-Henning Kamp <[email protected]> Oncore driver (Original author)
26.Frank Kardel <kardel (at) ntp (dot) org> PARSE <GENERIC> driver (>14 reference clocks), STREAMS modules for PARSE, support scripts, syslog cleanup, dynamic interface handling
27.William L. Jones <[email protected]> RS/6000 AIX modifications, HPUX modifications
28.Dave Katz <[email protected]> RS/6000 AIX port
29.Craig Leres <[email protected]> 4.4BSD port, ppsclock, Magnavox GPS clock driver
30.George Lindholm <[email protected]> SunOS 5.1 port
31.Louis A. Mamakos <[email protected]> MD5-based authentication
32.Lars H. Mathiesen <[email protected]> adaptation of foundation code for
Version 3 as specified in RFC-1305
33.Danny Mayer <[email protected]>Network I/O, Windows Port, Code
Maintenance
NSA210 User’s Guide
601
Appendix E Open Source Licences
34.David L. Mills <[email protected]> Version 4 foundation: clock discipline, authentication, precision kernel; clock drivers: Spectracom, Austron, Arbiter,
Heath, ATOM, ACTS, KSI/Odetics; audio clock drivers: CHU, WWV/H, IRIG
35.Wolfgang Moeller <[email protected]> VMS port
36.Jeffrey Mogul <[email protected]> ntptrace utility
37.Tom Moore <[email protected]> i386 svr4 port
38.Kamal A Mostafa <[email protected]> SCO OpenServer port
39.Derek Mulcahy <[email protected]> and Damon Hart-Davis
<[email protected]> ARCRON MSF clock driver
40.Rob Neal <[email protected]> Bancomm refclock and config/parse code maintenance
41.Rainer Pruy <[email protected]> monitoring/trap scripts, statistics file handling
42.Dirce Richards <[email protected]> Digital UNIX V4.0 port
43.Wilfredo Sánchez <[email protected]> added support for NetInfo
44.Nick Sayer <[email protected]> SunOS streams modules
45.Jack Sasportas <[email protected]> Saved a Lot of space on the stuff in the html/pic/ subdirectory
46.Ray Schnitzler <[email protected]> Unixware1 port
47.Michael Shields <[email protected]> USNO clock driver
48.Jeff Steinman <[email protected]> Datum PTS clock driver
49.Harlan Stenn <[email protected]> GNU automake/autoconfigure makeover, various other bits (see the ChangeLog)
50.Kenneth Stone <[email protected]> HP-UX port
51.Ajit Thyagarajan <[email protected]>IP multicast/anycast support
52.Tomoaki TSURUOKA <[email protected]>TRAK clock driver
53.Paul A Vixie <[email protected]> TrueTime GPS driver, generic TrueTime clock driver
602
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
54.Ulrich Windl <[email protected]> corrected and validated
HTML documents according to the HTML DTD
This Product includes pam software under below license
Unless otherwise *explicitly* stated the following text describes the licensed conditions under which the contents of this Linux-PAM release may be distributed:
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms of Linux-PAM, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain any existing copyright notice, and this entire permission notice in its entirety, including the disclaimer of warranties.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce all prior and current copyright notices, this list of conditions, and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. The name of any author may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without their specific prior written permission.
ALTERNATIVELY, this product may be distributed under the terms of the GNU
General Public License, in which case the provisions of the GNU GPL are required
INSTEAD OF the above restrictions. (This clause is necessary due to a potential conflict between the GNU GPL and the restrictions contained in a BSD-style copyright.)
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED.IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR(S) BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS
NSA210 User’s Guide
603
Appendix E Open Source Licences
OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
This Product includes pure-ftpd software under below license
Pure-FTPd is covered by the following license :
/*
* Copyright (c) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
* Frank Denis <[email protected]> with the help of all Pure-FTPd contributors.
*
* Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any
* purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
* copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
*
* THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL
WARRANTIES
* WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
* MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE
FOR
* ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY
DAMAGES
* WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER
IN AN
* ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
OUT OF
* OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
*/
604
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
This Product includes setsystz software under below license
/* setsystz: set the Linux kernel's idea of the time zone */
/* Copyright (c) 2007 David A. Madore, Public Domain */
This Product includes sqlite software under below license
SQLite Copyright
All of the deliverable code in SQLite has been dedicated to the public domain by the authors. All code authors, and representatives of the companies they work for, have signed affidavits dedicating their contributions to the public domain and originals of those signed affidavits are stored in a firesafe at the main offices of
Hwaci. Anyone is free to copy, modify, publish, use, compile, sell, or distribute the original SQLite code, either in source code form or as a compiled binary, for any purpose, commercial or non-commercial, and by any means.
The previous paragraph applies to the deliverable code in SQLite - those parts of the SQLite library that you actually bundle and ship with a larger application.
Portions of the documentation and some code used as part of the build process might fall under other licenses. The details here are unclear. We do not worry about the licensing of the documentation and build code so much because none of these things are part of the core deliverable SQLite library.
All of the deliverable code in SQLite has been written from scratch. No code has been taken from other projects or from the open internet. Every line of code can be traced back to its original author, and all of those authors have public domain dedications on file. So the SQLite code base is clean and is uncontaminated with licensed code from other projects.
Obtaining An Explicit License To Use SQLite
Even though SQLite is in the public domain and does not require a license, some users want to obtain a license anyway. Some reasons for obtaining a license include:
•You are using SQLite in a jurisdiction that does not recognize the public domain.
•You are using SQLite in a jurisdiction that does not recognize the right of an author to dedicate their work to the public domain.
NSA210 User’s Guide
605
Appendix E Open Source Licences
•You want to hold a tangible legal document as evidence that you have the legal right to use and distribute SQLite.
•Your legal department tells you that you have to purchase a license.
If you feel like you really have to purchase a license for SQLite, Hwaci, the company that employs the architect and principal developers of SQLite, will sell you one.
Contributed Code
In order to keep SQLite completely free and unencumbered by copyright, all new contributors to the SQLite code base are asked to dedicate their contributions to the public domain. If you want to send a patch or enhancement for possible inclusion in the SQLite source tree, please accompany the patch with the following statement:
The author or authors of this code dedicate any and all copyright interest in this code to the public domain. We make this dedication for the benefit of the public at large and to the detriment of our heirs and successors. We intend this dedication to be an overt act of relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to this code under copyright law.
We are not able to accept patches or changes to SQLite that are not accompanied by a statement such as the above. In addition, if you make changes or enhancements as an employee, then a simple statement such as the above is insufficient. You must also send by surface mail a copyright release signed by a company officer. A signed original of the copyright release should be mailed to:
Hwaci
6200 Maple Cove Lane
Charlotte, NC 28269
USA
A template copyright release is available in PDF or HTML. You can use this release to make future changes
606
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Copyright Release for
Contributions To SQLite
SQLite is software that implements an embeddable SQL database engine. SQLite is available for free download from http://www.sqlite.org/. The principal author and maintainer of SQLite has disclaimed all copyright interest in his contributions to SQLite and thus released his contributions into the public domain. In order to keep the SQLite software unencumbered by copyright claims, the principal author asks others who may from time to time contribute changes and enhancements to likewise disclaim their own individual copyright interest.
Because the SQLite software found at http://www.sqlite.org/ is in the public domain, anyone is free to download the SQLite software from that website, make changes to the software, use, distribute, or sell the modified software, under either the original name or under some new name, without any need to obtain permission, pay royalties, acknowledge the original source of the software, or in any other way compensate, identify, or notify the original authors. Nobody is in any way compelled to contribute their SQLite changes and enhancements back to the SQLite website. This document concerns only changes and enhancements to
SQLite that are intentionally and deliberately contributed back to the SQLite website.
For the purposes of this document, "SQLite software" shall mean any computer source code, documentation, makefiles, test scripts, or other information that is published on the SQLite website, http://www.sqlite.org/. Precompiled binaries are excluded from the definition of "SQLite software" in this document because the process of compiling the software may introduce information from outside sources which is not properly a part of SQLite.
The header comments on the SQLite source files exhort the reader to share freely and to never take more than one gives. In the spirit of that exhortation I make the following declarations:
1.I dedicate to the public domain any and all copyright interest in the SQLite software that was publicly available on the SQLite website (http://www.sqlite.org/
) prior to the date of the signature below and any changes or enhancements to the
SQLite software that I may cause to be published on that website in the future. I make this dedication for the benefit of the public at large and to the detriment of my heirs and successors. I intend this dedication to be an overt act of relinquishment in perpetuity of all present and future rights to the SQLite software under copyright law.
2.To the best of my knowledge and belief, the changes and enhancements that I have contributed to SQLite are either originally written by me or are derived from prior works which I have verified are also in the public domain and are not subject to claims of copyright by other parties.
NSA210 User’s Guide
607
Appendix E Open Source Licences
3.To the best of my knowledge and belief, no individual, business, organization, government, or other entity has any copyright interest in the SQLite software as it existed on the SQLite website as of the date on the signature line below.
4.I agree never to publish any additional information to the SQLite website (by
CVS, email, scp, FTP, or any other means) unless that information is an original work of authorship by me or is derived from prior published versions of SQLite. I agree never to copy and paste code into the SQLite code base from other sources.
I agree never to publish on the SQLite website any information that would violate a law or breach a contract.
Signature:
Date:
Name (printed):
This Product includes tz32 software under below license
=== asctime.c==========
** This file is in the public domain, so clarified as of
** 1996-06-05 by Arthur David Olson.
=== asctime.c==========
=== date.c ==========
/*
* Copyright (c) 1985, 1987, 1988 The Regents of the University of California.
* All rights reserved.
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms are permitted
* provided that the above copyright notice and this paragraph are
* duplicated in all such forms and that any documentation,
608
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
* advertising materials, and other materials related to such
* distribution and use acknowledge that the software was developed
* by the University of California, Berkeley. The name of the
* University may not be used to endorse or promote products derived
* from this software without specific prior written permission.
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE IMPLIED
* WARRANTIES OF MERCHANT[A]BILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE.
*/
=== difftime.c ==========
/*
** This file is in the public domain, so clarified as of
** 1996-06-05 by Arthur David Olson.
*/
=============
====== localtime.c =====
/*
** This file is in the public domain, so clarified as of
** 1996-06-05 by Arthur David Olson.
*/
==================
====== logwtmp.c =====
/*
* Copyright (c) 1988 The Regents of the University of California.
* All rights reserved.
NSA210 User’s Guide
609
Appendix E Open Source Licences
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms are permitted
* provided that the above copyright notice and this paragraph are
* duplicated in all such forms and that any documentation,
* advertising materials, and other materials related to such
* distribution and use acknowledge that the software was developed
* by the University of California, Berkeley. The name of the
* University may not be used to endorse or promote products derived
* from this software without specific prior written permission.
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED ``AS IS'' AND WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE IMPLIED
* WARRANTIES OF MERCHANT[A]BILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE.
*/
===================
====== private.h =====
** This file is in the public domain, so clarified as of
** 1996-06-05 by Arthur David Olson.
====== private.h =====
======tzfile.h =====
** This file is in the public domain, so clarified as of
** 1996-06-05 by Arthur David Olson.
====== tzfile.h =====
This Product includes crypto++ software under below license
610
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
License
The License of Crypto++ is somewhat unusual amongst open source projects. A distinction is made between the library as a compilation (i.e., collection), which is copyrighted by Wei Dai, and the individual files in it, which are public domain (with the exception of mars.cpp which is subject to its own license, included in that file).
The library is copyrighted as a compilation in order to place certain disclaimers
(regarding warranty, export, and patents) in the license and to keep the attributions and public domain declarations intact when Crypto++ is distributed in source code form. The fact that individual files are public domain means that legally you can place code segments, entire files, or small sets of files (up to the limit set by fair use) into your own project and do anything you want with them without worrying about the copyright.
Because one purpose of the project is to act as a repository of public domain (not copyrighted) cryptographic source code, the code in Crypto++ was either written specifically for this project by its contributors and placed in the public domain, or derived from other sources that are public domain (again with the exception of mars.cpp).
Compilation Copyright (c) 1995-2009 by Wei Dai. All rights reserved.
This copyright applies only to this software distribution package as a compilation, and does not imply a copyright on any particular file in the package.
The following files are copyrighted by their respective original authors, and their use is subject to additional licenses included in these files.
mars.cpp - Copyright 1998 Brian Gladman.
All other files in this compilation are placed in the public domain by
Wei Dai and other contributors.
I would like to thank the following authors for placing their works into
NSA210 User’s Guide
611
Appendix E Open Source Licences the public domain:
Joan Daemen - 3way.cpp
Leonard Janke - cast.cpp, seal.cpp
Steve Reid - cast.cpp
Phil Karn - des.cpp
Andrew M. Kuchling - md2.cpp, md4.cpp
Colin Plumb - md5.cpp
Seal Woods - rc6.cpp
Chris Morgan - rijndael.cpp
Paulo Baretto - rijndael.cpp, skipjack.cpp, square.cpp
Richard De Moliner - safer.cpp
Matthew Skala - twofish.cpp
Kevin Springle - camellia.cpp, shacal2.cpp, ttmac.cpp, whrlpool.cpp, ripemd.cpp
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this compilation for any purpose, including commercial applications, is hereby granted without fee, subject to the following restrictions:
1. Any copy or modification of this compilation in any form, except in object code form as part of an application software, must include the above copyright notice and this license.
2. Users of this software agree that any modification or extension they provide to Wei Dai will be considered public domain and not
612
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences copyrighted unless it includes an explicit copyright notice.
3. Wei Dai makes no warranty or representation that the operation of the software in this compilation will be error-free, and Wei Dai is under no obligation to provide any services, by way of maintenance, update, or otherwise. THE SOFTWARE AND
ANY DOCUMENTATION ARE PROVIDED "AS IS" WITHOUT EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
WARRANTY INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT
WILL WEI DAI OR ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR BE LIABLE FOR DIRECT,
INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
4. Users will not use Wei Dai or any other contributor's name in any publicity or advertising, without prior written consent in each case.
5. Export of this software from the United States may require a specific license from the United States Government. It is the responsibility of any person or organization contemplating export to obtain such a license before exporting.
6. Certain parts of this software may be protected by patents. It is the users' responsibility to obtain the appropriate licenses before using those parts.
If this compilation is used in object code form in an application software, acknowledgement of the author is not required but would be appreciated. The contribution of any useful modifications or extensions to Wei Dai is not required but would also be appreciated.
NSA210 User’s Guide
613
Appendix E Open Source Licences
This Product includes wxWidgets software under below license
Licence
Background
wxWidgets is currently licensed under the "wxWindows Licence" pending approval of the "wxWidgets Licence" which will be identical apart from the name.
The wxWindows Licence is essentially the L-GPL (Library General Public Licence), with an exception stating that derived works in binary form may be distributed on the user's own terms. This is a solution that satisfies those who wish to produce
GPL'ed software using wxWidgets, and also those producing proprietary software.
Participants in the discussion that led to this decision include the folk from
Abisource, Robert Roebling, Julian Smart, Markus Fleck, Karsten Ballueder, and some advice from Richard Stallman. Richard has confirmed that the new licence is compatible with GPL'ed applications. However, there are no significant restrictions on proprietary applications.
The wxWindows Licence has been approved by the Open Source Initiative, and you can find the licence on their site here.
In August 2005, an ambiguity in Clause 2 was removed (replaced "the user's" with
"your") and the version bumped to 3.1.
The wxWindows Library Licence
Copyright (c) 1998 Julian Smart, Robert Roebling [, ...]
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this licence document, but changing it is not allowed.
WXWINDOWS LIBRARY LICENCE
614
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public Licence as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the Licence, or (at
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library
General Public Licence for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public Licence along with this software, usually in a file named COPYING.LIB. If not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA.
EXCEPTION NOTICE
1. As a special exception, the copyright holders of this library give permission for additional uses of the text contained in this release of the library as licenced under the wxWindows Library Licence, applying either version 3 of the Licence, or (at your option) any later version of the Licence as published by the copyright holders of version 3 of the
Licence document.
2. The exception is that you may use, copy, link, modify and distribute under the user's own terms, binary object code versions of works based on the Library.
3. If you copy code from files distributed under the terms of the GNU
General Public Licence or the GNU Library General Public Licence into a copy of this library, as this licence permits, the exception does not apply to the code that you add in this way. To avoid misleading anyone as to the status of such modified files, you must delete this exception notice from such code and/or adjust the licensing conditions notice
NSA210 User’s Guide
615
Appendix E Open Source Licences accordingly.
4. If you write modifications of your own for this library, it is your choice whether to permit this exception to apply to your modifications.
If you do not wish that, you must delete the exception notice from such code and/or adjust the licensing conditions notice accordingly.
This Product includes squeezeboxserver software under below license
SLIM DEVICES LICENSE NOTICE
Please be aware that not all software distributed by Slim Devices is licensed under the GPL. If you wish to redistribute any of our software, please be sure to first read the GPL, and then make sure that you are only distributing materials which we've explicity licensed for such use. Feel free to contact us if you have any questions, or would like permission to distribute our other non-GPL programs. Also, be aware that standard copyright rules apply in any case where no particular license is given.
Each of the software products we ship are licensed as follows:
- All of Squeezebox Server's perl code is licensed for redistribution or inclusion in other software per version 2 of the GPL license, included below for your convenience.
- SoftSqueeze is (c) Richard Titmuss and is licensed under GPL.
616
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
- The CODE2000 TrueType Font is (c) James Kass and is Shareware.
See Graphics/CODE2000.HTM for more information.
- Certain integral components of Slim Server, such as CPAN modules, are (c) of their respective authors, and are included in Squeezebox Server per their respective licenses.
- Certain ancillary programs included in the Squeezebox Server distribution on our web site are licensed to us only for direct distribution to end-users. These include the Windows installer and Activestate binaries.
- Squeezebox firmare may not be redistributed under any circumstances. It is (c) Slim Devices, and additonally contains code which is (c) Ubicom. Ubicom's code is licenced to us only for direct distribution in binary form. You may use the firmware only on hardware manufactured by Slim Devices.
- SLIMP3 firmware is (c) Slim Devices, and source is available under the Slim Devices Public Source Licence, for certain educational and hobbyist uses. Please read the license carefully.
- Slim Devices logos, graphics, animations, and documentation are
(c) Slim Devices and are not licensed for redistribution. When in doubt look for a GPL notice at the top of the file, or ask us for
NSA210 User’s Guide
617
Appendix E Open Source Licences written permission to redistribute, which we will grant for any reasonable purpose.
- Squeezebox2 firmware additionally contains the following code:
- Kiss FFT, Copyright (c) 2003-2004, Mark Borgerding, licensed under
a modified BSD license (reproduced below).
- 16:16 fixed math routines, Copyright (c) 2001 Beartronics, licensed
under the "Artistic License"
(http://www.opensource.org/licenses/artistic-license.html). Copies of
modified source files can be found at
http://www.slimdevices.com/opensource/fixed_math.tar.gz.
- The following applies to Squeezebox2 distribution:
This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of
Microsoft Corporation. Use or distribution of such technology outside of this product is prohibited without a license from Microsoft or authorized Microsoft subsidiary.
#------------------------------------------------------------------
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2, June 1991
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
618
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by the GNU Library General Public License instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
NSA210 User’s Guide
619
Appendix E Open Source Licences you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
(2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software.
Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original authors' reputations.
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow.
620
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed under the terms of this General Public License. The "Program", below, refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program" means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term "modification".) Each licensee is addressed as "you".
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
NSA210 User’s Guide
621
Appendix E Open Source Licences and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License along with the Program.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
parties under the terms of this License.
c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
622
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the Program.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this License.
NSA210 User’s Guide
623
Appendix E Open Source Licences
3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it, under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
customarily used for software interchange; or,
c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
received the program in object code or executable form with such
an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
624
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the executable.
If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place counts as distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance.
5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
NSA210 User’s Guide
625
Appendix E Open Source Licences modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Program or works based on it.
6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this License.
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
626
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system, which is implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this License.
8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the Program under this License may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
NSA210 User’s Guide
627
Appendix E Open Source Licences countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
Foundation.
10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
NO WARRANTY
628
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO
WARRANTY
FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT
WHEN
OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER
PARTIES
PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESSED
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE
RISK AS
TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD
THE
PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY
SERVICING,
REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN
WRITING
WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/
OR
REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR
DAMAGES,
INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
ARISING
OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED
TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES
SUSTAINED BY
YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY
OTHER
NSA210 User’s Guide
629
Appendix E Open Source Licences
PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF
THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
#------------------------------------------------------------------
630
Kiss FFT used under the following license:
Copyright (c) 2003-2004, Mark Borgerding
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the author nor the names of any contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED.
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE
OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
#------------------------------------------------------------------
The Code2000 font is copyright James Kass, distributed by permission of the author.
Details about Code2000 may be found in Graphics/CODE2000.HTM
This Product includes php software under below license
• PHP 4 and PHP 5 are distributed under the PHP License v3.01, copyright (c) the
PHP Group.
• This is an Open Source license, certified by the Open Source Initiative.
• The PHP license is a BSD-style license which does not have the "copyleft" restrictions associated with GPL.
• Some files have been contributed under other (compatible) licenses and carry additional requirements and copyright information.
This is indicated in the license + copyright comment block at the top of the source file.
• Practical Guidelines:
• Distributing PHP
• Contributing to PHP
--------------------------------------------------------------------
The PHP License, version 3.01
Copyright (c) 1999 - 2009 The PHP Group. All rights reserved.
--------------------------------------------------------------------
NSA210 User’s Guide
631
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, is permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
distribution.
3. The name "PHP" must not be used to endorse or promote products
derived from this software without prior written permission. For
written permission, please contact [email protected].
4. Products derived from this software may not be called "PHP", nor
may "PHP" appear in their name, without prior written permission
from [email protected]. You may indicate that your software works in
conjunction with PHP by saying "Foo for PHP" instead of calling
it "PHP Foo" or "phpfoo"
5. The PHP Group may publish revised and/or new versions of the
license from time to time. Each version will be given a
distinguishing version number.
632
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Once covered code has been published under a particular version
of the license, you may always continue to use it under the terms
of that version. You may also choose to use such covered code
under the terms of any subsequent version of the license
published by the PHP Group. No one other than the PHP Group has
the right to modify the terms applicable to covered code created
under this License.
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
acknowledgment:
"This product includes PHP software, freely available from
<http://www.php.net/software/>".
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE PHP DEVELOPMENT TEAM ``AS IS'' AND
ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE PHP
DEVELOPMENT TEAM OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,
STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED
OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
NSA210 User’s Guide
633
Appendix E Open Source Licences
--------------------------------------------------------------------
This software consists of voluntary contributions made by many individuals on behalf of the PHP Group.
The PHP Group can be contacted via Email at [email protected].
For more information on the PHP Group and the PHP project, please see <http://www.php.net>.
PHP includes the Zend Engine, freely available at
<http://www.zend.com>.
This Product includes AutoXS-Header, Class-C3-XS, Class-XSAccessor, Class-
XSAccessor-Array, Compress-Raw-Zlib, Digest-SHA1, EV, ExtUtils-Cbuilder, GD,
HTML-Parser, JSON-XS, Module-Build, Sub-Name, Template-Toolkit and XML-
Parser software under the same terms as Perl ‘s license
Perl5 is Copyright (C) 1993-2005, by Larry Wall and others.
It is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of either: a) the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 1, or (at your option) any later version, or b) the "Artistic License".
For those of you that choose to use the GNU General Public License, my interpretation of the GNU General Public License is that no Perl script falls under the terms of the GPL unless you explicitly put said script under the terms of the
GPL yourself.
634
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
Furthermore, any object code linked with perl does not automatically fall under the terms of the GPL, provided such object code only adds definitions of subroutines and variables, and does not otherwise impair the resulting interpreter from executing any standard Perl script. I consider linking in C subroutines in this manner to be the moral equivalent of defining subroutines in the Perl language itself. You may sell such an object file as proprietary provided that you provide or offer to provide the Perl source, as specified by the GNU General Public License.
(This is merely an alternate way of specifying input to the program.) You may also sell a binary produced by the dumping of a running Perl script that belongs to you, provided that you provide or offer to provide the Perl source as specified by the
GPL. (The fact that a Perl interpreter and your code are in the same binary file is, in this case, a form of mere aggregation.)
This is my interpretation of the GPL. If you still have concerns or difficulties understanding my intent, feel free to contact me. Of course, the Artistic License spells all this out for your protection, so you may prefer to use that.
-- Larry Wall
This Product includes gd software under below license
Portions copyright 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
2002 by Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory. Funded under Grant
P41-RR02188 by the National Institutes of Health.
Portions copyright 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 by
Boutell.Com, Inc.
Portions relating to GD2 format copyright 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
Philip Warner.
Portions relating to PNG copyright 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Greg
Roelofs.
NSA210 User’s Guide
635
Appendix E Open Source Licences
636
Portions relating to gdttf.c copyright 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 John
Ellson ([email protected]).
Portions relating to gdft.c copyright 2001, 2002 John Ellson
Portions copyright 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007
Pierre-Alain Joye ([email protected]).
Portions relating to JPEG and to color quantization copyright 2000,
2001, 2002, Doug Becker and copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997,
1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, Thomas G. Lane. This software is
based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group. See the
file README-JPEG.TXT for more information.
Portions relating to WBMP copyright 2000, 2001, 2002 Maurice
Szmurlo and Johan Van den Brande.
Permission has been granted to copy, distribute and modify gd in
any context without fee, including a commercial application,
provided that this notice is present in user-accessible supporting
documentation.
This does not affect your ownership of the derived work itself, and
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix E Open Source Licences
the intent is to assure proper credit for the authors of gd, not to
interfere with your productive use of gd. If you have questions,
ask. "Derived works" includes all programs that utilize the
library. Credit must be given in user-accessible documentation.
This software is provided "AS IS." The copyright holders disclaim
all warranties, either express or implied, including but not
limited to implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a
particular purpose, with respect to this code and accompanying
documentation.
Although their code does not appear in gd, the authors wish to thank
David Koblas, David Rowley, and Hutchison Avenue Software Corporation
for their prior contributions.
Notice
Information herein is subject to change without notice. Companies, names, and data used in examples herein are fictitious unless otherwise noted. No part may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, for any purpose, except the express written permission of ZyXEL
Communications Corporation.
(Insert the license term as below)
NSA210 User’s Guide
637
Appendix E Open Source Licences
638
NSA210 User’s Guide
A
P P E N D I X
F
Legal Information
Copyright
Copyright © 2010 by ZyXEL Communications Corporation.
The contents of this publication may not be reproduced in any part or as a whole, transcribed, stored in a retrieval system, translated into any language, or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, magnetic, optical, chemical, photocopying, manual, or otherwise, without the prior written permission of ZyXEL Communications Corporation.
Published by ZyXEL Communications Corporation. All rights reserved.
Disclaimers
ZyXEL does not assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any products, or software described herein. Neither does it convey any license under its patent rights nor the patent rights of others. ZyXEL further reserves the right to make changes in any products described herein without notice. This publication is subject to change without notice.
Do not use the NSA for illegal purposes. Illegal downloading or sharing of files can result in severe civil and criminal penalties. You are subject to the restrictions of copyright laws and any other applicable laws and will bear the consequences of any infringements thereof. ZyXEL bears NO responsibility or liability for your use of the download service feature.
Make sure all data and programs on the NSA are also stored elsewhere. ZyXEL is not responsible for any loss of or damage to any data, programs, or storage media resulting from the use, misuse, or disuse of this or any other ZyXEL product.
Certifications
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Interference Statement
The device complies with Part 15 of FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
NSA210 User’s Guide
639
Appendix F Legal Information
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
• This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operations.
This device has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This device generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy, and if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation.
Notices
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du
Canada.
Viewing Certifications
1
Go to http://www.zyxel.com
.
2
Select your product on the ZyXEL home page to go to that product's page.
3
Select the certification you wish to view from this page.
ZyXEL warrants to the original end user (purchaser) that this product is free from any defects in materials or workmanship for a period of up to two years from the date of purchase. During the warranty period, and upon proof of purchase, should the product have indications of failure due to faulty workmanship and/or materials, ZyXEL will, at its discretion, repair or replace the defective products or components without charge for either parts or labor, and to whatever extent it shall deem necessary to restore the product or components to proper operating condition. Any replacement will consist of a new or re-manufactured functionally equivalent product of equal or higher value, and will be solely at the discretion of
ZyXEL. This warranty shall not apply if the product has been modified, misused, tampered with, damaged by an act of God, or subjected to abnormal working conditions.
Note
Repair or replacement, as provided under this warranty, is the exclusive remedy of the purchaser. This warranty is in lieu of all other warranties, express or implied,
640
NSA210 User’s Guide
Appendix F Legal Information including any implied warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular use or purpose. ZyXEL shall in no event be held liable for indirect or consequential damages of any kind to the purchaser.
To obtain the services of this warranty, contact your vendor. You may also refer to the warranty policy for the region in which you bought the device at http:// www.zyxel.com/web/support_warranty_info.php.
Registration
Register your product online to receive e-mail notices of firmware upgrades and information at www.zyxel.com
for global products, or at www.us.zyxel.com
for
North American products.
NSA210 User’s Guide
641
Appendix F Legal Information
642
NSA210 User’s Guide
1. passive mode transfer
Numerics
3-D photo wall
A
access rights
Flickr
shares
YouTube
activation download service
Flickr/YouTube
FTP
FTP Uploadr
recycle bins
web publishing
ANONYMOUS FTP
anonymous FTP access
application zone
applications
auto upload
Flickr/YouTube
FTP Uploadr
broadcatching
adding channels
channel guides
RSS
COPY/SYNC button
configuration
example
synchronization
download service
activation
adding a task
BitTorrent
configuration
link capture browser plugin
NSA210 User’s Guide notifications
preferences
protection
status
URL
FTP
activation
anonymous access
passive mode transfer
media server
configuration
iTunes server
print server
configuration
name
web publishing
activation
example
port number
archive
authorization
Flickr
YouTube
auto upload
Flickr/YouTube
activation
authorization
configuration
FTP Uploadr
activation
bandwidth limit
configuration
server entry
grace period
B
backup
archive
synchronization tutorial
tutorial
backup files
Index
Index
643
Index restoring files by
backup job restoring files by
backup settings
bandwidth limit
BitTorrent
IP filtering
protection
re-seeding
settings
torrent files
health
info-hash
trackers
broadcatching
adding channels
channel guides
RSS
browser plugin, capturing link
browsers
browsing shares
C
capturing download links
certificate
editing
tutorial
verifying
changing password
channel guides
CIFS
configuration
COPY/SYNC button
download service<